services: Split ladspa-service-type from pulseaudio-service-type.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 ng0@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72
73 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
74 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
75 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
76 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
77 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
78 Documentation License''.
79 @end copying
80
81 @dircategory System administration
82 @direntry
83 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
84 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
85 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
86 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
87 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
88 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
89 @end direntry
90
91 @dircategory Software development
92 @direntry
93 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
94 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
95 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
96 @end direntry
97
98 @titlepage
99 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
100 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
101 @author The GNU Guix Developers
102
103 @page
104 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
105 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
106 @value{UPDATED} @*
107
108 @insertcopying
109 @end titlepage
110
111 @contents
112
113 @c *********************************************************************
114 @node Top
115 @top GNU Guix
116
117 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
118 package management tool written for the GNU system.
119
120 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
121 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
122 @c translation.
123 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
124 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
125 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
126 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
127 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
128 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
129 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
130 Project}.
131
132 @menu
133 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
134 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
135 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
136 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
137 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
138 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
139 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
140 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
141 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
142 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
143 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
144 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
145 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
146 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
147
148 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
149 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
150 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
151 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
152
153 @detailmenu
154 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
155
156 Introduction
157
158 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
159 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
160
161 Installation
162
163 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
164 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
165 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
166 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
167 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
168 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
169
170 Setting Up the Daemon
171
172 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
173 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
174 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
175
176 System Installation
177
178 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
179 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
180 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
181 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
182 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
183 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
184 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
185 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
186 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
187
188 Manual Installation
189
190 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
191 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
192
193 Package Management
194
195 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
196 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
197 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
198 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
199 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
200 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
201 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
202 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
203 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
204 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
205 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
206
207 Substitutes
208
209 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
210 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
211 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
212 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
213 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
214 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
215
216 Development
217
218 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
219 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
220
221 Programming Interface
222
223 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
224 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
225 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
226 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
227 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
228 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
229 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
230 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
231
232 Defining Packages
233
234 * package Reference:: The package data type.
235 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
236
237 Utilities
238
239 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
240 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
241 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
242 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
243 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
244 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
245 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
246 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
247 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
248 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
249 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
250 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
251 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
252 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
253 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
254
255 Invoking @command{guix build}
256
257 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
258 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
259 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
260 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
261
262 System Configuration
263
264 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
265 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
266 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
267 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
268 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
269 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
270 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
271 * Services:: Specifying system services.
272 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
273 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
274 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
275 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
276 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
277 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
278 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
279 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
280 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
281
282 Services
283
284 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
285 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
286 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
287 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
288 * X Window:: Graphical display.
289 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
290 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
291 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
292 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
293 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
294 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
295 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
296 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
297 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
298 * Web Services:: Web servers.
299 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
300 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
301 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
302 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
303 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
304 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
305 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
306 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
307 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
308 * Game Services:: Game servers.
309 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
310 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
311
312 Defining Services
313
314 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
315 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
316 * Service Reference:: API reference.
317 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
318
319 @end detailmenu
320 @end menu
321
322 @c *********************************************************************
323 @node Introduction
324 @chapter Introduction
325
326 @cindex purpose
327 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
328 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
329 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
330 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
331 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
332 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
333 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
334
335 @cindex Guix System
336 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
337 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
338 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
339 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
340 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
341 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
342 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
343 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
344 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
345 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
346
347 @menu
348 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
349 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
350 @end menu
351
352 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
353 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
354
355 @cindex user interfaces
356 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
357 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
358 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage,
359 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
360 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
361 @cindex build daemon
362 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
363 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
364 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
365
366 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
367 @cindex customization, of packages
368 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
369 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
370 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
371 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
372 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
373 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
374 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
375 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
376
377 @cindex functional package management
378 @cindex isolation
379 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
380 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
381 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
382 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
383 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
384 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
385 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
386 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
387 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
388 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
389 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
390 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
391 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
392 explicit inputs are visible.
393
394 @cindex store
395 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
396 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
397 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
398 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
399 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
400 input yields a different directory name.
401
402 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
403 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
404 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
405
406
407 @node GNU Distribution
408 @section GNU Distribution
409
410 @cindex Guix System
411 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
412 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
413 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
414 users of that software}.}. The
415 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
416 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
417 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
418 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
419 Guix@tie{}System.
420
421 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
422 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
423 list of available packages can be browsed
424 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
425 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
426
427 @example
428 guix package --list-available
429 @end example
430
431 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
432 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
433 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
434 tools that help users exert that freedom.
435
436 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
437
438 @table @code
439
440 @item x86_64-linux
441 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
442
443 @item i686-linux
444 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
445
446 @item armhf-linux
447 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
448 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
449 and Linux-Libre kernel.
450
451 @item aarch64-linux
452 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
453
454 @item mips64el-linux
455 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
456 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
457 supported; in particular, the project's build farms no longer provide
458 substitutes for this architecture.
459
460 @end table
461
462 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
463 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
464 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
465 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
466 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
467 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
468 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
469
470 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
471 @code{mips64el-linux}.
472
473 @noindent
474 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
475 @pxref{Porting}.
476
477 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
478 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
479
480
481 @c *********************************************************************
482 @node Installation
483 @chapter Installation
484
485 @cindex installing Guix
486
487 @quotation Note
488 We recommend the use of this
489 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
490 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
491 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
492 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
493 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
494 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
495 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
496 as the root user.
497 @end quotation
498
499 @cindex foreign distro
500 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
501 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
502 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
503 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
504 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
505
506 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
507 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
508
509 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
510 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
511 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
512 ready to use it.
513
514 @menu
515 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
516 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
517 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
518 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
519 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
520 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
521 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
522 @end menu
523
524 @node Binary Installation
525 @section Binary Installation
526
527 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
528 @cindex installer script
529 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
530 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
531 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
532 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
533 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
534
535 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
536 @quotation Note
537 We recommend the use of this
538 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
539 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
540 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
541 user.
542 @end quotation
543
544 Installing goes along these lines:
545
546 @enumerate
547 @item
548 @cindex downloading Guix binary
549 Download the binary tarball from
550 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
551 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
552 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
553
554 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
555 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
556 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
557
558 @example
559 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
560 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
561 @end example
562
563 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
564 then run this command to import it:
565
566 @example
567 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
568 -qO - | gpg --import -
569 @end example
570
571 @noindent
572 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
573
574 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
575 signature!'' is normal.
576
577 @c end authentication part
578
579 @item
580 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
581 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
582
583 @example
584 # cd /tmp
585 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
586 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
587 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
588 @end example
589
590 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
591 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
592 step.)
593
594 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
595 would overwrite its own essential files.
596
597 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
598 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
599 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
600 versions are fine.)
601 They stem from the fact that all the
602 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
603 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
604 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
605 reproducible.
606
607 @item
608 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
609 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
610
611 @example
612 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
613 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
614 ~root/.config/guix/current
615 @end example
616
617 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @code{PATH} and other relevant
618 environment variables:
619
620 @example
621 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
622 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
623 @end example
624
625 @item
626 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
627 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
628
629 @item
630 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
631
632 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
633 with these commands:
634
635 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
636 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
637 @c files into place.
638 @c
639 @c See this thread for more information:
640 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
641
642 @example
643 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
644 /etc/systemd/system/
645 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
646 @end example
647
648 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
649
650 @example
651 # initctl reload-configuration
652 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
653 /etc/init/
654 # start guix-daemon
655 @end example
656
657 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
658
659 @example
660 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
661 --build-users-group=guixbuild
662 @end example
663
664 @item
665 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
666 for instance with:
667
668 @example
669 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
670 # cd /usr/local/bin
671 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
672 @end example
673
674 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
675 there:
676
677 @example
678 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
679 # cd /usr/local/share/info
680 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
681 do ln -s $i ; done
682 @end example
683
684 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
685 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
686 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
687 Info search path.)
688
689 @item
690 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
691 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
692 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
693
694 @example
695 # guix archive --authorize < \
696 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
697 @end example
698
699 @item
700 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
701 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
702 @end enumerate
703
704 Voilà, the installation is complete!
705
706 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
707 the root profile:
708
709 @example
710 # guix install hello
711 @end example
712
713 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
714 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
715
716 @example
717 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
718 @end example
719
720 @noindent
721 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
722
723 @example
724 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
725 --profile-name=current-guix guix
726 @end example
727
728 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
729
730 @node Requirements
731 @section Requirements
732
733 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
734 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
735 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
736 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
737
738 @cindex official website
739 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
740 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
741
742 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
743
744 @itemize
745 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.2.x;
746 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
747 0.1.0 or later;
748 @item
749 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
750 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
751 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
752 @item
753 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
754 or later;
755 @item
756 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
757 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
758 2017 or later;
759 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} 3.x;
760 @item @url{https://zlib.net, zlib};
761 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
762 @end itemize
763
764 The following dependencies are optional:
765
766 @itemize
767 @item
768 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
769 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
770 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
771 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
772 version 0.10.2 or later.
773
774 @item
775 When @url{https://www.nongnu.org/lzip/lzlib.html, lzlib} is available, lzlib
776 substitutes can be used and @command{guix publish} can compress substitutes
777 with lzlib.
778
779 @item
780 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
781 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
782 @end itemize
783
784 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
785 following packages are also needed:
786
787 @itemize
788 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
789 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
790 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
791 C++11 standard.
792 @end itemize
793
794 @cindex state directory
795 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
796 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
797 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
798 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
799 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
800 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
801 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
802 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
803
804 @node Running the Test Suite
805 @section Running the Test Suite
806
807 @cindex test suite
808 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
809 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
810 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
811 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
812 suite, type:
813
814 @example
815 make check
816 @end example
817
818 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
819 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
820 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
821 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
822 cache.
823
824 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
825 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
826
827 @example
828 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
829 @end example
830
831 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
832 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
833 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
834
835 @example
836 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
837 @end example
838
839 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
840 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
841 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
842 your message.
843
844 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
845 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
846 Guix is already installed, using:
847
848 @example
849 make check-system
850 @end example
851
852 @noindent
853 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
854
855 @example
856 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
857 @end example
858
859 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
860 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
861 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
862 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
863 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
864 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
865
866 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
867 all the details.
868
869 @node Setting Up the Daemon
870 @section Setting Up the Daemon
871
872 @cindex daemon
873 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
874 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
875 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
876 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
877 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
878 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
879 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
880
881 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
882 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
883 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
884
885 @menu
886 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
887 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
888 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
889 @end menu
890
891 @node Build Environment Setup
892 @subsection Build Environment Setup
893
894 @cindex build environment
895 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
896 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
897 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
898 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
899 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
900 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
901 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
902
903 @cindex build users
904 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
905 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
906 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
907 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
908 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
909 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
910 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
911 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
912 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
913 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
914
915 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
916 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
917
918 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
919 @c for why `-G' is needed.
920 @example
921 # groupadd --system guixbuild
922 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
923 do
924 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
925 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
926 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
927 guixbuilder$i;
928 done
929 @end example
930
931 @noindent
932 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
933 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
934 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
935 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
936 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
937 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
938 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
939
940 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
941 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
942 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
943 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
944 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
945 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
946 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
947 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
948
949 @example
950 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
951 @end example
952
953 @cindex chroot
954 @noindent
955 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
956 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
957 environment contains nothing but:
958
959 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
960 @itemize
961 @item
962 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
963 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
964 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
965 can only be created if the host has them.};
966
967 @item
968 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
969 since a separate PID name space is used;
970
971 @item
972 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
973 user @file{nobody};
974
975 @item
976 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
977
978 @item
979 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
980 @code{127.0.0.1};
981
982 @item
983 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
984 @end itemize
985
986 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
987 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
988 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
989 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
990 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
991 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
992 capture the name of their build tree.
993
994 @vindex http_proxy
995 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
996 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
997 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
998
999 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1000 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
1001 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1002 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1003 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1004 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1005 @emph{pure} functions.
1006
1007
1008 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1009 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1010
1011 @cindex offloading
1012 @cindex build hook
1013 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1014 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1015 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1016 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1017 present.}. When that
1018 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
1019 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
1020 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
1021 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
1022 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
1023 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
1024 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
1025 build are copied back to the initial machine.
1026
1027 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1028
1029 @lisp
1030 (list (build-machine
1031 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1032 (system "x86_64-linux")
1033 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1034 (user "bob")
1035 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1036
1037 (build-machine
1038 (name "meeps.example.org")
1039 (system "mips64el-linux")
1040 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1041 (user "alice")
1042 (private-key
1043 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1044 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1045 @end lisp
1046
1047 @noindent
1048 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1049 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
1050 architecture.
1051
1052 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1053 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1054 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1055 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1056 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1057 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1058 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1059 detailed below.
1060
1061 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1062 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1063 builds. The important fields are:
1064
1065 @table @code
1066
1067 @item name
1068 The host name of the remote machine.
1069
1070 @item system
1071 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
1072
1073 @item user
1074 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1075 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1076 allow non-interactive logins.
1077
1078 @item host-key
1079 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1080 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1081 long string that looks like this:
1082
1083 @example
1084 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1085 @end example
1086
1087 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1088 key can be found in a file such as
1089 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1090
1091 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1092 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1093 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1094 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1095
1096 @example
1097 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1098 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1099 @end example
1100
1101 @end table
1102
1103 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1104
1105 @table @asis
1106
1107 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1108 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1109
1110 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1111 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1112 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1113
1114 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1115 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1116
1117 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1118 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1119 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1120
1121 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1122 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1123
1124 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1125 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1126 to on that machine.
1127
1128 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1129 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1130
1131 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1132 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1133 machines with a higher speed factor.
1134
1135 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1136 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1137 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1138 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1139 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1140
1141 @end table
1142 @end deftp
1143
1144 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1145 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1146
1147 @example
1148 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1149 @end example
1150
1151 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1152 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1153 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1154 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1155 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1156
1157 @example
1158 # guix archive --generate-key
1159 @end example
1160
1161 @noindent
1162 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1163 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1164
1165 @example
1166 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1167 @end example
1168
1169 @noindent
1170 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1171
1172 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1173 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1174 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1175 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1176 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1177
1178 @cindex offload test
1179 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1180 master node:
1181
1182 @example
1183 # guix offload test
1184 @end example
1185
1186 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1187 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1188 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1189 from it, and report any error in the process.
1190
1191 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1192 command line:
1193
1194 @example
1195 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1196 @end example
1197
1198 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1199 regular expression like this:
1200
1201 @example
1202 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1203 @end example
1204
1205 @cindex offload status
1206 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1207 main node:
1208
1209 @example
1210 # guix offload status
1211 @end example
1212
1213
1214 @node SELinux Support
1215 @subsection SELinux Support
1216
1217 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1218 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1219 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1220 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1221 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1222 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1223 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1224 be used on Guix System.
1225
1226 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1227 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1228 To install the policy run this command as root:
1229
1230 @example
1231 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1232 @end example
1233
1234 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1235 mechanism provided by your system.
1236
1237 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1238 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1239 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1240 command:
1241
1242 @example
1243 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1244 @end example
1245
1246 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1247 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1248 operations.
1249
1250 @subsubsection Limitations
1251 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1252
1253 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1254 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1255 the Guix daemon.
1256
1257 @enumerate
1258 @item
1259 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1260 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1261 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1262 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1263
1264 @item
1265 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1266 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1267 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1268 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1269 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1270 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1271 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1272 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1273 reading and following these links.
1274
1275 @item
1276 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1277 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1278 differently from files.
1279
1280 @item
1281 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1282 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1283 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1284 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1285 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1286 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1287 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1288 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1289 allowed for processes in that domain.
1290
1291 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1292 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1293 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1294 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1295 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1296 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1297 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1298 @end enumerate
1299
1300 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1301 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1302
1303 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1304 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1305 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1306 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1307
1308 @example
1309 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1310 @end example
1311
1312 @noindent
1313 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1314
1315 @cindex chroot
1316 @cindex container, build environment
1317 @cindex build environment
1318 @cindex reproducible builds
1319 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1320 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1321 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1322 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1323 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1324 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1325 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1326 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1327 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1328 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1329 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1330
1331 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1332 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1333 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1334 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1335 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1336
1337 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1338 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1339 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1340
1341 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1342 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands.) The
1343 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1344 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1345 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1346
1347 The following command-line options are supported:
1348
1349 @table @code
1350 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1351 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1352 the Daemon, build users}).
1353
1354 @item --no-substitutes
1355 @cindex substitutes
1356 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1357 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1358 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1359
1360 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1361 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1362 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1363
1364 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1365 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1366 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1367 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1368 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1369
1370 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1371 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1372
1373 @cindex offloading
1374 @item --no-offload
1375 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1376 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1377 builds to remote machines.
1378
1379 @item --cache-failures
1380 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1381
1382 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1383 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1384 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1385 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1386
1387 @item --cores=@var{n}
1388 @itemx -c @var{n}
1389 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1390 as available.
1391
1392 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1393 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1394 guix build}).
1395
1396 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1397 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1398 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1399
1400 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1401 @itemx -M @var{n}
1402 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1403 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1404 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1405 Setup}), or simply fail.
1406
1407 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1408 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1409 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1410
1411 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1412
1413 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1414 Build Options, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
1415
1416 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1417 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1418 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1419
1420 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1421
1422 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1423 Build Options, @code{--timeout}}).
1424
1425 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1426 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1427 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1428 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1429 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1430
1431 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1432 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1433 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1434
1435 @item --debug
1436 Produce debugging output.
1437
1438 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1439 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1440 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1441
1442 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1443 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1444
1445 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1446 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1447 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1448 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1449 needs.
1450
1451 @item --disable-chroot
1452 Disable chroot builds.
1453
1454 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1455 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1456 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1457 account.
1458
1459 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1460 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1461 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1462
1463 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1464 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1465 them with bzip2 by default.
1466
1467 @item --disable-deduplication
1468 @cindex deduplication
1469 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1470
1471 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1472 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1473 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1474 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1475 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1476 this optimization.
1477
1478 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1479 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1480 derivations.
1481
1482 @cindex GC roots
1483 @cindex garbage collector roots
1484 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1485 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1486 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are reachable from a GC
1487 root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC roots.
1488
1489 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1490 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1491 corresponding to live outputs.
1492
1493 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1494 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1495 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1496 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1497
1498 In this way, setting @code{--gc-keep-derivations} to ``yes'' causes liveness
1499 to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting @code{--gc-keep-outputs} to
1500 ``yes'' causes liveness to flow from derivations to outputs. When both are
1501 set to ``yes'', the effect is to keep all the build prerequisites (the
1502 sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time tools) of live objects in
1503 the store, regardless of whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC
1504 root. This is convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1505
1506 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1507 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1508 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1509
1510 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1511 on the kernel version number.
1512
1513 @item --lose-logs
1514 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1515 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1516
1517 @item --system=@var{system}
1518 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1519 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1520 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1521
1522 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1523 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1524 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1525 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1526 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1527
1528 @table @code
1529 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1530 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1531 creating it if needed.
1532
1533 @item --listen=localhost
1534 @cindex daemon, remote access
1535 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1536 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1537 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1538 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1539 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1540
1541 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1542 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1543 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1544 @end table
1545
1546 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1547 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1548 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1549 by setting the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1550 (@pxref{The Store, @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1551
1552 @quotation Note
1553 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1554 @code{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1555 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1556 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1557 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1558 @end quotation
1559
1560 When @code{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1561 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1562 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1563 @end table
1564
1565
1566 @node Application Setup
1567 @section Application Setup
1568
1569 @cindex foreign distro
1570 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1571 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1572 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1573
1574 @subsection Locales
1575
1576 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1577 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1578 @vindex LOCPATH
1579 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1580 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1581 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1582 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1583 variable:
1584
1585 @example
1586 $ guix install glibc-locales
1587 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1588 @end example
1589
1590 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1591 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1592 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1593 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1594
1595 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1596 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1597 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1598
1599 @enumerate
1600 @item
1601 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1602 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1603 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1604 incompatible locale data.
1605
1606 @item
1607 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1608 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1609 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1610 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1611 data in the right format.
1612 @end enumerate
1613
1614 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1615 versions may be incompatible.
1616
1617 @subsection Name Service Switch
1618
1619 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1620 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1621 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1622 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1623 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1624 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1625 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1626 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1627 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1628 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1629
1630 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1631 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1632 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1633 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1634 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1635
1636 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1637 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1638 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1639 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1640 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1641 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1642 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1643 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1644 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1645 Reference Manual}).
1646
1647 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1648 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1649 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1650 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1651 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1652 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1653 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1654 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1655 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1656
1657 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1658 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1659 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1660 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1661
1662 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1663 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1664 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1665 themselves.
1666
1667 @subsection X11 Fonts
1668
1669 @cindex fonts
1670 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1671 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1672 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1673 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1674 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1675 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1676 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1677
1678 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1679 graphical applications, consider installing
1680 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1681 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1682 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1683 for Chinese languages:
1684
1685 @example
1686 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1687 @end example
1688
1689 @cindex @code{xterm}
1690 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1691 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1692 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1693
1694 @example
1695 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1696 @end example
1697
1698 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1699 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1700
1701 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1702 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1703 @example
1704 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1705 @end example
1706
1707 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1708 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1709 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1710
1711 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1712 @cindex font cache
1713 After installing fonts you may have to refresh the font cache to use
1714 them in applications. The same applies when applications installed via
1715 Guix do not seem to find fonts. To force rebuilding of the font cache
1716 run @code{fc-cache -rv}. The @code{fc-cache} command is provided by
1717 the @code{fontconfig} package.
1718
1719 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1720
1721 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1722 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1723 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1724
1725 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1726 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1727 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1728 information.
1729
1730 @subsection Emacs Packages
1731
1732 @cindex @code{emacs}
1733 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1734 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1735 sub-directories of
1736 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1737 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1738 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may not be
1739 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1740 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1741 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1742 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1743
1744 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1745 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1746 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1747 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1748 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1749
1750 @subsection The GCC toolchain
1751
1752 @cindex GCC
1753 @cindex ld-wrapper
1754
1755 Guix offers individual compiler packages such as @code{gcc} but if you
1756 are in need of a complete toolchain for compiling and linking source
1757 code what you really want is the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This
1758 package provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development,
1759 including GCC itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus
1760 debugging symbols in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker
1761 wrapper.
1762
1763 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
1764 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
1765 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
1766 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
1767 @code{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
1768
1769 @node Upgrading Guix
1770 @section Upgrading Guix
1771
1772 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1773
1774 To upgrade Guix, run:
1775
1776 @example
1777 guix pull
1778 @end example
1779
1780 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1781
1782 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1783 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1784 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1785
1786 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1787
1788 @example
1789 sudo -i guix pull
1790 @end example
1791
1792 @noindent
1793 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1794 tool):
1795
1796 @example
1797 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1798 @end example
1799
1800 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1801 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1802
1803 @c TODO What else?
1804
1805 @c *********************************************************************
1806 @node System Installation
1807 @chapter System Installation
1808
1809 @cindex installing Guix System
1810 @cindex Guix System, installation
1811 This section explains how to install Guix System
1812 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1813 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1814 @pxref{Installation}.
1815
1816 @ifinfo
1817 @quotation Note
1818 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1819 @c installation image.
1820 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1821 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1822 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1823 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1824
1825 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1826 available.
1827 @end quotation
1828 @end ifinfo
1829
1830 @menu
1831 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1832 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1833 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1834 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1835 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1836 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1837 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1838 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1839 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1840 @end menu
1841
1842 @node Limitations
1843 @section Limitations
1844
1845 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1846 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1847 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1848
1849 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1850 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1851
1852 @itemize
1853 @item
1854 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
1855
1856 @item
1857 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1858 may be missing.
1859
1860 @item
1861 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1862 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1863 missing.
1864 @end itemize
1865
1866 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1867 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
1868 info.
1869
1870
1871 @node Hardware Considerations
1872 @section Hardware Considerations
1873
1874 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
1875 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
1876 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
1877 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
1878 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
1879 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
1880 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
1881 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
1882 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
1883
1884 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
1885 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
1886 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
1887 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
1888 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
1889 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
1890 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
1891 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
1892 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
1893
1894 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
1895 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
1896 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
1897 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
1898 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
1899 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
1900
1901 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
1902 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
1903 about their support in GNU/Linux.
1904
1905
1906 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
1907 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
1908
1909 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
1910 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
1911 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz},
1912 where @var{system} is one of:
1913
1914 @table @code
1915 @item x86_64-linux
1916 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
1917
1918 @item i686-linux
1919 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
1920 @end table
1921
1922 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
1923 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
1924 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
1925
1926 @example
1927 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1928 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1929 @end example
1930
1931 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
1932 then run this command to import it:
1933
1934 @example
1935 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
1936 -qO - | gpg --import -
1937 @end example
1938
1939 @noindent
1940 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
1941
1942 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
1943 signature!'' is normal.
1944
1945 @c end duplication
1946
1947 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
1948 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
1949
1950 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
1951
1952 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
1953
1954 @enumerate
1955 @item
1956 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1957
1958 @example
1959 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1960 @end example
1961
1962 @item
1963 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
1964 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
1965 copy the image with:
1966
1967 @example
1968 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso of=/dev/sdX
1969 sync
1970 @end example
1971
1972 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
1973 @end enumerate
1974
1975 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
1976
1977 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
1978
1979 @enumerate
1980 @item
1981 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1982
1983 @example
1984 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1985 @end example
1986
1987 @item
1988 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
1989 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
1990 copy the image with:
1991
1992 @example
1993 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
1994 @end example
1995
1996 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
1997 @end enumerate
1998
1999 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2000
2001 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2002 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2003 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2004
2005 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2006 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2007
2008
2009 @node Preparing for Installation
2010 @section Preparing for Installation
2011
2012 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2013 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternately,
2014 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2015 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2016 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2017
2018 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2019 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2020 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2021 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2022 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2023 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2024 with the middle button.
2025
2026 @quotation Note
2027 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2028 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2029 ``Networking'' section below.
2030 @end quotation
2031
2032 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2033 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2034
2035 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2036 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2037
2038 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2039 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2040 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2041 the networking dialog.
2042
2043 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2044
2045 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2046 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2047 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2048 things.
2049
2050 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2051
2052 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2053 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2054
2055 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2056
2057 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2058 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2059 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2060 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2061
2062
2063 @node Manual Installation
2064 @section Manual Installation
2065
2066 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2067 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2068 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2069 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2070 Installation}).
2071
2072 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2073 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2074 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2075 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2076 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2077
2078 @menu
2079 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2080 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2081 @end menu
2082
2083 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2084 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2085
2086 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2087 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2088 guide you through this.
2089
2090 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2091
2092 @cindex keyboard layout
2093 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2094 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2095 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2096
2097 @example
2098 loadkeys dvorak
2099 @end example
2100
2101 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2102 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2103 more information.
2104
2105 @subsubsection Networking
2106
2107 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2108
2109 @example
2110 ifconfig -a
2111 @end example
2112
2113 @noindent
2114 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2115
2116 @example
2117 ip address
2118 @end example
2119
2120 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2121 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2122 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2123 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2124 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2125
2126 @table @asis
2127 @item Wired connection
2128 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2129 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2130
2131 @example
2132 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2133 @end example
2134
2135 @noindent
2136 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2137
2138 @example
2139 ip link set @var{interface} up
2140 @end example
2141
2142 @item Wireless connection
2143 @cindex wireless
2144 @cindex WiFi
2145 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2146 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2147 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2148 @command{nano}:
2149
2150 @example
2151 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2152 @end example
2153
2154 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2155 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2156 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2157
2158 @example
2159 network=@{
2160 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2161 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2162 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2163 @}
2164 @end example
2165
2166 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2167 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2168 network interface you want to use):
2169
2170 @example
2171 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2172 @end example
2173
2174 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2175 @end table
2176
2177 @cindex DHCP
2178 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2179 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2180
2181 @example
2182 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2183 @end example
2184
2185 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2186
2187 @example
2188 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2189 @end example
2190
2191 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2192 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2193
2194 @cindex installing over SSH
2195 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2196 an SSH server:
2197
2198 @example
2199 herd start ssh-daemon
2200 @end example
2201
2202 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2203 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2204
2205 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2206
2207 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2208 then format the target partition(s).
2209
2210 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2211 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2212 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2213 the partition layout you want:
2214
2215 @example
2216 cfdisk
2217 @end example
2218
2219 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2220 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2221 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2222 manual}).
2223
2224 @cindex EFI, installation
2225 @cindex UEFI, installation
2226 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2227 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2228 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2229 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2230
2231 @example
2232 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2233 @end example
2234
2235 @quotation Note
2236 @vindex grub-bootloader
2237 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2238 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2239 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2240 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2241 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2242 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2243 bootloaders.
2244 @end quotation
2245
2246 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2247 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2248 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, and JFS file systems. In particular,
2249 code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
2250 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2251 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2252
2253 @example
2254 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2255 @end example
2256
2257 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2258 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2259 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2260 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2261 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2262 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2263
2264 @example
2265 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2266 @end example
2267
2268 @cindex encrypted disk
2269 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2270 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2271 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2272 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
2273 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2274 be along these lines:
2275
2276 @example
2277 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2278 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2279 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2280 @end example
2281
2282 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2283 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2284 root file system):
2285
2286 @example
2287 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2288 @end example
2289
2290 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2291 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2292 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2293 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2294
2295 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2296 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2297 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2298 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2299
2300 @example
2301 mkswap /dev/sda3
2302 swapon /dev/sda3
2303 @end example
2304
2305 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2306 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2307 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2308 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2309 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2310 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2311
2312 @example
2313 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2314 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2315 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2316 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2317 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2318 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2319 @end example
2320
2321 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2322 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2323 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2324
2325 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2326 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2327
2328 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2329 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2330
2331 @example
2332 herd start cow-store /mnt
2333 @end example
2334
2335 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2336 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2337 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2338 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2339 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2340
2341 Next, you have to edit a file and
2342 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2343 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2344 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2345 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2346 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2347 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2348 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2349 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2350 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2351
2352 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2353 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2354 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2355 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2356 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2357 something along these lines:
2358
2359 @example
2360 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2361 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2362 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2363 @end example
2364
2365 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2366 in particular:
2367
2368 @itemize
2369 @item
2370 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2371 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2372 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2373 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2374 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2375 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2376 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2377 configuration.
2378
2379 @item
2380 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2381 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2382 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2383 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2384
2385 @item
2386 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2387 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2388 @end itemize
2389
2390 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2391 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2392 under @file{/mnt}):
2393
2394 @example
2395 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2396 @end example
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2400 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2401 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2402 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2403
2404 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2405 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2406 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2407 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2408 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2409 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2410 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2411
2412
2413 @node After System Installation
2414 @section After System Installation
2415
2416 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2417 system whenever you want by running, say:
2418
2419 @example
2420 guix pull
2421 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2422 @end example
2423
2424 @noindent
2425 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2426 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2427 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2428
2429 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2430 @quotation Note
2431 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2432 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2433 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @code{PATH} unchanged. To
2434 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2435 @end quotation
2436
2437 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2438 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2439
2440
2441 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2442 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2443
2444 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2445 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2446 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2447 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2448 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2449 section is for you.
2450
2451 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2452 disk image, follow these steps:
2453
2454 @enumerate
2455 @item
2456 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2457 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2458
2459 @item
2460 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2461 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2462
2463 @example
2464 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2465 @end example
2466
2467 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2468 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2469
2470 @item
2471 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2472
2473 @example
2474 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2475 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2476 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2477 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2478 @end example
2479
2480 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2481 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2482
2483 @item
2484 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2485 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2486 @end enumerate
2487
2488 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2489 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2490 that.
2491
2492 @node Building the Installation Image
2493 @section Building the Installation Image
2494
2495 @cindex installation image
2496 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2497 system} command, specifically:
2498
2499 @example
2500 guix system disk-image --file-system-type=iso9660 \
2501 gnu/system/install.scm
2502 @end example
2503
2504 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2505 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2506 about the installation image.
2507
2508 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2509
2510 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2511 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2512
2513 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2514 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2515 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2516
2517 @example
2518 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2519 @end example
2520
2521 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2522 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2523
2524 @c *********************************************************************
2525 @node Package Management
2526 @chapter Package Management
2527
2528 @cindex packages
2529 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2530 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2531 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2532 features.
2533
2534 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2535 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2536 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2537 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2538 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2539 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2540 with it):
2541
2542 @example
2543 guix install emacs-guix
2544 @end example
2545
2546 @menu
2547 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2548 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2549 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2550 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2551 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2552 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2553 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
2554 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2555 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2556 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2557 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2558 @end menu
2559
2560 @node Features
2561 @section Features
2562
2563 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2564 own directory---something that resembles
2565 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2566
2567 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2568 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2569 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2570 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2571
2572 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2573 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2574 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2575 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2576 simply continues to point to
2577 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2578 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2579
2580 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2581 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2582 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2583
2584 @cindex transactions
2585 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2586 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2587 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2588 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2589 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2590 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2591
2592 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2593 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2594 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2595 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2596 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2597 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2598 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2599
2600 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2601 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2602 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2603 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2604 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2605 collected.
2606
2607 @cindex reproducibility
2608 @cindex reproducible builds
2609 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2610 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2611 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2612 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2613 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2614 given package installation matches the current state of their
2615 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2616 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2617 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2618 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2619
2620 @cindex substitutes
2621 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2622 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2623 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2624 downloads it and unpacks it;
2625 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2626 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2627 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2628 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2629 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2630
2631 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2632 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2633 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2634 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2635 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2636
2637 @cindex replication, of software environments
2638 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
2639 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
2640 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
2641 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
2642 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
2643 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
2644 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
2645
2646 @node Invoking guix package
2647 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
2648
2649 @cindex installing packages
2650 @cindex removing packages
2651 @cindex package installation
2652 @cindex package removal
2653 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
2654 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
2655 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
2656 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
2657 is:
2658
2659 @example
2660 guix package @var{options}
2661 @end example
2662
2663 @cindex transactions
2664 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
2665 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
2666 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
2667 want to roll back.
2668
2669 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
2670 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
2671
2672 @example
2673 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
2674 @end example
2675
2676 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
2677 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
2678
2679 @itemize
2680 @item
2681 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
2682 @item
2683 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
2684 @item
2685 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
2686 @item
2687 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
2688 @item
2689 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
2690 @end itemize
2691
2692 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
2693 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
2694 package} directly.
2695
2696 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
2697 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
2698 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
2699 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
2700
2701 @cindex profile
2702 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
2703 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
2704 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
2705 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
2706 variable, and so on.
2707 @cindex search paths
2708 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
2709 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
2710 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
2711 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
2712
2713 @example
2714 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
2715 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
2716 @end example
2717
2718 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
2719 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
2720 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
2721 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
2722 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
2723 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
2724 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
2725 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
2726 package}.
2727
2728 The @var{options} can be among the following:
2729
2730 @table @code
2731
2732 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
2733 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
2734 Install the specified @var{package}s.
2735
2736 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
2737 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
2738 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
2739 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
2740
2741 If no version number is specified, the
2742 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
2743 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
2744 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
2745 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
2746 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
2747 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2748
2749 @cindex propagated inputs
2750 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
2751 that automatically get installed along with the required package
2752 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
2753 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
2754 package definitions).
2755
2756 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
2757 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
2758 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
2759 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
2760 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
2761 also been explicitly installed by the user.
2762
2763 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
2764 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
2765 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
2766 environment variable definitions are reported here.
2767
2768 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
2769 @itemx -e @var{exp}
2770 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
2771
2772 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
2773 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
2774 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
2775 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
2776
2777 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
2778 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
2779 multiple-output package.
2780
2781 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
2782 @itemx -f @var{file}
2783 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
2784
2785 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
2786 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
2787
2788 @lisp
2789 @include package-hello.scm
2790 @end lisp
2791
2792 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
2793 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
2794 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
2795 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2796
2797 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
2798 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
2799 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
2800
2801 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
2802 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
2803 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
2804 @code{glibc}.
2805
2806 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2807 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2808 @cindex upgrading packages
2809 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
2810 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
2811 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
2812
2813 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
2814 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
2815 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2816 pull}).
2817
2818 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2819 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
2820 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
2821 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
2822 substring ``emacs'':
2823
2824 @example
2825 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
2826 @end example
2827
2828 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
2829 @itemx -m @var{file}
2830 @cindex profile declaration
2831 @cindex profile manifest
2832 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
2833 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
2834 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
2835
2836 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
2837 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
2838 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
2839 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
2840 so on.
2841
2842 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
2843 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
2844 of packages:
2845
2846 @findex packages->manifest
2847 @lisp
2848 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
2849
2850 (packages->manifest
2851 (list emacs
2852 guile-2.0
2853 ;; Use a specific package output.
2854 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
2855 @end lisp
2856
2857 @findex specifications->manifest
2858 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
2859 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
2860 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
2861 instead provide regular package specifications and let
2862 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
2863 objects, like this:
2864
2865 @lisp
2866 (specifications->manifest
2867 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
2868 @end lisp
2869
2870 @item --roll-back
2871 @cindex rolling back
2872 @cindex undoing transactions
2873 @cindex transactions, undoing
2874 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
2875 the last transaction.
2876
2877 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
2878 before any other actions.
2879
2880 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
2881 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
2882 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
2883
2884 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
2885 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
2886 generations in a profile is always linear.
2887
2888 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
2889 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
2890 @cindex generations
2891 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
2892
2893 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
2894 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
2895 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
2896 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
2897 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
2898
2899 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
2900 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
2901 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
2902 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
2903
2904 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
2905 @cindex search paths
2906 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2907 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2908 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2909 of the installed packages.
2910
2911 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
2912 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2913 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2914 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2915 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
2916 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
2917 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2918
2919 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2920 shell:
2921
2922 @example
2923 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2924 @end example
2925
2926 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2927 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2928 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2929 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2930
2931 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2932 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2933
2934 @example
2935 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2936 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2937 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2938 @end example
2939
2940 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2941 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2942 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2943
2944
2945 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2946 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2947 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2948
2949 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
2950 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
2951 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
2952 installed:
2953
2954 @example
2955 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
2956 @dots{}
2957 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
2958 Hello, world!
2959 @end example
2960
2961 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
2962 siblings that point to specific generations:
2963
2964 @example
2965 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
2966 @end example
2967
2968 @item --list-profiles
2969 List all the user's profiles:
2970
2971 @example
2972 $ guix package --list-profiles
2973 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
2974 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
2975 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
2976 /home/charlie/tmp/test
2977 @end example
2978
2979 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
2980
2981 @cindex collisions, in a profile
2982 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
2983 @cindex profile collisions
2984 @item --allow-collisions
2985 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
2986
2987 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
2988 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
2989 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
2990
2991 @item --bootstrap
2992 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
2993 useful to distribution developers.
2994
2995 @end table
2996
2997 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
2998 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
2999 availability of packages:
3000
3001 @table @option
3002
3003 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3004 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3005 @cindex searching for packages
3006 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3007 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3008 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3009 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3010 GNU recutils manual}).
3011
3012 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3013 command, for instance:
3014
3015 @example
3016 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3017 name: jemalloc
3018 version: 4.5.0
3019 relevance: 6
3020
3021 name: glibc
3022 version: 2.25
3023 relevance: 1
3024
3025 name: libgc
3026 version: 7.6.0
3027 relevance: 1
3028 @end example
3029
3030 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3031 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3032
3033 @example
3034 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3035 name: elfutils
3036
3037 name: gmp
3038 @dots{}
3039 @end example
3040
3041 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3042 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3043 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3044 the @command{guix search} alias):
3045
3046 @example
3047 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3048 name: gnubg
3049 @dots{}
3050 @end example
3051
3052 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3053 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3054 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3055 keyboards.
3056
3057 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3058 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3059 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3060
3061 @example
3062 $ guix search crypto library | \
3063 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3064 @end example
3065
3066 @noindent
3067 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3068 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3069
3070 @item --show=@var{package}
3071 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3072 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3073 recutils manual}).
3074
3075 @example
3076 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3077 name: python
3078 version: 2.7.6
3079
3080 name: python
3081 version: 3.3.5
3082 @end example
3083
3084 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3085 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3086 @example
3087 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3088 name: python
3089 version: 3.4.3
3090 @end example
3091
3092
3093
3094 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3095 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3096 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3097 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3098 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3099
3100 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3101 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3102 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3103 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3104 the store.
3105
3106 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3107 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3108 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3109 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3110 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3111
3112 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3113 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3114 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3115
3116 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3117 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3118 @cindex generations
3119 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3120 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3121 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3122 shown.
3123
3124 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3125 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3126 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3127 location of this package in the store.
3128
3129 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3130 generations. Valid patterns include:
3131
3132 @itemize
3133 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3134 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
3135 the first one.
3136
3137 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3138 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3139
3140 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3141 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3142 a range must be smaller than its end.
3143
3144 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3145 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3146 second one.
3147
3148 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3149 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3150 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3151 that are up to 20 days old.
3152 @end itemize
3153
3154 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3155 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3156 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3157 one.
3158
3159 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3160 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3161 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3162 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3163 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3164
3165 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3166 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3167
3168 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3169 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3170
3171 @end table
3172
3173 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3174 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3175 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3176 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3177 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3178 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3179 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3180 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3181
3182 @node Substitutes
3183 @section Substitutes
3184
3185 @cindex substitutes
3186 @cindex pre-built binaries
3187 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3188 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3189 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3190 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3191 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3192
3193 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3194 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3195 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3196 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3197
3198 @menu
3199 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3200 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3201 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3202 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3203 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3204 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3205 @end menu
3206
3207 @node Official Substitute Server
3208 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3209
3210 @cindex build farm
3211 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3212 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3213 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3214 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3215 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3216 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3217 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3218 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3219 option}).
3220
3221 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3222 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3223 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3224 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3225 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3226
3227 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3228 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3229 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3230 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3231 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3232 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3233 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3234 other substitute server.
3235
3236 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3237 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3238
3239 @cindex security
3240 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3241 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3242 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3243 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3244 mirror thereof, you
3245 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3246 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3247 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3248 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3249
3250 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3251 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3252 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3253 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3254 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3255 Then, you can run something like this:
3256
3257 @example
3258 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3259 @end example
3260
3261 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3262 should change from something like:
3263
3264 @example
3265 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3266 The following derivations would be built:
3267 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3268 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3269 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3270 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3271 @dots{}
3272 @end example
3273
3274 @noindent
3275 to something like:
3276
3277 @example
3278 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3279 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3280 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3281 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3282 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3283 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3284 @dots{}
3285 @end example
3286
3287 @noindent
3288 This indicates that substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and
3289 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
3290
3291 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3292 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3293 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3294 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3295 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
3296 build}, and other command-line tools.
3297
3298 @node Substitute Authentication
3299 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3300
3301 @cindex digital signatures
3302 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3303 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3304 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3305
3306 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3307 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3308 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3309 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3310 with this option:
3311
3312 @example
3313 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3314 @end example
3315
3316 @noindent
3317 @cindex reproducible builds
3318 If the ACL contains only the key for @code{b.example.org}, and if
3319 @code{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3320 then Guix will download substitutes from @code{a.example.org} because it
3321 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3322 @code{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3323 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3324 below).
3325
3326 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3327 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3328 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3329 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3330 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3331 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
3332
3333 @node Proxy Settings
3334 @subsection Proxy Settings
3335
3336 @vindex http_proxy
3337 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
3338 The @code{http_proxy} environment
3339 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
3340 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
3341 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
3342 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
3343 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3344
3345 @node Substitution Failure
3346 @subsection Substitution Failure
3347
3348 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3349 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3350 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3351 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3352 etc.
3353
3354 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3355 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3356 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3357 @code{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3358 option @code{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @code{--fallback} was
3359 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3360 considered to have failed. However, if @code{--fallback} was given,
3361 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3362 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3363 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3364 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3365 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3366 @code{--fallback} was given.
3367
3368 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3369 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3370 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3371 by a server.
3372
3373 @node On Trusting Binaries
3374 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3375
3376 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3377 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3378 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3379 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3380 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3381 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3382 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3383 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3384 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3385 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3386
3387 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3388 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3389 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3390 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3391 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3392 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3393 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3394 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3395 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3396 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3397 @command{guix build --check}}).
3398
3399 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3400 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3401 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3402
3403 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3404 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3405
3406 @cindex multiple-output packages
3407 @cindex package outputs
3408 @cindex outputs
3409
3410 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3411 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3412 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3413 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3414 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3415 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3416 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3417 files.
3418
3419 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3420 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3421 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3422 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3423 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3424 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3425 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3426
3427 @example
3428 guix install glib
3429 @end example
3430
3431 @cindex documentation
3432 The command to install its documentation is:
3433
3434 @example
3435 guix install glib:doc
3436 @end example
3437
3438 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3439 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3440 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3441 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3442 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3443 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3444 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3445 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3446 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3447
3448 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3449 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3450 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3451 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3452 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3453 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3454 guix package}).
3455
3456
3457 @node Invoking guix gc
3458 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3459
3460 @cindex garbage collector
3461 @cindex disk space
3462 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3463 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3464 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3465 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3466 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3467
3468 @cindex GC roots
3469 @cindex garbage collector roots
3470 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3471 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3472 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3473 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3474 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3475 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3476 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3477 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3478
3479 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3480 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3481 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3482 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3483 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3484
3485 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3486 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3487 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3488
3489 @example
3490 guix gc -F 5G
3491 @end example
3492
3493 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
3494 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
3495 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
3496 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
3497 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
3498 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
3499 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
3500
3501 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
3502 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
3503 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
3504 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
3505 options are as follows:
3506
3507 @table @code
3508 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
3509 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
3510 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
3511 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
3512 specified.
3513
3514 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
3515 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
3516 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
3517 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
3518
3519 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
3520
3521 @item --free-space=@var{free}
3522 @itemx -F @var{free}
3523 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
3524 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
3525 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
3526
3527 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
3528 nothing and exit immediately.
3529
3530 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
3531 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
3532 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
3533 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
3534 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
3535
3536 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
3537 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
3538 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
3539
3540 @example
3541 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
3542 @end example
3543
3544 @item --delete
3545 @itemx -D
3546 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
3547 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
3548 they are still live.
3549
3550 @item --list-failures
3551 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
3552
3553 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
3554 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
3555 @option{--cache-failures}}).
3556
3557 @item --list-roots
3558 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
3559 roots.
3560
3561 @item --list-busy
3562 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
3563 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
3564
3565 @item --clear-failures
3566 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
3567
3568 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
3569 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
3570
3571 @item --list-dead
3572 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
3573 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
3574
3575 @item --list-live
3576 Show the list of live store files and directories.
3577
3578 @end table
3579
3580 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
3581
3582 @table @code
3583
3584 @item --references
3585 @itemx --referrers
3586 @cindex package dependencies
3587 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
3588 as arguments.
3589
3590 @item --requisites
3591 @itemx -R
3592 @cindex closure
3593 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
3594 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
3595 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
3596 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
3597
3598 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
3599 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
3600 the graph of references.
3601
3602 @item --derivers
3603 @cindex derivation
3604 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
3605 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3606
3607 For example, this command:
3608
3609 @example
3610 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
3611 @end example
3612
3613 @noindent
3614 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
3615 installed in your profile.
3616
3617 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
3618 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
3619 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
3620 @end table
3621
3622 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
3623 store and to control disk usage.
3624
3625 @table @option
3626
3627 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
3628 @cindex integrity, of the store
3629 @cindex integrity checking
3630 Verify the integrity of the store.
3631
3632 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
3633 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
3634
3635 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
3636 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
3637
3638 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
3639 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
3640 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
3641 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
3642 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
3643
3644 @cindex repairing the store
3645 @cindex corruption, recovering from
3646 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
3647 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
3648 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
3649 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
3650 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
3651 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
3652 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
3653
3654 @item --optimize
3655 @cindex deduplication
3656 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
3657 @dfn{deduplication}.
3658
3659 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
3660 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
3661 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
3662 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
3663 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
3664
3665 @end table
3666
3667 @node Invoking guix pull
3668 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
3669
3670 @cindex upgrading Guix
3671 @cindex updating Guix
3672 @cindex @command{guix pull}
3673 @cindex pull
3674 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
3675 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
3676 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
3677 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
3678 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
3679 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
3680 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized.
3681
3682 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
3683 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
3684
3685 @enumerate
3686 @item
3687 the @option{--channels} option;
3688 @item
3689 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
3690 @item
3691 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
3692 @item
3693 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
3694 variable.
3695 @end enumerate
3696
3697 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
3698 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
3699 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
3700 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
3701 become available.
3702
3703 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
3704 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
3705 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
3706 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
3707 versa.
3708
3709 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
3710 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
3711 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
3712 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
3713 (@pxref{Documentation}):
3714
3715 @example
3716 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
3717 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
3718 @end example
3719
3720 The @code{--list-generations} or @code{-l} option lists past generations
3721 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
3722
3723 @example
3724 $ guix pull -l
3725 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
3726 guix 65956ad
3727 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3728 branch: origin/master
3729 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
3730
3731 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
3732 guix e0cc7f6
3733 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3734 branch: origin/master
3735 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
3736 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
3737 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
3738 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
3739 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
3740
3741 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
3742 guix 844cc1c
3743 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3744 branch: origin/master
3745 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
3746 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
3747 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
3748 @end example
3749
3750 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
3751 describe the current status of Guix.
3752
3753 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
3754 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
3755 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
3756 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
3757
3758 @example
3759 $ guix pull --roll-back
3760 switched from generation 3 to 2
3761 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
3762 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3763 @end example
3764
3765 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
3766 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
3767 @example
3768 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
3769 switched from generation 3 to 2
3770 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
3771 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3772 @end example
3773
3774 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
3775 but it supports the following options:
3776
3777 @table @code
3778 @item --url=@var{url}
3779 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
3780 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
3781 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
3782 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
3783 string), or @var{branch}.
3784
3785 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3786 @cindex configuration file for channels
3787 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
3788 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
3789 @option{--channels} option (see below).
3790
3791 @item --channels=@var{file}
3792 @itemx -C @var{file}
3793 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
3794 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
3795 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
3796 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
3797 information.
3798
3799 @cindex channel news
3800 @item --news
3801 @itemx -N
3802 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
3803 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
3804 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
3805
3806 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
3807 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
3808 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
3809
3810 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3811 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3812 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
3813 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
3814 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
3815 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3816
3817 @item --roll-back
3818 @cindex rolling back
3819 @cindex undoing transactions
3820 @cindex transactions, undoing
3821 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
3822 undo the last transaction.
3823
3824 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3825 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3826 @cindex generations
3827 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3828
3829 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3830 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3831 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3832 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
3833 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
3834
3835 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3836 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3837 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3838 one.
3839
3840 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3841 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3842 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3843 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3844 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3845
3846 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
3847
3848 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3849 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3850
3851 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
3852 current generation only.
3853
3854 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3855 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3856 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
3857
3858 @item --dry-run
3859 @itemx -n
3860 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
3861 substituted but do not actually do it.
3862
3863 @item --system=@var{system}
3864 @itemx -s @var{system}
3865 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3866 the system type of the build host.
3867
3868 @item --verbose
3869 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
3870
3871 @item --bootstrap
3872 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
3873 useful to Guix developers.
3874 @end table
3875
3876 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
3877 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
3878 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
3879 information.
3880
3881 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
3882 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
3883
3884 @node Channels
3885 @section Channels
3886
3887 @cindex channels
3888 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3889 @cindex configuration file for channels
3890 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
3891 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
3892 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
3893 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
3894 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
3895 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
3896 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
3897 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
3898 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used to
3899 @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
3900
3901 @subsection Using a Custom Guix Channel
3902
3903 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
3904 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
3905 suppose you want to update from your own copy of the Guix repository at
3906 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
3907 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
3908
3909 @lisp
3910 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use my own repo.
3911 (list (channel
3912 (name 'guix)
3913 (url "https://example.org/my-guix.git")
3914 (branch "super-hacks")))
3915 @end lisp
3916
3917 @noindent
3918 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
3919 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}.
3920
3921 @subsection Specifying Additional Channels
3922
3923 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
3924 @cindex personal packages (channels)
3925 @cindex channels, for personal packages
3926 You can also specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. Let's say you
3927 have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages that you think
3928 would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but would like to
3929 have these packages transparently available to you at the command line. You
3930 would first write modules containing those package definitions (@pxref{Package
3931 Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and then you and anyone else can
3932 use it as an additional channel to get packages from. Neat, no?
3933
3934 @c What follows stems from discussions at
3935 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
3936 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
3937 @quotation Warning
3938 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
3939 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
3940 of caution:
3941
3942 @itemize
3943 @item
3944 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
3945 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
3946 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
3947 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
3948 process.
3949
3950 @item
3951 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
3952 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
3953 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
3954 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
3955 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
3956 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
3957 either.
3958
3959 @item
3960 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
3961 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
3962 @end itemize
3963
3964 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
3965 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
3966 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
3967 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
3968 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
3969 @end quotation
3970
3971 To use a channel, write @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct
3972 @command{guix pull} to pull from it @emph{in addition} to the default Guix
3973 channel(s):
3974
3975 @vindex %default-channels
3976 @lisp
3977 ;; Add my personal packages to those Guix provides.
3978 (cons (channel
3979 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3980 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git"))
3981 %default-channels)
3982 @end lisp
3983
3984 @noindent
3985 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
3986 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
3987 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
3988 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
3989 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
3990 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
3991 modules:
3992
3993 @example
3994 $ guix pull --list-generations
3995 @dots{}
3996 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
3997 guix d894ab8
3998 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3999 branch: master
4000 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
4001 my-personal-packages dd3df5e
4002 repository URL: https://example.org/personal-packages.git
4003 branch: master
4004 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
4005 11 new packages: my-gimp, my-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
4006 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
4007 @end example
4008
4009 @noindent
4010 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
4011 both Guix and packages from the @code{my-personal-packages} channel. Among
4012 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{my-gimp} and
4013 @code{my-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
4014 @code{my-personal-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
4015
4016 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
4017 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
4018 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
4019 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
4020 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
4021 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
4022 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
4023 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
4024 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
4025 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
4026
4027 @cindex dependencies, channels
4028 @cindex meta-data, channels
4029 @subsection Declaring Channel Dependencies
4030
4031 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
4032 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
4033 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
4034 the channel repository.
4035
4036 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
4037
4038 @lisp
4039 (channel
4040 (version 0)
4041 (dependencies
4042 (channel
4043 (name some-collection)
4044 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git"))
4045 (channel
4046 (name some-other-collection)
4047 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
4048 (branch "testing"))))
4049 @end lisp
4050
4051 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
4052 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
4053 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
4054 channels are available.
4055
4056 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
4057 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
4058 dependencies to a minimum.
4059
4060 @cindex subdirectory, channels
4061 @subsection Package Modules in a Sub-directory
4062
4063 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
4064 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
4065 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
4066
4067 @lisp
4068 (channel
4069 (version 0)
4070 (directory "guix"))
4071 @end lisp
4072
4073 @cindex news, for channels
4074 @subsection Writing Channel News
4075
4076 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
4077 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
4078 an email, but that's not convenient.
4079
4080 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
4081 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
4082 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
4083 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
4084
4085 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
4086 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
4087
4088 @lisp
4089 (channel
4090 (version 0)
4091 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
4092 @end lisp
4093
4094 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
4095 something like this:
4096
4097 @lisp
4098 (channel-news
4099 (version 0)
4100 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
4101 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
4102 (fr "Oh la la"))
4103 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
4104 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
4105 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
4106 (title (en "Added a great package")
4107 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
4108 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
4109 @end lisp
4110
4111 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
4112 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
4113 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
4114 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
4115
4116 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
4117 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
4118 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
4119 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
4120 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
4121
4122 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
4123 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
4124 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
4125 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
4126 file containing the strings to translate:
4127
4128 @example
4129 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.scm
4130 @end example
4131
4132 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
4133 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
4134
4135 @subsection Replicating Guix
4136
4137 @cindex pinning, channels
4138 @cindex replicating Guix
4139 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4140 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
4141 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
4142 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
4143 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
4144
4145 @lisp
4146 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
4147 (list (channel
4148 (name 'guix)
4149 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4150 (commit "d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300"))
4151 (channel
4152 (name 'my-personal-packages)
4153 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git")
4154 (branch "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
4155 @end lisp
4156
4157 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
4158 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
4159 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
4160 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
4161 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
4162
4163 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
4164 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
4165 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
4166 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
4167 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
4168 package it defines.
4169
4170 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
4171 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
4172 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
4173 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
4174
4175 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4176 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4177
4178 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4179 @cindex pinning, channels
4180 @cindex replicating Guix
4181 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4182
4183 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4184 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4185 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4186 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4187 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4188 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4189
4190 The general syntax is:
4191
4192 @example
4193 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4194 @end example
4195
4196 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4197 @command{guix} command if the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4198 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4199
4200 @table @code
4201 @item --url=@var{url}
4202 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4203 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4204 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4205 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4206 string), or @var{branch}.
4207
4208 @item --channels=@var{file}
4209 @itemx -C @var{file}
4210 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4211 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4212 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4213 @end table
4214
4215 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4216 the latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4217
4218 @example
4219 guix time-machine -- build hello
4220 @end example
4221
4222 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4223 which is in general a newer revison of Guix than you have installed.
4224 Time travel works in both directions!
4225
4226 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4227 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4228 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4229
4230 @node Inferiors
4231 @section Inferiors
4232
4233 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4234 @quotation Note
4235 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4236 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4237 @end quotation
4238
4239 @cindex inferiors
4240 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4241 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4242 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4243 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4244 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4245
4246 @cindex inferior packages
4247 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4248 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4249 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4250 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4251 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4252
4253 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4254 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4255 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4256 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4257 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4258 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4259 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4260 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4261 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4262
4263 @lisp
4264 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4265 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4266
4267 (define channels
4268 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4269 ;; extract guile-json.
4270 (list (channel
4271 (name 'guix)
4272 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4273 (commit
4274 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4275
4276 (define inferior
4277 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4278 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4279
4280 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4281 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4282 (packages->manifest
4283 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4284 (specification->package "guile")))
4285 @end lisp
4286
4287 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4288 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4289 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4290
4291 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4292 inferior:
4293
4294 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4295 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4296 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4297 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4298 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4299
4300 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4301 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4302 @end deffn
4303
4304 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4305 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4306 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4307 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4308 the inferior could not be launched.
4309 @end deffn
4310
4311 @cindex inferior packages
4312 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4313 packages.
4314
4315 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4316 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4317 @end deffn
4318
4319 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4320 [@var{version}]
4321 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4322 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4323 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4324 @end deffn
4325
4326 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4327 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4331 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4332 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4333 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4334 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4335 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4336 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4337 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4338 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4339 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4340 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4341 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4342 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4343 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4344 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4345 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4346 these procedures.
4347 @end deffn
4348
4349 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4350 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4351 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4352 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4353 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4354 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4355 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4356 declaration, and so on.
4357
4358 @node Invoking guix describe
4359 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4360
4361 @cindex reproducibility
4362 @cindex replicating Guix
4363 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4364 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4365 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4366 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4367 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4368 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4369 command answers these questions.
4370
4371 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4372 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4373 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4374
4375 @example
4376 $ guix describe
4377 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4378 guix e0fa68c
4379 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4380 branch: master
4381 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4382 @end example
4383
4384 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4385 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4386 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4387 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4388 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4389 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4390 also to replicate it.
4391
4392 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4393 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4394
4395 @example
4396 $ guix describe -f channels
4397 (list (channel
4398 (name 'guix)
4399 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4400 (commit
4401 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")))
4402 @end example
4403
4404 @noindent
4405 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4406 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4407 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4408 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4409 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4410 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4411
4412 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4413 follows:
4414
4415 @table @code
4416 @item --format=@var{format}
4417 @itemx -f @var{format}
4418 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4419
4420 @table @code
4421 @item human
4422 produce human-readable output;
4423 @item channels
4424 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4425 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4426 guix pull});
4427 @item json
4428 @cindex JSON
4429 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4430 @item recutils
4431 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4432 @end table
4433
4434 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4435 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4436 Display information about @var{profile}.
4437 @end table
4438
4439 @node Invoking guix archive
4440 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4441
4442 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4443 @cindex archive
4444 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4445 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4446 a machine that runs Guix.
4447 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4448 to the store on another machine.
4449
4450 @quotation Note
4451 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4452 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4453 @end quotation
4454
4455 @cindex exporting store items
4456 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4457
4458 @example
4459 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4460 @end example
4461
4462 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4463 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4464 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4465 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4466 output of @code{emacs}:
4467
4468 @example
4469 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4470 @end example
4471
4472 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4473 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4474 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4475
4476 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4477 one would run:
4478
4479 @example
4480 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4481 @end example
4482
4483 @noindent
4484 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4485 to another like this:
4486
4487 @example
4488 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4489 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4490 @end example
4491
4492 @noindent
4493 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4494 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4495 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
4496 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
4497 items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4498 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4499 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4500
4501 @cindex nar, archive format
4502 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4503 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
4504 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4505 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4506 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4507 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4508 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4509 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4510 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4511 deterministic.
4512
4513 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4514 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4515 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4516 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4517 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4518
4519 The main options are:
4520
4521 @table @code
4522 @item --export
4523 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
4524 resulting archive to the standard output.
4525
4526 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4527 @code{--recursive} is passed.
4528
4529 @item -r
4530 @itemx --recursive
4531 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
4532 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
4533 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
4534 of the exported store items.
4535
4536 @item --import
4537 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4538 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4539 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4540 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
4541
4542 @item --missing
4543 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4544 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4545 the store.
4546
4547 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4548 @cindex signing, archives
4549 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4550 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
4551 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
4552 generate the key pair.
4553
4554 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4555 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4556 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4557 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4558 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4559 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4560 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4561 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4562 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4563
4564 @item --authorize
4565 @cindex authorizing, archives
4566 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4567 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4568 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4569
4570 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4571 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4572 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4573 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4574 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4575 (SPKI)}.
4576
4577 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4578 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4579 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4580 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4581 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4582
4583 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4584 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4585
4586 @example
4587 $ wget -O - \
4588 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4589 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4590 @end example
4591
4592 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4593 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4594 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4595 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4596 unsafe.
4597
4598 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4599 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
4600
4601 @item --list
4602 @itemx -t
4603 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4604 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4605 this example:
4606
4607 @example
4608 $ wget -O - \
4609 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4610 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4611 @end example
4612
4613 @end table
4614
4615
4616 @c *********************************************************************
4617 @node Development
4618 @chapter Development
4619
4620 @cindex software development
4621 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
4622 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
4623 this chapter is about.
4624
4625 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
4626 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
4627 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
4628 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
4629 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
4630
4631 @menu
4632 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4633 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
4634 @end menu
4635
4636 @node Invoking guix environment
4637 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4638
4639 @cindex reproducible build environments
4640 @cindex development environments
4641 @cindex @command{guix environment}
4642 @cindex environment, package build environment
4643 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4644 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4645 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4646 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
4647 environment to use them.
4648
4649 The general syntax is:
4650
4651 @example
4652 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4653 @end example
4654
4655 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4656 GNU@tie{}Guile:
4657
4658 @example
4659 guix environment guile
4660 @end example
4661
4662 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4663 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
4664 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4665 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4666 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4667 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
4668 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4669 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4670 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4671 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4672 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4673 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4674 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4675 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
4676 details on Bash start-up files.}.
4677
4678 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4679 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4680 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
4681 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
4682 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4683 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4684
4685 @example
4686 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4687 then
4688 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4689 fi
4690 @end example
4691
4692 @noindent
4693 ...@: or to browse the profile:
4694
4695 @example
4696 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
4697 @end example
4698
4699 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4700 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4701 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4702 and Emacs are available:
4703
4704 @example
4705 guix environment guile emacs
4706 @end example
4707
4708 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4709 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4710 command from the rest of the arguments:
4711
4712 @example
4713 guix environment guile -- make -j4
4714 @end example
4715
4716 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4717 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4718 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4719 NumPy:
4720
4721 @example
4722 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
4723 @end example
4724
4725 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4726 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4727 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4728 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4729 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4730 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4731 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4732 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4733 additionally includes Git and strace:
4734
4735 @example
4736 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
4737 @end example
4738
4739 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4740 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4741 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
4742 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4743 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4744 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4745 working directory are mounted:
4746
4747 @example
4748 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4749 @end example
4750
4751 @quotation Note
4752 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
4753 @end quotation
4754
4755 The available options are summarized below.
4756
4757 @table @code
4758 @item --root=@var{file}
4759 @itemx -r @var{file}
4760 @cindex persistent environment
4761 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
4762 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
4763 register it as a garbage collector root.
4764
4765 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
4766 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
4767
4768 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
4769 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
4770 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
4771 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
4772 gc}, for more on GC roots.
4773
4774 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4775 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4776 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
4777 @var{expr} evaluates to.
4778
4779 For example, running:
4780
4781 @example
4782 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
4783 @end example
4784
4785 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
4786 PETSc package.
4787
4788 Running:
4789
4790 @example
4791 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
4792 @end example
4793
4794 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
4795
4796 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
4797 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
4798
4799 @example
4800 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
4801 @end example
4802
4803 @item --load=@var{file}
4804 @itemx -l @var{file}
4805 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
4806 within @var{file} evaluates to.
4807
4808 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
4809 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4810
4811 @lisp
4812 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
4813 @end lisp
4814
4815 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4816 @itemx -m @var{file}
4817 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
4818 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
4819 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
4820
4821 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
4822 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
4823 manifest files.
4824
4825 @item --ad-hoc
4826 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
4827 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
4828 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
4829 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
4830
4831 For instance, the command:
4832
4833 @example
4834 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
4835 @end example
4836
4837 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
4838 available.
4839
4840 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
4841 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
4842 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
4843 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4844
4845 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
4846 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
4847 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
4848 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
4849 that will be added to the environment directly.
4850
4851 @item --pure
4852 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
4853 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below.) This has the effect of
4854 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
4855
4856 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
4857 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
4858 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
4859 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
4860 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
4861 several times.
4862
4863 @example
4864 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
4865 -- mpirun @dots{}
4866 @end example
4867
4868 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
4869 variables defined are @code{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
4870 with @code{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@code{HOME},
4871 @code{USER}, etc.)
4872
4873 @item --search-paths
4874 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
4875 environment.
4876
4877 @item --system=@var{system}
4878 @itemx -s @var{system}
4879 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
4880
4881 @item --container
4882 @itemx -C
4883 @cindex container
4884 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
4885 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
4886 Additionally, unless overridden with @code{--user}, a dummy home
4887 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
4888 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
4889
4890 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
4891 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
4892 @option{--user} is passed (see below.)
4893
4894 @item --network
4895 @itemx -N
4896 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
4897 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
4898 device.
4899
4900 @item --link-profile
4901 @itemx -P
4902 For containers, link the environment profile to
4903 @file{~/.guix-profile} within the container. This is equivalent to
4904 running the command @command{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile}
4905 within the container. Linking will fail and abort the environment if
4906 the directory already exists, which will certainly be the case if
4907 @command{guix environment} was invoked in the user's home directory.
4908
4909 Certain packages are configured to look in
4910 @code{~/.guix-profile} for configuration files and data;@footnote{For
4911 example, the @code{fontconfig} package inspects
4912 @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts} for additional fonts.}
4913 @code{--link-profile} allows these programs to behave as expected within
4914 the environment.
4915
4916 @item --user=@var{user}
4917 @itemx -u @var{user}
4918 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
4919 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
4920 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
4921 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
4922 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
4923 need not exist on the system.
4924
4925 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @code{--share} and
4926 @code{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
4927 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
4928 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
4929
4930 @example
4931 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
4932 cd $HOME/wd
4933 guix environment --container --user=foo \
4934 --expose=$HOME/test \
4935 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
4936 @end example
4937
4938 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
4939 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
4940 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
4941
4942 @item --no-cwd
4943 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
4944 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
4945 directory within the container. If this is undesirable, @code{--no-cwd}
4946 will cause the current working directory to @emph{not} be automatically
4947 shared and will change to the user's home directory within the container
4948 instead. See also @code{--user}.
4949
4950 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4951 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
4952 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
4953 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4954 point in the container.
4955
4956 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4957 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
4958 directory:
4959
4960 @example
4961 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4962 @end example
4963
4964 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4965 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
4966 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
4967 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4968 point in the container.
4969
4970 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4971 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
4972 @file{/exchange} directory:
4973
4974 @example
4975 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4976 @end example
4977 @end table
4978
4979 @command{guix environment}
4980 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
4981 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
4982 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4983
4984 @node Invoking guix pack
4985 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
4986
4987 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
4988 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
4989 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
4990 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
4991
4992 @quotation Note
4993 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
4994 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
4995 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
4996 @end quotation
4997
4998 @cindex pack
4999 @cindex bundle
5000 @cindex application bundle
5001 @cindex software bundle
5002 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5003 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5004 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5005 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5006 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5007 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5008 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5009 that you pretend to be shipping.
5010
5011 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5012 their dependencies, you can run:
5013
5014 @example
5015 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5016 @dots{}
5017 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5018 @end example
5019
5020 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5021 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5022 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5023 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5024 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5025 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5026
5027 Users of this pack would have to run
5028 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5029 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5030 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5031
5032 @example
5033 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5034 @end example
5035
5036 @noindent
5037 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5038
5039 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5040 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5041 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5042 that case, you will want to use the @code{--relocatable} option (see
5043 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5044 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5045 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5046 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5047
5048 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5049 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5050 the following command:
5051
5052 @example
5053 guix pack -f docker guile emacs geiser
5054 @end example
5055
5056 @noindent
5057 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5058 command. See the
5059 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5060 documentation} for more information.
5061
5062 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5063 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5064 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5065 command:
5066
5067 @example
5068 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5069 @end example
5070
5071 @noindent
5072 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5073 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5074 @uref{https://singularity.lbl.gov, Singularity container execution
5075 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5076 @command{singularity exec}.
5077
5078 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5079
5080 @table @code
5081 @item --format=@var{format}
5082 @itemx -f @var{format}
5083 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
5084
5085 The available formats are:
5086
5087 @table @code
5088 @item tarball
5089 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
5090 specified binaries and symlinks.
5091
5092 @item docker
5093 This produces a tarball that follows the
5094 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
5095 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
5096 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
5097 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
5098
5099 @item squashfs
5100 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
5101 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
5102 procfs.
5103
5104 @quotation Note
5105 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
5106 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
5107 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
5108 with something like:
5109
5110 @example
5111 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
5112 @end example
5113
5114 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
5115 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
5116 such file or directory'' message.
5117 @end quotation
5118 @end table
5119
5120 @cindex relocatable binaries
5121 @item --relocatable
5122 @itemx -R
5123 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
5124 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
5125
5126 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
5127 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
5128 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
5129 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
5130 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to PRoot
5131 if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially work anywhere---see below
5132 for the implications.
5133
5134 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
5135
5136 @example
5137 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
5138 @end example
5139
5140 @noindent
5141 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
5142 home directory as a normal user, run:
5143
5144 @example
5145 tar xf pack.tar.gz
5146 ./mybin/sh
5147 @end example
5148
5149 @noindent
5150 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
5151 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
5152 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
5153 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
5154 software on a non-Guix machine.
5155
5156 @quotation Note
5157 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
5158 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
5159 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
5160 turn it off.
5161
5162 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
5163 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
5164 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to PRoot if user
5165 namespaces are not supported.
5166
5167 The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program provides the necessary
5168 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
5169 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
5170 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
5171 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
5172 @end quotation
5173
5174 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
5175 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
5176 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
5177 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
5178 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
5179 pack.
5180
5181 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
5182 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
5183 do:
5184
5185 @example
5186 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
5187 @end example
5188
5189 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
5190 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
5191
5192 @example
5193 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
5194 docker run @var{image-id}
5195 @end example
5196
5197 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5198 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5199 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5200
5201 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
5202 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @code{--expression} in
5203 @command{guix build}}).
5204
5205 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5206 @itemx -m @var{file}
5207 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
5208 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
5209 case the manifests are concatenated.
5210
5211 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
5212 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
5213 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
5214 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
5215 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
5216 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
5217 but not both.
5218
5219 @item --system=@var{system}
5220 @itemx -s @var{system}
5221 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
5222 the system type of the build host.
5223
5224 @item --target=@var{triplet}
5225 @cindex cross-compilation
5226 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
5227 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
5228 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5229
5230 @item --compression=@var{tool}
5231 @itemx -C @var{tool}
5232 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
5233 @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no compression.
5234
5235 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
5236 @itemx -S @var{spec}
5237 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
5238 appear several times.
5239
5240 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
5241 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
5242 symlink target.
5243
5244 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
5245 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
5246
5247 @item --save-provenance
5248 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
5249 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
5250 (@pxref{Channels}).
5251
5252 Provenance information is saved in the
5253 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
5254 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
5255 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
5256 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
5257
5258 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
5259 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
5260 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
5261 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
5262 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
5263
5264 @item --root=@var{file}
5265 @itemx -r @var{file}
5266 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
5267 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
5268 collector root.
5269
5270 @item --localstatedir
5271 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
5272 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
5273 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
5274 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
5275 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
5276
5277 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
5278 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
5279 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
5280 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
5281 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
5282
5283 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
5284 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5285
5286 @item --derivation
5287 @itemx -d
5288 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
5289
5290 @item --bootstrap
5291 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
5292 useful to Guix developers.
5293 @end table
5294
5295 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
5296 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
5297 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5298
5299
5300 @c *********************************************************************
5301 @node Programming Interface
5302 @chapter Programming Interface
5303
5304 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
5305 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
5306 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
5307 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
5308 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
5309 turned into concrete build actions.
5310
5311 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
5312 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
5313 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
5314 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
5315 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
5316
5317 @cindex derivation
5318 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
5319 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
5320 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
5321 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
5322 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
5323 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
5324 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
5325
5326 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
5327 package definitions.
5328
5329 @menu
5330 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
5331 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
5332 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
5333 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
5334 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
5335 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
5336 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
5337 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
5338 @end menu
5339
5340 @node Package Modules
5341 @section Package Modules
5342
5343 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
5344 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
5345 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
5346 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
5347 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
5348 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
5349 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
5350 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
5351 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
5352 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
5353 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5354
5355 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
5356 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
5357 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
5358 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
5359 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
5360 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
5361
5362 @cindex customization, of packages
5363 @cindex package module search path
5364 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
5365 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
5366 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
5367 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
5368 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
5369 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
5370 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
5371 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
5372
5373 @enumerate
5374 @item
5375 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
5376 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
5377 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5378 environment variable described below.
5379
5380 @item
5381 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
5382 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
5383 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
5384 channels.
5385 @end enumerate
5386
5387 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
5388
5389 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5390 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
5391 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
5392 over the own modules of the distribution.
5393 @end defvr
5394
5395 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
5396 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
5397 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
5398 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
5399 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
5400 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
5401
5402 @node Defining Packages
5403 @section Defining Packages
5404
5405 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
5406 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
5407 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
5408 package looks like this:
5409
5410 @lisp
5411 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
5412 #:use-module (guix packages)
5413 #:use-module (guix download)
5414 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
5415 #:use-module (guix licenses)
5416 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
5417
5418 (define-public hello
5419 (package
5420 (name "hello")
5421 (version "2.10")
5422 (source (origin
5423 (method url-fetch)
5424 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
5425 ".tar.gz"))
5426 (sha256
5427 (base32
5428 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
5429 (build-system gnu-build-system)
5430 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
5431 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
5432 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
5433 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
5434 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
5435 (license gpl3+)))
5436 @end lisp
5437
5438 @noindent
5439 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
5440 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
5441 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
5442 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5443 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
5444 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
5445 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
5446
5447 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
5448 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
5449 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
5450
5451 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
5452 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
5453 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
5454 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
5455 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5456
5457 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
5458
5459 @itemize
5460 @item
5461 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
5462 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
5463 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
5464 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
5465
5466 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
5467 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
5468
5469 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
5470 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
5471 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
5472 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
5473 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
5474 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
5475
5476 @cindex patches
5477 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
5478 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
5479 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
5480
5481 @item
5482 @cindex GNU Build System
5483 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
5484 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
5485 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
5486 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
5487 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
5488
5489 @item
5490 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
5491 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
5492 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
5493 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
5494
5495 @cindex quote
5496 @cindex quoting
5497 @findex '
5498 @findex quote
5499 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
5500 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
5501 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
5502 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
5503 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
5504 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5505 Manual}).
5506
5507 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
5508 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
5509 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
5510 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
5511 Reference Manual}).
5512
5513 @item
5514 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
5515 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
5516 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
5517 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
5518
5519 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
5520 @findex `
5521 @findex quasiquote
5522 @cindex comma (unquote)
5523 @findex ,
5524 @findex unquote
5525 @findex ,@@
5526 @findex unquote-splicing
5527 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
5528 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
5529 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
5530 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
5531 Reference Manual}).
5532
5533 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
5534 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
5535 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
5536
5537 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
5538 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
5539 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
5540 @end itemize
5541
5542 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
5543
5544 Once a package definition is in place, the
5545 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
5546 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
5547 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
5548 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
5549 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
5550 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
5551 more information on how to test package definitions, and
5552 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
5553 for style conformance.
5554 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5555 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
5556 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
5557 in a ``channel''.
5558
5559 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
5560 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
5561 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
5562
5563 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
5564 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
5565 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
5566 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
5567 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
5568
5569 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
5570 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
5571 (@pxref{Derivations}).
5572
5573 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
5574 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
5575 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
5576 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
5577 (@pxref{The Store}).
5578 @end deffn
5579
5580 @noindent
5581 @cindex cross-compilation
5582 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
5583 package for some other system:
5584
5585 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
5586 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
5587 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
5588 @var{system} to @var{target}.
5589
5590 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
5591 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
5592 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5593 @end deffn
5594
5595 @cindex package transformations
5596 @cindex input rewriting
5597 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
5598 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
5599 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
5600 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
5601
5602 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
5603 [@var{rewrite-name}]
5604 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
5605 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
5606 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
5607 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
5608 is the replacement.
5609
5610 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
5611 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
5612 @end deffn
5613
5614 @noindent
5615 Consider this example:
5616
5617 @lisp
5618 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5619 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
5620 ;; recursively.
5621 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
5622
5623 (define git-with-libressl
5624 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
5625 @end lisp
5626
5627 @noindent
5628 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
5629 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
5630 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
5631 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
5632 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
5633
5634 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
5635 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
5636
5637 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements}
5638 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given @var{replacements} to
5639 all the package graph (excluding implicit inputs). @var{replacements} is a list of
5640 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as @code{"gcc"} or
5641 @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching package and returns a
5642 replacement for that package.
5643 @end deffn
5644
5645 The example above could be rewritten this way:
5646
5647 @lisp
5648 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5649 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
5650 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
5651 @end lisp
5652
5653 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
5654 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
5655 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
5656
5657 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
5658 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
5659 graph.
5660
5661 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
5662 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
5663 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
5664 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
5665 @end deffn
5666
5667 @menu
5668 * package Reference:: The package data type.
5669 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
5670 @end menu
5671
5672
5673 @node package Reference
5674 @subsection @code{package} Reference
5675
5676 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
5677 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5678
5679 @deftp {Data Type} package
5680 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
5681
5682 @table @asis
5683 @item @code{name}
5684 The name of the package, as a string.
5685
5686 @item @code{version}
5687 The version of the package, as a string.
5688
5689 @item @code{source}
5690 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
5691 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
5692 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
5693 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
5694 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5695 @code{local-file}}).
5696
5697 @item @code{build-system}
5698 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
5699 Systems}).
5700
5701 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5702 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
5703 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
5704
5705 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5706 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5707 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5708 @cindex inputs, of packages
5709 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
5710 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
5711 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
5712 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
5713 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
5714 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
5715 inputs:
5716
5717 @lisp
5718 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
5719 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
5720 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
5721 @end lisp
5722
5723 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
5724 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
5725 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
5726 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
5727 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
5728 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
5729
5730 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
5731 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
5732 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
5733 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
5734
5735 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
5736 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
5737 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
5738 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
5739 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
5740 propagated inputs.)
5741
5742 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
5743 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
5744 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
5745
5746 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
5747 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
5748 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
5749 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
5750 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
5751 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
5752
5753 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
5754 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
5755 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
5756
5757 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5758 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5759 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
5760 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
5761
5762 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
5763 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
5764 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
5765 for details.
5766
5767 @item @code{synopsis}
5768 A one-line description of the package.
5769
5770 @item @code{description}
5771 A more elaborate description of the package.
5772
5773 @item @code{license}
5774 @cindex license, of packages
5775 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
5776 or a list of such values.
5777
5778 @item @code{home-page}
5779 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
5780
5781 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
5782 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
5783 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
5784
5785 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
5786 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
5787 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
5788 automatically corrected.
5789 @end table
5790 @end deftp
5791
5792 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
5793 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
5794 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
5795
5796 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
5797 cross-compiling:
5798
5799 @lisp
5800 (package
5801 (name "guile")
5802 ;; ...
5803
5804 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
5805 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
5806 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
5807 `(("self" ,this-package))
5808 '())))
5809 @end lisp
5810
5811 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
5812 @end deffn
5813
5814 @node origin Reference
5815 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
5816
5817 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
5818 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5819
5820 @deftp {Data Type} origin
5821 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
5822
5823 @table @asis
5824 @item @code{uri}
5825 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
5826 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
5827 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
5828 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
5829
5830 @item @code{method}
5831 A procedure that handles the URI.
5832
5833 Examples include:
5834
5835 @table @asis
5836 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
5837 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
5838 @code{uri} field;
5839
5840 @vindex git-fetch
5841 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
5842 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
5843 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
5844 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
5845
5846 @lisp
5847 (git-reference
5848 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
5849 (commit "v2.10"))
5850 @end lisp
5851 @end table
5852
5853 @item @code{sha256}
5854 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
5855 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
5856 base-32 string.
5857
5858 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
5859 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
5860 guix hash}).
5861
5862 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
5863 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
5864 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
5865 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
5866 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
5867 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
5868
5869 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
5870 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5871 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
5872
5873 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
5874 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
5875 @code{%current-target-system}.
5876
5877 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
5878 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
5879 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
5880 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
5881
5882 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
5883 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
5884 command.
5885
5886 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
5887 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
5888 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
5889 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
5890
5891 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
5892 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
5893 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
5894
5895 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
5896 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
5897 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
5898 @end table
5899 @end deftp
5900
5901
5902 @node Build Systems
5903 @section Build Systems
5904
5905 @cindex build system
5906 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
5907 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
5908 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
5909 dependencies of that build procedure.
5910
5911 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
5912 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
5913 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
5914
5915 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
5916 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
5917 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
5918 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
5919 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
5920 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
5921 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
5922
5923 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
5924 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
5925 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
5926 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
5927 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
5928 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
5929 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
5930
5931 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
5932 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
5933 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
5934
5935 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
5936 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
5937 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
5938 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
5939
5940 @cindex build phases
5941 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
5942 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
5943 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
5944 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
5945 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
5946 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
5947
5948 @table @code
5949 @item unpack
5950 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
5951 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
5952 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
5953
5954 @item patch-source-shebangs
5955 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
5956 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
5957 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
5958
5959 @item configure
5960 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
5961 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
5962 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
5963
5964 @item build
5965 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
5966 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
5967 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
5968
5969 @item check
5970 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
5971 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
5972 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
5973 check -j}.
5974
5975 @item install
5976 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
5977
5978 @item patch-shebangs
5979 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
5980
5981 @item strip
5982 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
5983 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
5984 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
5985 @end table
5986
5987 @vindex %standard-phases
5988 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
5989 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
5990 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
5991 procedure implements the actual phase.
5992
5993 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
5994 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
5995
5996 @example
5997 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
5998 @end example
5999
6000 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
6001 @code{configure} phase.
6002
6003 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
6004 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
6005 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
6006 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
6007 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
6008 have to mention them.
6009 @end defvr
6010
6011 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
6012 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
6013 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
6014 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
6015 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
6016
6017 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
6018 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
6019 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
6020 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
6021
6022 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
6023 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
6024 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
6025 parameters, respectively.
6026
6027 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
6028 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
6029 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
6030 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
6031 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
6032
6033 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
6034 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
6035 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
6036 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
6037 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
6038 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
6039 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
6040
6041 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
6042 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
6043 ``jar'' task will be run.
6044
6045 @end defvr
6046
6047 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
6048 @cindex Android distribution
6049 @cindex Android NDK build system
6050 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
6051 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
6052 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
6053
6054 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
6055 (header) files to the subdirectory "include" of the "out" output and
6056 their libraries to the subdirectory "lib" of the "out" output.
6057
6058 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
6059 has no conflicting files.
6060
6061 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
6062 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
6063
6064 @end defvr
6065
6066 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
6067 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
6068 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
6069
6070 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
6071 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
6072 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
6073 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
6074
6075 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
6076 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
6077 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
6078 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
6079 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
6080 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
6081
6082 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
6083 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
6084 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
6085
6086 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
6087 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
6088 the @code{cl-} prefix.
6089
6090 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
6091 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
6092 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
6093 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
6094
6095 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
6096 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
6097 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
6098 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
6099 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
6100 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
6101
6102 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
6103 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
6104 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
6105 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
6106 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
6107 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
6108 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
6109 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
6110
6111 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
6112 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
6113 be used to specify the name of the system.
6114
6115 @end defvr
6116
6117 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
6118 @cindex Rust programming language
6119 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
6120 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
6121 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
6122 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
6123
6124 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
6125 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
6126
6127 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
6128 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
6129 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
6130 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
6131 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
6132 should be added to the package definition via the
6133 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
6134
6135 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
6136 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
6137 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
6138 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
6139 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs any crate the binaries
6140 if they are defined by the crate.
6141 @end defvr
6142
6143 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
6144 @cindex simple Clojure build system
6145 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
6146 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
6147 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
6148 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
6149 yet.
6150
6151 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
6152 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
6153 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
6154
6155 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
6156 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
6157 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
6158 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
6159 Other parameters are documented below.
6160
6161 This build system is an extension of @var{ant-build-system}, but with the
6162 following phases changed:
6163
6164 @table @code
6165
6166 @item build
6167 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
6168 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
6169 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
6170 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
6171 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
6172 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
6173 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
6174 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
6175
6176 @item check
6177 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
6178 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
6179 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
6180 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
6181 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
6182 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
6183
6184 @item install
6185 This phase installs all jars built previously.
6186 @end table
6187
6188 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
6189
6190 @table @code
6191
6192 @item install-doc
6193 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
6194 @var{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
6195 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
6196 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
6197 @end table
6198 @end defvr
6199
6200 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
6201 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
6202 implements the build procedure for packages using the
6203 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
6204
6205 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
6206 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
6207 parameter.
6208
6209 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
6210 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
6211 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
6212 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
6213 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
6214 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
6215 @end defvr
6216
6217 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
6218 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
6219 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
6220 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
6221 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
6222 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
6223 system.
6224
6225 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
6226 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
6227 parameter.
6228
6229 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
6230 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
6231 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
6232
6233 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
6234 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
6235 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
6236
6237 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
6238 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
6239 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
6240 @code{dune}.
6241 @end defvr
6242
6243 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
6244 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
6245 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
6246 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
6247 Go build mechanisms}.
6248
6249 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
6250 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
6251 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
6252 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
6253 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
6254 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
6255 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
6256 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
6257 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
6258 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
6259
6260 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
6261 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
6262 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
6263 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
6264 @end defvr
6265
6266 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
6267 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
6268 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
6269
6270 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
6271 @var{gnu-build-system}:
6272
6273 @table @code
6274 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6275 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
6276 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
6277 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
6278 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
6279 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
6280 environment variables.
6281
6282 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
6283 process by listing their names in the
6284 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
6285 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
6286 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
6287 GLib and GTK+.
6288
6289 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6290 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
6291 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
6292 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
6293 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
6294 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
6295 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
6296 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
6297 @end table
6298
6299 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
6300 @end defvr
6301
6302 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
6303 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
6304 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
6305 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
6306 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
6307 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
6308 installs documentation.
6309
6310 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the @code{--target}
6311 option of @command{guild compile}.
6312
6313 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
6314 their @code{native-inputs} field.
6315 @end defvr
6316
6317 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
6318 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It implements
6319 the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/, julia} packages,
6320 which essentially is similar to running @command{julia -e 'using Pkg;
6321 Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where @code{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the
6322 paths to all Julia package inputs. Tests are run not run.
6323
6324 Julia packages require the source @code{file-name} to be the real name of the
6325 package, correctly capitalized.
6326
6327 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
6328 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
6329 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
6330 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
6331
6332 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
6333 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
6334 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
6335 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
6336 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
6337 and their uuid.
6338 @end defvr
6339
6340 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
6341 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
6342 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
6343
6344 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
6345 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
6346 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
6347 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
6348 output.
6349
6350 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
6351 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
6352 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
6353 @end defvr
6354
6355 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
6356 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
6357 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
6358 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
6359 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
6360 try some of them.
6361
6362 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
6363 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
6364 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
6365 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
6366 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
6367 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
6368 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
6369 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
6370 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
6371
6372 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
6373 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
6374 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
6375 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
6376
6377 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
6378 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
6379 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
6380
6381 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
6382 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
6383 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
6384 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
6385 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
6386 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
6387 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
6388
6389 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
6390 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
6391 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
6392 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
6393 libraries cannot be found and we use @code{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
6394 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
6395 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
6396 @end defvr
6397
6398 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
6399 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
6400 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
6401 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
6402 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
6403
6404 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
6405 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
6406 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
6407
6408 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
6409 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
6410 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
6411 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
6412 interpreter version.
6413
6414 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
6415 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
6416 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
6417 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
6418 @end defvr
6419
6420 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
6421 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
6422 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
6423 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
6424 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
6425 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
6426 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
6427 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
6428 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
6429 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
6430 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
6431 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
6432
6433 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
6434 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
6435 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
6436
6437 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
6438 @end defvr
6439
6440 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
6441 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
6442 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
6443
6444 This build system adds the phase @code{qt-wrap} to the ones defined by
6445 @var{cmake-build-system}, after the @code{install} phase.
6446
6447 This phase searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
6448 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
6449 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
6450 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
6451
6452 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
6453 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
6454 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
6455 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
6456 or such.
6457 @end defvr
6458
6459 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
6460 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
6461 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
6462 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
6463 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
6464 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
6465 are run after installation using the R function
6466 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
6467 @end defvr
6468
6469 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
6470 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
6471 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
6472 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
6473 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
6474 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
6475 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
6476 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
6477
6478 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
6479 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
6480 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6481 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
6482 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
6483 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6484 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
6485 @end defvr
6486
6487 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
6488 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
6489 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
6490 build system sets the @code{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
6491 files in the inputs.
6492
6493 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
6494 different engine and format can be specified with the
6495 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
6496 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
6497 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
6498 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
6499 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
6500 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
6501
6502 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
6503 install the built files under the texmf tree.
6504 @end defvr
6505
6506 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
6507 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
6508 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
6509 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
6510
6511 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
6512 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
6513 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
6514 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
6515 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
6516 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
6517 a traditional source release tarball.
6518
6519 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6520 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
6521 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
6522 @end defvr
6523
6524 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
6525 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
6526 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
6527 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
6528 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
6529 script.
6530
6531 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
6532 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
6533 @code{#:python} parameter.
6534 @end defvr
6535
6536 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
6537 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
6538 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
6539 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
6540 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
6541 the package.
6542
6543 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
6544 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
6545 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
6546 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
6547 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
6548 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
6549 @end defvr
6550
6551 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
6552 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
6553 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
6554 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
6555 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
6556 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
6557 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
6558 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
6559 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
6560 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
6561 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
6562 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
6563 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
6564 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
6565
6566 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
6567 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
6568 @end defvr
6569
6570 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
6571 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
6572 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
6573 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
6574 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
6575
6576 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
6577 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
6578 @end defvr
6579
6580 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
6581 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
6582 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
6583 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6584
6585 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
6586 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
6587 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
6588 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
6589 package is installed in its own directory under
6590 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
6591 @end defvr
6592
6593 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
6594 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
6595 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
6596 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
6597 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
6598 locations in the output directory.
6599 @end defvr
6600
6601 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
6602 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
6603 implements the build procedure for packages that use
6604 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
6605
6606 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
6607 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
6608 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
6609 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
6610 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
6611
6612 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6613 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
6614
6615 @table @code
6616
6617 @item configure
6618 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
6619 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @code{--build-type} is always set to
6620 @code{plain} unless something else is specified in @code{#:build-type}.
6621
6622 @item build
6623 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
6624 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
6625
6626 @item check
6627 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
6628 which is @code{"test"} by default.
6629
6630 @item install
6631 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
6632 @end table
6633
6634 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
6635
6636 @table @code
6637
6638 @item fix-runpath
6639 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
6640 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
6641 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
6642 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
6643 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
6644 required for the program to run.
6645
6646 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6647 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6648 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6649
6650 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6651 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6652 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6653 @end table
6654 @end defvr
6655
6656 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
6657 @var{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
6658
6659 @cindex build phases
6660 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6661 following phases changed:
6662
6663 @table @code
6664
6665 @item configure
6666 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
6667 can be used to build the external kernel module.
6668
6669 @item build
6670 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
6671 kernel module.
6672
6673 @item install
6674 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
6675 kernel module.
6676 @end table
6677
6678 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
6679 the module (in the "arguments" form of a package using the
6680 linux-module-build-system, use the key #:linux to specify it).
6681 @end defvr
6682
6683 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
6684 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
6685 implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://nodejs.org,
6686 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
6687 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
6688
6689 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
6690 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
6691 @code{node}.
6692 @end defvr
6693
6694 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
6695 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
6696 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
6697 and does not have a notion of build phases.
6698
6699 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
6700 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
6701
6702 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
6703 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
6704 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
6705 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
6706 @end defvr
6707
6708 @node The Store
6709 @section The Store
6710
6711 @cindex store
6712 @cindex store items
6713 @cindex store paths
6714
6715 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
6716 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
6717 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
6718 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
6719 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
6720 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
6721 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
6722 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
6723 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
6724
6725 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
6726 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
6727 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
6728 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
6729
6730 @quotation Note
6731 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
6732 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
6733 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
6734
6735 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
6736 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
6737 accidental modifications.
6738 @end quotation
6739
6740 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
6741 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
6742 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
6743 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
6744 @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
6745
6746 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
6747 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
6748 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
6749 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
6750 supported URI schemes are:
6751
6752 @table @code
6753 @item file
6754 @itemx unix
6755 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
6756 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
6757 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
6758
6759 @item guix
6760 @cindex daemon, remote access
6761 @cindex remote access to the daemon
6762 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
6763 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
6764 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
6765 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
6766 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
6767
6768 @example
6769 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
6770 @end example
6771
6772 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
6773 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
6774 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
6775
6776 The @code{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
6777 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
6778 @code{--listen}}).
6779
6780 @item ssh
6781 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
6782 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over
6783 SSH@footnote{This feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}).}.
6784 A typical URL might look like this:
6785
6786 @example
6787 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
6788 @end example
6789
6790 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
6791 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
6792 @end table
6793
6794 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
6795
6796 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
6797 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
6798 @quotation Note
6799 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
6800 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
6801 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
6802 @end quotation
6803 @end defvr
6804
6805 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
6806 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
6807 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
6808 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
6809 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
6810
6811 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
6812 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
6813 @end deffn
6814
6815 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
6816 Close the connection to @var{server}.
6817 @end deffn
6818
6819 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
6820 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
6821 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
6822 @end defvr
6823
6824 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
6825 argument.
6826
6827 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
6828 @cindex invalid store items
6829 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
6830 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
6831 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
6832 build.)
6833
6834 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
6835 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6839 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
6840 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
6841 resulting store path.
6842 @end deffn
6843
6844 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
6845 [@var{mode}]
6846 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
6847 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
6848 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
6852 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
6853 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
6854 Store Monad}).
6855
6856 @c FIXME
6857 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
6858
6859 @node Derivations
6860 @section Derivations
6861
6862 @cindex derivations
6863 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
6864 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
6865 following pieces of information:
6866
6867 @itemize
6868 @item
6869 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
6870 directory in the store, but may produce more.
6871
6872 @item
6873 @cindex build-time dependencies
6874 @cindex dependencies, build-time
6875 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
6876 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
6877 etc.)
6878
6879 @item
6880 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
6881
6882 @item
6883 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
6884 to be passed.
6885
6886 @item
6887 A list of environment variables to be defined.
6888
6889 @end itemize
6890
6891 @cindex derivation path
6892 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
6893 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
6894 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
6895 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
6896 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
6897 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
6898 Store}).
6899
6900 @cindex fixed-output derivations
6901 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
6902 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
6903 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
6904 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
6905 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
6906 method and tools being used.
6907
6908 @cindex references
6909 @cindex run-time dependencies
6910 @cindex dependencies, run-time
6911 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
6912 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
6913 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
6914 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
6915 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
6916 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
6917
6918 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
6919 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
6920 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
6921 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
6922
6923 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
6924 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6925 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
6926 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
6927 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6928 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
6929 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
6930 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
6931 @code{<derivation>} object.
6932
6933 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
6934 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
6935 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
6936 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
6937 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
6938 containing this output.
6939
6940 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
6941 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
6942 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
6943 a simple text format.
6944
6945 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
6946 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
6947 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
6948 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
6949
6950 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
6951 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
6952 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
6953 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
6954 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
6955 derivations that download files.
6956
6957 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
6958 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
6959 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
6960 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
6961
6962 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
6963 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
6964 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
6965 host CPU instruction set.
6966
6967 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
6968 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
6969 @end deffn
6970
6971 @noindent
6972 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
6973 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
6974 to a Bash executable in the store:
6975
6976 @lisp
6977 (use-modules (guix utils)
6978 (guix store)
6979 (guix derivations))
6980
6981 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
6982 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
6983 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
6984 (derivation store "foo"
6985 bash `("-e" ,builder)
6986 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
6987 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
6988 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
6989 @end lisp
6990
6991 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
6992 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
6993 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
6994 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6995 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
6996
6997 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
6998 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
6999 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
7000 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
7001
7002 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
7003 @var{name} @var{exp} @
7004 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
7005 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7006 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7007 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7008 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7009 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7010 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
7011 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
7012 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
7013 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
7014 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
7015 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
7016 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
7017 gnu-build-system))}.
7018
7019 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
7020 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
7021 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
7022 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
7023 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
7024 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
7025 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
7026
7027 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
7028 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
7029 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
7030
7031 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
7032 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
7033 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
7034 @var{substitutable?}.
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @noindent
7038 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
7039 containing one file:
7040
7041 @lisp
7042 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
7043 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
7044 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
7045 (lambda (p)
7046 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
7047 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
7048
7049 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
7050 @end lisp
7051
7052
7053 @node The Store Monad
7054 @section The Store Monad
7055
7056 @cindex monad
7057
7058 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
7059 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
7060 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
7061 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
7062
7063 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
7064 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
7065 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
7066 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
7067 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
7068
7069 @cindex monadic values
7070 @cindex monadic functions
7071 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
7072 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
7073 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
7074 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
7075 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
7076 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
7077 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
7078 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
7079 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
7080
7081 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
7082
7083 @lisp
7084 (define (sh-symlink store)
7085 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
7086 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
7087 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
7088 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
7089 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
7090 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
7091 @end lisp
7092
7093 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
7094 as a monadic function:
7095
7096 @lisp
7097 (define (sh-symlink)
7098 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
7099 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
7100 (gexp->derivation "sh"
7101 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
7102 #$output))))
7103 @end lisp
7104
7105 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
7106 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
7107 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
7108 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
7109 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
7110
7111 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
7112 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
7113 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
7114
7115 @lisp
7116 (define (sh-symlink)
7117 (gexp->derivation "sh"
7118 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
7119 #$output)))
7120 @end lisp
7121
7122 @c See
7123 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
7124 @c for the funny quote.
7125 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
7126 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
7127 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
7128 @code{run-with-store}:
7129
7130 @lisp
7131 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
7132 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
7133 @end lisp
7134
7135 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
7136 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
7137 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
7138 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
7139
7140 @example
7141 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
7142 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
7143 @end example
7144
7145 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
7146 automatically run through the store:
7147
7148 @example
7149 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
7150 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
7151 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
7152 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
7153 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
7154 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
7155 scheme@@(guile-user)>
7156 @end example
7157
7158 @noindent
7159 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
7160 @code{store-monad} REPL.
7161
7162 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
7163 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
7164
7165 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
7166 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
7167 in @var{monad}.
7168 @end deffn
7169
7170 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
7171 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
7172 @end deffn
7173
7174 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
7175 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
7176 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
7177 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
7178 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
7179 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
7180 in this example:
7181
7182 @lisp
7183 (run-with-state
7184 (with-monad %state-monad
7185 (>>= (return 1)
7186 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
7187 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
7188 'some-state)
7189
7190 @result{} 4
7191 @result{} some-state
7192 @end lisp
7193 @end deffn
7194
7195 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
7196 @var{body} ...
7197 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
7198 @var{body} ...
7199 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
7200 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
7201 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
7202 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
7203 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
7204 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
7205 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
7206 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
7207 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
7208 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
7209
7210 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
7211 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
7215 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
7216 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
7217 sequence must be a monadic expression.
7218
7219 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
7220 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
7221 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
7222 @end deffn
7223
7224 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
7225 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
7226 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
7227 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
7228 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
7229 @end deffn
7230
7231 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
7232 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
7233 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
7234 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
7235 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
7236 @end deffn
7237
7238 @cindex state monad
7239 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
7240 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
7241 monadic procedure calls.
7242
7243 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
7244 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
7245 the state that is threaded.
7246
7247 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
7248 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
7249 increments the current state value:
7250
7251 @lisp
7252 (define (square x)
7253 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
7254 (mbegin %state-monad
7255 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
7256 (return (* x x)))))
7257
7258 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
7259 @result{} (0 1 4)
7260 @result{} 3
7261 @end lisp
7262
7263 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
7264 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
7265 @end defvr
7266
7267 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
7268 Return the current state as a monadic value.
7269 @end deffn
7270
7271 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
7272 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
7273 monadic value.
7274 @end deffn
7275
7276 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
7277 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
7278 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
7279 @end deffn
7280
7281 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
7282 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
7283 The state is assumed to be a list.
7284 @end deffn
7285
7286 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
7287 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
7288 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
7289 @end deffn
7290
7291 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
7292 store)} module, is as follows.
7293
7294 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
7295 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
7296
7297 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
7298 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
7299 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
7300 @end defvr
7301
7302 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
7303 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
7304 open store connection.
7305 @end deffn
7306
7307 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
7308 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7309 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
7310 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7311 @end deffn
7312
7313 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
7314 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7315 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
7316 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7320 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
7321 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
7322 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
7323 @var{name} is omitted.
7324
7325 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
7326 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
7327 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
7328
7329 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7330 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7331 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7332 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7333
7334 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
7335
7336 @lisp
7337 (run-with-store (open-connection)
7338 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
7339 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
7340 (return (list a b))))
7341
7342 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
7343 @end lisp
7344
7345 @end deffn
7346
7347 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
7348 monadic procedures:
7349
7350 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
7351 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
7352 [#:output "out"]
7353 Return as a monadic
7354 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
7355 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
7356 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
7357 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
7358 @end deffn
7359
7360 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
7361 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
7362 @var{target} [@var{system}]
7363 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
7364 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7365 @end deffn
7366
7367
7368 @node G-Expressions
7369 @section G-Expressions
7370
7371 @cindex G-expression
7372 @cindex build code quoting
7373 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
7374 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
7375 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
7376 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
7377 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
7378
7379 @cindex strata of code
7380 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
7381 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
7382 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
7383 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
7384 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
7385 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
7386 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
7387 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
7388 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
7389 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
7390 @command{make}, etc.
7391
7392 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
7393 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
7394 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
7395 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
7396 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
7397 expressions.
7398
7399 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
7400 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
7401 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
7402 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
7403 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
7404 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
7405 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
7406 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
7407
7408 @itemize
7409 @item
7410 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
7411 processes.
7412
7413 @item
7414 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
7415 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
7416 introduced.
7417
7418 @item
7419 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
7420 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
7421 processes that use them.
7422 @end itemize
7423
7424 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7425 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
7426 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
7427 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
7428 such that these objects can also be inserted
7429 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
7430 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
7431 add files to the store and to refer to them in
7432 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
7433 below.)
7434
7435 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
7436
7437 @lisp
7438 (define build-exp
7439 #~(begin
7440 (mkdir #$output)
7441 (chdir #$output)
7442 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
7443 "list-files")))
7444 @end lisp
7445
7446 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
7447 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
7448 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
7449
7450 @lisp
7451 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
7452 @end lisp
7453
7454 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
7455 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
7456 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
7457 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
7458 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
7459 output of the derivation.
7460
7461 @cindex cross compilation
7462 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
7463 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
7464 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
7465 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
7466 native package build:
7467
7468 @lisp
7469 (gexp->derivation "vi"
7470 #~(begin
7471 (mkdir #$output)
7472 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
7473 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
7474 "-s"
7475 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
7476 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
7477 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
7478 @end lisp
7479
7480 @noindent
7481 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
7482 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
7483 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
7484
7485 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
7486 @findex with-imported-modules
7487 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
7488 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
7489 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
7490 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
7491
7492 @lisp
7493 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
7494 #~(begin
7495 (use-modules (guix build utils))
7496 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
7497 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
7498 #~(begin
7499 #$build
7500 (display "success!\n")
7501 #t)))
7502 @end lisp
7503
7504 @noindent
7505 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
7506 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
7507 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
7508
7509 @cindex module closure
7510 @findex source-module-closure
7511 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
7512 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
7513 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
7514 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
7515 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
7516 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
7517
7518 @lisp
7519 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
7520
7521 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
7522 '((guix build utils)
7523 (gnu build vm)))
7524 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
7525 #~(begin
7526 (use-modules (guix build utils)
7527 (gnu build vm))
7528 @dots{})))
7529 @end lisp
7530
7531 @cindex extensions, for gexps
7532 @findex with-extensions
7533 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
7534 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
7535 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
7536 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
7537
7538 @lisp
7539 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
7540
7541 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
7542 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
7543 #~(begin
7544 (use-modules (json))
7545 @dots{})))
7546 @end lisp
7547
7548 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
7549
7550 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
7551 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
7552 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
7553 or more of the following forms:
7554
7555 @table @code
7556 @item #$@var{obj}
7557 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
7558 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
7559 supported types, for example a package or a
7560 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
7561 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
7562
7563 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
7564 objects are substituted similarly.
7565
7566 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
7567 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
7568
7569 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
7570
7571 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
7572 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
7573 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
7574 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
7575 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
7576
7577 @item #+@var{obj}
7578 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
7579 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
7580 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
7581 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
7582 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
7583
7584 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
7585 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
7586 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
7587 output when @var{output} is omitted.
7588
7589 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7590
7591 @item #$@@@var{lst}
7592 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
7593 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
7594 containing list.
7595
7596 @item #+@@@var{lst}
7597 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
7598 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
7599 @var{lst}.
7600
7601 @end table
7602
7603 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
7604 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
7605 @end deffn
7606
7607 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
7608 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
7609 in their execution environment.
7610
7611 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
7612 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
7613 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
7614
7615 @lisp
7616 `((guix build utils)
7617 (guix gcrypt)
7618 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
7619 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
7620 @end lisp
7621
7622 @noindent
7623 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
7624 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
7625
7626 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
7627 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
7628 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
7629 @end deffn
7630
7631 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
7632 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
7633 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
7634 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
7635 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
7636
7637 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
7638 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
7639 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
7640 @var{body}@dots{}.
7641 @end deffn
7642
7643 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
7644 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
7645 @end deffn
7646
7647 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
7648 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
7649 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
7650 information about monads.)
7651
7652 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
7653 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
7654 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7655 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7656 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
7657 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
7658 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7659 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7660 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
7661 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
7662 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
7663 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
7664 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7665 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
7666 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
7667 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
7668 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
7669 to by @var{exp}.
7670
7671 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
7672 Its meaning is to
7673 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
7674 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
7675 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
7676 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
7677 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
7678
7679 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
7680 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
7681
7682 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
7683 applicable.
7684
7685 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
7686 following forms:
7687
7688 @example
7689 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
7690 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
7691 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
7692 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
7693 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
7694 @end example
7695
7696 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
7697 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
7698 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
7699 text format.
7700
7701 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
7702 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
7703 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
7704 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
7705 referenced by the outputs.
7706
7707 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
7708 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
7709
7710 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @cindex file-like objects
7714 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
7715 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
7716 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
7717 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
7718
7719 @lisp
7720 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
7721 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
7722 @end lisp
7723
7724 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
7725 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
7726 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
7727 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
7728 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
7729 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
7730 content is directly passed as a string.
7731
7732 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7733 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
7734 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
7735 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
7736 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
7737 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
7738 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
7739 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
7740 base name of @var{file}.
7741
7742 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
7743 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
7744 permission bits are kept.
7745
7746 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7747 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7748 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7749 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7750
7751 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
7752 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
7753 @end deffn
7754
7755 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
7756 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
7757 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
7758
7759 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
7763 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
7764 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
7765 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
7766 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7767
7768 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
7769 @end deffn
7770
7771 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
7772 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7773 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
7774 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
7775 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
7776 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
7777
7778 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
7779 command:
7780
7781 @lisp
7782 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
7783
7784 (gexp->script "list-files"
7785 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
7786 "ls"))
7787 @end lisp
7788
7789 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
7790 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
7791 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
7792
7793 @example
7794 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
7795 !#
7796 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
7797 @end example
7798 @end deffn
7799
7800 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7801 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
7802 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
7803 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
7804 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
7805
7806 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
7807 @end deffn
7808
7809 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7810 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7811 [#:splice? #f] @
7812 [#:guile (default-guile)]
7813 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
7814 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
7815 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
7816
7817 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
7818 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
7819 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
7820 @var{module-path}.
7821
7822 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
7823 or a subset thereof.
7824 @end deffn
7825
7826 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} [#:splice? #f]
7827 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
7828 @var{exp}.
7829
7830 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
7831 @end deffn
7832
7833 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7834 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
7835 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
7836 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
7837 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
7838 references to all these.
7839
7840 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
7841 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
7842 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
7843 like this:
7844
7845 @lisp
7846 (define (profile.sh)
7847 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
7848 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
7849 (text-file* "profile.sh"
7850 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
7851 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
7852 @end lisp
7853
7854 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
7855 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
7856 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
7857 @end deffn
7858
7859 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7860 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
7861 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
7862 as in:
7863
7864 @lisp
7865 (mixed-text-file "profile"
7866 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
7867 @end lisp
7868
7869 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
7870 @end deffn
7871
7872 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
7873 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
7874 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
7875 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
7876 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
7877
7878 @lisp
7879 (file-union "etc"
7880 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
7881 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
7882 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
7883 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
7884 @end lisp
7885
7886 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
7887 @end deffn
7888
7889 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
7890 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
7891 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
7892
7893 @lisp
7894 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
7895 @end lisp
7896
7897 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
7898 @end deffn
7899
7900 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
7901 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
7902 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
7903 @var{suffix} is a string.
7904
7905 As an example, consider this gexp:
7906
7907 @lisp
7908 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7909 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
7910 "/bin/uname")))
7911 @end lisp
7912
7913 The same effect could be achieved with:
7914
7915 @lisp
7916 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7917 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
7918 "/bin/uname")))
7919 @end lisp
7920
7921 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
7922 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
7923 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
7924 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
7925 @end deffn
7926
7927
7928 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
7929 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
7930 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
7931 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
7932
7933 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7934 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
7935 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
7936 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
7937 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
7938
7939 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
7940 [#:target #f]
7941 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
7942 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
7943 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
7944 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
7945 @end deffn
7946
7947 @node Invoking guix repl
7948 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
7949
7950 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop
7951 The @command{guix repl} command spawns a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop}
7952 (REPL) for interactive programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
7953 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
7954 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
7955 dependencies are available in the search path. You can use it this way:
7956
7957 @example
7958 $ guix repl
7959 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
7960 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
7961 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
7962 @end example
7963
7964 @cindex inferiors
7965 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
7966 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
7967 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
7968 of Guix.
7969
7970 The available options are as follows:
7971
7972 @table @code
7973 @item --type=@var{type}
7974 @itemx -t @var{type}
7975 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
7976
7977 @table @code
7978 @item guile
7979 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
7980 @item machine
7981 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
7982 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
7983 @end table
7984
7985 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
7986 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
7987 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
7988 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
7989
7990 @table @code
7991 @item --listen=tcp:37146
7992 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
7993
7994 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
7995 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
7996 @end table
7997 @end table
7998
7999 @c *********************************************************************
8000 @node Utilities
8001 @chapter Utilities
8002
8003 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
8004 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
8005 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
8006 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
8007
8008 @menu
8009 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
8010 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
8011 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
8012 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
8013 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
8014 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
8015 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
8016 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
8017 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
8018 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
8019 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
8020 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
8021 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
8022 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
8023 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
8024 @end menu
8025
8026 @node Invoking guix build
8027 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
8028
8029 @cindex package building
8030 @cindex @command{guix build}
8031 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
8032 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
8033 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
8034 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
8035 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
8036
8037 The general syntax is:
8038
8039 @example
8040 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
8041 @end example
8042
8043 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
8044 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
8045 resulting directories:
8046
8047 @example
8048 guix build emacs guile
8049 @end example
8050
8051 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
8052
8053 @example
8054 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
8055 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
8056 @end example
8057
8058 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
8059 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
8060 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
8061 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
8062 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
8063 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8064
8065 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
8066 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
8067 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
8068 needed.
8069
8070 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
8071 described in the subsections below.
8072
8073 @menu
8074 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
8075 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
8076 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
8077 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
8078 @end menu
8079
8080 @node Common Build Options
8081 @subsection Common Build Options
8082
8083 A number of options that control the build process are common to
8084 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
8085 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
8086 following:
8087
8088 @table @code
8089
8090 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
8091 @itemx -L @var{directory}
8092 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
8093 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8094
8095 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
8096 the command-line tools.
8097
8098 @item --keep-failed
8099 @itemx -K
8100 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
8101 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
8102 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
8103 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
8104 build issues.
8105
8106 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
8107 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
8108 Store, the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
8109
8110 @item --keep-going
8111 @itemx -k
8112 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
8113 all the builds have either completed or failed.
8114
8115 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
8116 derivations has failed.
8117
8118 @item --dry-run
8119 @itemx -n
8120 Do not build the derivations.
8121
8122 @anchor{fallback-option}
8123 @item --fallback
8124 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
8125 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
8126
8127 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
8128 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
8129 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
8130 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
8131 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
8132
8133 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
8134 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
8135 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8136
8137 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
8138 disabled.
8139
8140 @item --no-substitutes
8141 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
8142 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
8143 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8144
8145 @item --no-grafts
8146 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
8147 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8148 information on grafts.
8149
8150 @item --rounds=@var{n}
8151 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
8152 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
8153
8154 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
8155 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
8156 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
8157 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
8158
8159 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
8160 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
8161 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
8162 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
8163 the two results.
8164
8165 @item --no-offload
8166 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
8167 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
8168 builds to remote machines.
8169
8170 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
8171 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
8172 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
8173
8174 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
8175 guix-daemon, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
8176
8177 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
8178 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
8179 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
8180
8181 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
8182 guix-daemon, @code{--timeout}}).
8183
8184 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
8185 @c most programs honor it.
8186 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
8187 @cindex build logs, verbosity
8188 @item -v @var{level}
8189 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
8190 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
8191 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
8192 output on standard error.
8193
8194 @item --cores=@var{n}
8195 @itemx -c @var{n}
8196 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
8197 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
8198
8199 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
8200 @itemx -M @var{n}
8201 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
8202 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
8203 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
8204
8205 @item --debug=@var{level}
8206 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
8207 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
8208 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
8209
8210 @end table
8211
8212 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
8213 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
8214 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
8215 derivations)} module.
8216
8217 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
8218 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
8219 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
8220
8221 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
8222 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
8223 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
8224 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
8225 below:
8226
8227 @example
8228 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
8229 @end example
8230
8231 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
8232 the parsed command-line options.
8233 @end defvr
8234
8235
8236 @node Package Transformation Options
8237 @subsection Package Transformation Options
8238
8239 @cindex package variants
8240 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
8241 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
8242 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
8243 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
8244 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
8245 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
8246 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8247
8248 @table @code
8249
8250 @item --with-source=@var{source}
8251 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
8252 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
8253 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
8254 its version number.
8255 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
8256 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
8257
8258 When @var{package} is omitted,
8259 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
8260 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
8261 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
8262 package is @code{guile}.
8263
8264 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
8265 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
8266
8267 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
8268 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
8269 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
8270 the @code{ed} package:
8271
8272 @example
8273 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
8274 @end example
8275
8276 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
8277 candidates:
8278
8279 @example
8280 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
8281 @end example
8282
8283 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
8284
8285 @example
8286 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
8287 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
8288 @end example
8289
8290 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8291 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
8292 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
8293 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
8294 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
8295
8296 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
8297 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
8298 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
8299
8300 @example
8301 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
8302 @end example
8303
8304 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
8305 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
8306 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
8307
8308 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
8309 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
8310
8311 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8312 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
8313 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
8314 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
8315 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8316 information on grafts.
8317
8318 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
8319 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
8320 they currently refer to:
8321
8322 @example
8323 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
8324 @end example
8325
8326 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
8327 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
8328 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
8329 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
8330 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
8331 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
8332 care!
8333
8334 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
8335 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
8336 @cindex latest commit, building
8337 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
8338 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
8339 recursively.
8340
8341 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
8342 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
8343
8344 @example
8345 guix build python-numpy \
8346 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
8347 @end example
8348
8349 This option can also be combined with @code{--with-branch} or
8350 @code{--with-commit} (see below).
8351
8352 @cindex continuous integration
8353 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
8354 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
8355 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
8356 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
8357 integration (CI).
8358
8359 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
8360 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
8361 in a while to save disk space.
8362
8363 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
8364 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
8365 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
8366 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
8367 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
8368 @code{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
8369
8370 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
8371 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
8372 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
8373 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
8374
8375 @example
8376 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
8377 @end example
8378
8379 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
8380 This is similar to @code{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
8381 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
8382 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
8383 @end table
8384
8385 @node Additional Build Options
8386 @subsection Additional Build Options
8387
8388 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
8389 build}.
8390
8391 @table @code
8392
8393 @item --quiet
8394 @itemx -q
8395 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
8396 @code{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
8397 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
8398
8399 @item --file=@var{file}
8400 @itemx -f @var{file}
8401 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
8402 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
8403
8404 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
8405 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
8406
8407 @lisp
8408 @include package-hello.scm
8409 @end lisp
8410
8411 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8412 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8413 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
8414
8415 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
8416 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
8417 version 1.8 of Guile.
8418
8419 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
8420 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
8421 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8422
8423 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
8424 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
8425 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
8426
8427 @item --source
8428 @itemx -S
8429 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
8430 themselves.
8431
8432 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
8433 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
8434 source tarball.
8435
8436 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
8437 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
8438 Packages}).
8439
8440 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
8441 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
8442 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
8443 the packages.
8444
8445 @item --sources
8446 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
8447 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
8448 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
8449 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
8450 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
8451 optional argument values:
8452
8453 @table @code
8454 @item package
8455 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
8456 as the @code{--source} option.
8457
8458 @item all
8459 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
8460 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
8461
8462 @example
8463 $ guix build --sources tzdata
8464 The following derivations will be built:
8465 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
8466 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8467 @end example
8468
8469 @item transitive
8470 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
8471 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
8472 prefetch package source for later offline building.
8473
8474 @example
8475 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
8476 The following derivations will be built:
8477 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8478 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
8479 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
8480 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
8481 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
8482 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
8483 @dots{}
8484 @end example
8485
8486 @end table
8487
8488 @item --system=@var{system}
8489 @itemx -s @var{system}
8490 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
8491 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
8492 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
8493 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
8494
8495 @quotation Note
8496 The @code{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
8497 be confused with cross-compilation. See @code{--target} below for
8498 information on cross-compilation.
8499 @end quotation
8500
8501 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
8502 different personalities. For instance, passing
8503 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
8504 @code{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows you
8505 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
8506
8507 @quotation Note
8508 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
8509 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
8510 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
8511 @end quotation
8512
8513 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
8514 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
8515 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
8516 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
8517
8518 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
8519 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
8520 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
8521
8522 @item --target=@var{triplet}
8523 @cindex cross-compilation
8524 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
8525 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
8526 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
8527
8528 @anchor{build-check}
8529 @item --check
8530 @cindex determinism, checking
8531 @cindex reproducibility, checking
8532 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
8533 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
8534 identical.
8535
8536 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
8537 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
8538 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
8539 background information and tools.
8540
8541 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
8542 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
8543 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
8544
8545 @item --repair
8546 @cindex repairing store items
8547 @cindex corruption, recovering from
8548 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
8549 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
8550
8551 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
8552
8553 @item --derivations
8554 @itemx -d
8555 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
8556 packages.
8557
8558 @item --root=@var{file}
8559 @itemx -r @var{file}
8560 @cindex GC roots, adding
8561 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
8562 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
8563 collector root.
8564
8565 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
8566 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
8567 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
8568 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
8569 more on GC roots.
8570
8571 @item --log-file
8572 @cindex build logs, access
8573 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
8574 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
8575 missing.
8576
8577 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
8578 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
8579
8580 @example
8581 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
8582 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
8583 guix build --log-file guile
8584 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
8585 @end example
8586
8587 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
8588 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
8589 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
8590
8591 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
8592 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
8593
8594 @example
8595 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
8596 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
8597 @end example
8598
8599 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
8600 @end table
8601
8602 @node Debugging Build Failures
8603 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
8604
8605 @cindex build failures, debugging
8606 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
8607 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
8608 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
8609 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
8610 build daemon uses.
8611
8612 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
8613 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
8614 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
8615 @code{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--keep-failed}}).
8616
8617 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
8618 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
8619 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
8620 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
8621 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
8622
8623 @example
8624 $ guix build foo -K
8625 @dots{} @i{build fails}
8626 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8627 $ source ./environment-variables
8628 $ cd foo-1.2
8629 @end example
8630
8631 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
8632 troubleshoot your build process.
8633
8634 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
8635 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
8636 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
8637 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
8638 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
8639
8640 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
8641 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
8642
8643 @example
8644 $ guix build -K foo
8645 @dots{}
8646 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8647 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
8648 [env]# source ./environment-variables
8649 [env]# cd foo-1.2
8650 @end example
8651
8652 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
8653 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
8654 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
8655 the container, which would may find handy while debugging. The
8656 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
8657 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
8658 info on grafts).
8659
8660 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
8661 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
8662
8663 @example
8664 [env]# rm /bin/sh
8665 @end example
8666
8667 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
8668 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
8669
8670 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
8671 can run:
8672
8673 @example
8674 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
8675 @end example
8676
8677 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
8678 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
8679 similar to the one the daemon uses.
8680
8681
8682 @node Invoking guix edit
8683 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
8684
8685 @cindex @command{guix edit}
8686 @cindex package definition, editing
8687 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
8688 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
8689 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
8690 For instance:
8691
8692 @example
8693 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
8694 @end example
8695
8696 @noindent
8697 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
8698 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
8699 and that of Vim.
8700
8701 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
8702 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
8703 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
8704 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
8705 for packages currently in the store.
8706
8707
8708 @node Invoking guix download
8709 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
8710
8711 @cindex @command{guix download}
8712 @cindex downloading package sources
8713 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
8714 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
8715 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
8716 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
8717 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
8718 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
8719
8720 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
8721 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
8722 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
8723 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
8724 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
8725 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
8726
8727 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
8728 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
8729 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
8730 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
8731 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
8732 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
8733 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
8734
8735 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
8736 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
8737 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
8738 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
8739
8740 The following options are available:
8741
8742 @table @code
8743 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8744 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8745 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
8746 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
8747
8748 @item --no-check-certificate
8749 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
8750
8751 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
8752 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
8753 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
8754
8755 @item --output=@var{file}
8756 @itemx -o @var{file}
8757 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
8758 store.
8759 @end table
8760
8761 @node Invoking guix hash
8762 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
8763
8764 @cindex @command{guix hash}
8765 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
8766 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
8767 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
8768 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8769
8770 The general syntax is:
8771
8772 @example
8773 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
8774 @end example
8775
8776 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
8777 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
8778 following options:
8779
8780 @table @code
8781
8782 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8783 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8784 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
8785
8786 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
8787 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
8788
8789 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
8790 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
8791 in the definitions of packages.
8792
8793 @item --recursive
8794 @itemx -r
8795 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
8796
8797 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
8798 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
8799 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
8800 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
8801 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
8802 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
8803 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
8804 @c it exists.
8805
8806 @item --exclude-vcs
8807 @itemx -x
8808 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
8809 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
8810
8811 @vindex git-fetch
8812 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
8813 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
8814 Reference}):
8815
8816 @example
8817 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
8818 $ cd foo
8819 $ guix hash -rx .
8820 @end example
8821 @end table
8822
8823 @node Invoking guix import
8824 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
8825
8826 @cindex importing packages
8827 @cindex package import
8828 @cindex package conversion
8829 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
8830 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
8831 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
8832 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
8833 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
8834 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
8835 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8836
8837 The general syntax is:
8838
8839 @example
8840 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
8841 @end example
8842
8843 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
8844 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
8845 options specific to @var{importer}.
8846
8847 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
8848 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
8849 gnupg} if needed.
8850
8851 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
8852
8853 @table @code
8854 @item gnu
8855 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
8856 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
8857 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
8858
8859 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
8860 license needs to be figured out manually.
8861
8862 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
8863 GNU@tie{}Hello:
8864
8865 @example
8866 guix import gnu hello
8867 @end example
8868
8869 Specific command-line options are:
8870
8871 @table @code
8872 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
8873 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
8874 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
8875 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
8876 @end table
8877
8878 @item pypi
8879 @cindex pypi
8880 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
8881 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
8882 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
8883 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
8884 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
8885 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
8886
8887 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
8888 package:
8889
8890 @example
8891 guix import pypi itsdangerous
8892 @end example
8893
8894 @table @code
8895 @item --recursive
8896 @itemx -r
8897 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8898 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8899 in Guix.
8900 @end table
8901
8902 @item gem
8903 @cindex gem
8904 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
8905 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
8906 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
8907 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
8908 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
8909 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
8910 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
8911 as an exercise to the packager.
8912
8913 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
8914
8915 @example
8916 guix import gem rails
8917 @end example
8918
8919 @table @code
8920 @item --recursive
8921 @itemx -r
8922 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8923 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8924 in Guix.
8925 @end table
8926
8927 @item cpan
8928 @cindex CPAN
8929 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
8930 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
8931 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
8932 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
8933 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
8934 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
8935 list of dependencies.
8936
8937 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
8938 Perl module:
8939
8940 @example
8941 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
8942 @end example
8943
8944 @item cran
8945 @cindex CRAN
8946 @cindex Bioconductor
8947 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
8948 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
8949 statistical and graphical environment}.
8950
8951 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
8952
8953 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
8954 R package:
8955
8956 @example
8957 guix import cran Cairo
8958 @end example
8959
8960 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
8961 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
8962 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
8963
8964 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
8965 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
8966 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
8967 genomic data in bioinformatics.
8968
8969 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
8970 package archive.
8971
8972 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
8973 R package:
8974
8975 @example
8976 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
8977 @end example
8978
8979 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
8980 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
8981 @code{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
8982
8983 @example
8984 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
8985 @end example
8986
8987 @item texlive
8988 @cindex TeX Live
8989 @cindex CTAN
8990 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
8991 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
8992 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
8993
8994 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
8995 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
8996 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
8997 versioned archives.
8998
8999 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
9000 TeX package:
9001
9002 @example
9003 guix import texlive fontspec
9004 @end example
9005
9006 When @code{--archive=DIRECTORY} is added, the source code is downloaded
9007 not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the @file{texmf-dist/source}
9008 tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from the specified sibling
9009 directory under the same root.
9010
9011 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
9012 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
9013 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
9014
9015 @example
9016 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
9017 @end example
9018
9019 @item json
9020 @cindex JSON, import
9021 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
9022 example package definition in JSON format:
9023
9024 @example
9025 @{
9026 "name": "hello",
9027 "version": "2.10",
9028 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
9029 "build-system": "gnu",
9030 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
9031 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
9032 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
9033 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
9034 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
9035 @}
9036 @end example
9037
9038 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
9039 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
9040 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
9041 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
9042
9043 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
9044 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
9045
9046 @example
9047 @{
9048 @dots{}
9049 "source": @{
9050 "method": "url-fetch",
9051 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
9052 "sha256": @{
9053 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
9054 @}
9055 @}
9056 @dots{}
9057 @}
9058 @end example
9059
9060 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
9061 and outputs a package expression:
9062
9063 @example
9064 guix import json hello.json
9065 @end example
9066
9067 @item nix
9068 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
9069 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
9070 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
9071 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
9072 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
9073 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
9074 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
9075 package definition.
9076
9077 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
9078 by their canonical upstream variant.
9079
9080 Usually, you will first need to do:
9081
9082 @example
9083 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
9084 @end example
9085
9086 @noindent
9087 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
9088
9089 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
9090 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
9091 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
9092
9093 @example
9094 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
9095 @end example
9096
9097 @item hackage
9098 @cindex hackage
9099 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
9100 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
9101 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
9102 dependencies.
9103
9104 Specific command-line options are:
9105
9106 @table @code
9107 @item --stdin
9108 @itemx -s
9109 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
9110 @item --no-test-dependencies
9111 @itemx -t
9112 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
9113 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
9114 @itemx -e @var{alist}
9115 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
9116 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
9117 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
9118 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
9119 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
9120 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
9121 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
9122 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
9123 @item --recursive
9124 @itemx -r
9125 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9126 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9127 in Guix.
9128 @end table
9129
9130 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
9131 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
9132 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
9133
9134 @example
9135 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
9136 @end example
9137
9138 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
9139 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
9140
9141 @example
9142 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
9143 @end example
9144
9145 @item stackage
9146 @cindex stackage
9147 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
9148 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
9149 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
9150 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
9151 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
9152 GHC compiler used by Guix.
9153
9154 Specific command-line options are:
9155
9156 @table @code
9157 @item --no-test-dependencies
9158 @itemx -t
9159 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
9160 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
9161 @itemx -l @var{version}
9162 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
9163 release is used.
9164 @item --recursive
9165 @itemx -r
9166 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9167 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9168 in Guix.
9169 @end table
9170
9171 The command below imports metadata for the @code{HTTP} Haskell package
9172 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
9173
9174 @example
9175 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
9176 @end example
9177
9178 @item elpa
9179 @cindex elpa
9180 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
9181 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
9182
9183 Specific command-line options are:
9184
9185 @table @code
9186 @item --archive=@var{repo}
9187 @itemx -a @var{repo}
9188 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
9189 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
9190 are:
9191 @itemize -
9192 @item
9193 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
9194 identifier. This is the default.
9195
9196 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
9197 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
9198 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
9199 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
9200 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
9201
9202 @item
9203 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
9204 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
9205
9206 @item
9207 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
9208 identifier.
9209 @end itemize
9210
9211 @item --recursive
9212 @itemx -r
9213 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9214 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9215 in Guix.
9216 @end table
9217
9218 @item crate
9219 @cindex crate
9220 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
9221 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
9222
9223 @example
9224 guix import crate blake2-rfc
9225 @end example
9226
9227 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
9228
9229 @example
9230 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
9231 @end example
9232
9233 Additional options include:
9234
9235 @table @code
9236 @item --recursive
9237 @itemx -r
9238 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9239 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9240 in Guix.
9241 @end table
9242
9243 @item opam
9244 @cindex OPAM
9245 @cindex OCaml
9246 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
9247 repository used by the OCaml community.
9248 @end table
9249
9250 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
9251 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
9252 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
9253
9254 @node Invoking guix refresh
9255 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
9256
9257 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
9258 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
9259 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
9260 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
9261 upstream version, like this:
9262
9263 @example
9264 $ guix refresh
9265 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
9266 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
9267 @end example
9268
9269 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
9270 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
9271
9272 @example
9273 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
9274 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
9275 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
9276 @end example
9277
9278 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
9279 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
9280 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
9281 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
9282 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
9283 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
9284 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
9285
9286 @table @code
9287
9288 @item --recursive
9289 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
9290
9291 @example
9292 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
9293 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
9294 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
9295 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
9296 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
9297 @dots{}
9298 @end example
9299
9300 @end table
9301
9302 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
9303 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
9304 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
9305 to that effect:
9306
9307 @lisp
9308 (define-public network-manager
9309 (package
9310 (name "network-manager")
9311 ;; @dots{}
9312 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
9313 @end lisp
9314
9315 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
9316 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
9317 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
9318 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
9319 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
9320 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
9321 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
9322
9323 When the public
9324 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
9325 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
9326 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
9327 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
9328
9329 The following options are supported:
9330
9331 @table @code
9332
9333 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9334 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9335 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9336
9337 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9338
9339 @example
9340 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
9341 @end example
9342
9343 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
9344 the packages.)
9345
9346 @item --update
9347 @itemx -u
9348 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
9349 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
9350 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
9351
9352 @example
9353 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
9354 @end example
9355
9356 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
9357
9358 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
9359 @itemx -s @var{subset}
9360 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
9361 @code{non-core}.
9362
9363 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
9364 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
9365 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
9366 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
9367 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
9368 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
9369
9370 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
9371 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
9372 inconvenient.
9373
9374 @item --manifest=@var{file}
9375 @itemx -m @var{file}
9376 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
9377 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
9378
9379 @item --type=@var{updater}
9380 @itemx -t @var{updater}
9381 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
9382 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
9383
9384 @table @code
9385 @item gnu
9386 the updater for GNU packages;
9387 @item gnome
9388 the updater for GNOME packages;
9389 @item kde
9390 the updater for KDE packages;
9391 @item xorg
9392 the updater for X.org packages;
9393 @item kernel.org
9394 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
9395 @item elpa
9396 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
9397 @item cran
9398 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
9399 @item bioconductor
9400 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
9401 @item cpan
9402 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
9403 @item pypi
9404 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
9405 @item gem
9406 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
9407 @item github
9408 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
9409 @item hackage
9410 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
9411 @item stackage
9412 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
9413 @item crate
9414 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
9415 @item launchpad
9416 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
9417 @end table
9418
9419 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
9420 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
9421
9422 @example
9423 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
9424 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
9425 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
9426 @end example
9427
9428 @end table
9429
9430 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
9431 names, as in this example:
9432
9433 @example
9434 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
9435 @end example
9436
9437 @noindent
9438 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
9439 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
9440 effect in this case.
9441
9442 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
9443 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
9444 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
9445 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
9446
9447 @table @code
9448
9449 @item --list-updaters
9450 @itemx -L
9451 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
9452
9453 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
9454 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
9455
9456 @item --list-dependent
9457 @itemx -l
9458 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
9459 result of upgrading one or more packages.
9460
9461 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
9462 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
9463 dependents of a package.
9464
9465 @end table
9466
9467 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
9468 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
9469 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
9470
9471 @example
9472 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
9473 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
9474 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
9475 @end example
9476
9477 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
9478 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
9479
9480 @table @code
9481
9482 @item --list-transitive
9483 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
9484
9485 @example
9486 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
9487 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
9488 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
9489 @end example
9490
9491 @end table
9492
9493 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
9494 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
9495
9496 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
9497
9498 @table @code
9499
9500 @item --gpg=@var{command}
9501 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
9502 for in @code{$PATH}.
9503
9504 @item --keyring=@var{file}
9505 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
9506 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
9507 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
9508 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
9509 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
9510
9511 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
9512 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
9513 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
9514 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
9515 @option{--key-download} below.)
9516
9517 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
9518 commands like this one:
9519
9520 @example
9521 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
9522 @end example
9523
9524 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
9525
9526 @example
9527 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
9528 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
9529 @end example
9530
9531 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
9532 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
9533
9534 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9535 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
9536 of:
9537
9538 @table @code
9539 @item always
9540 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
9541 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
9542
9543 @item never
9544 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
9545
9546 @item interactive
9547 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
9548 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
9549 @end table
9550
9551 @item --key-server=@var{host}
9552 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
9553
9554 @end table
9555
9556 The @code{github} updater uses the
9557 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
9558 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
9559 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
9560 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
9561 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
9562 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
9563 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
9564 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
9565 otherwise.
9566
9567
9568 @node Invoking guix lint
9569 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
9570
9571 @cindex @command{guix lint}
9572 @cindex package, checking for errors
9573 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
9574 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
9575 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
9576 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
9577 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
9578
9579 @table @code
9580 @item synopsis
9581 @itemx description
9582 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
9583 descriptions and synopses.
9584
9585 @item inputs-should-be-native
9586 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
9587
9588 @item source
9589 @itemx home-page
9590 @itemx mirror-url
9591 @itemx github-url
9592 @itemx source-file-name
9593 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
9594 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
9595 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
9596 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
9597 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
9598 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
9599
9600 @item source-unstable-tarball
9601 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
9602 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
9603 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
9604
9605 @item archival
9606 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
9607 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
9608 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
9609 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
9610
9611 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
9612 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
9613 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
9614 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
9615 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
9616 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
9617 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
9618
9619 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
9620 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
9621 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
9622 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
9623
9624 Software Heritage
9625 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
9626 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
9627 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
9628 that limit has been reset.
9629
9630 @item cve
9631 @cindex security vulnerabilities
9632 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
9633 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
9634 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
9635 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
9636 NIST}.
9637
9638 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
9639
9640 @itemize
9641 @item
9642 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9643 @item
9644 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9645 @end itemize
9646
9647 @noindent
9648 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
9649 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
9650
9651 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
9652 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
9653 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
9654 that Guix uses, as in this example:
9655
9656 @lisp
9657 (package
9658 (name "grub")
9659 ;; @dots{}
9660 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
9661 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
9662 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
9663 @end lisp
9664
9665 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
9666 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
9667 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
9668 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
9669 declare them as in this example:
9670
9671 @lisp
9672 (package
9673 (name "t1lib")
9674 ;; @dots{}
9675 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
9676 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
9677 "CVE-2011-1553"
9678 "CVE-2011-1554"
9679 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
9680 @end lisp
9681
9682 @item formatting
9683 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
9684 use of tabulations, etc.
9685 @end table
9686
9687 The general syntax is:
9688
9689 @example
9690 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9691 @end example
9692
9693 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
9694 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
9695
9696 @table @code
9697 @item --list-checkers
9698 @itemx -l
9699 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
9700 and exit.
9701
9702 @item --checkers
9703 @itemx -c
9704 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
9705 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
9706
9707 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9708 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9709 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9710 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9711
9712 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9713 the command-line tools.
9714
9715 @end table
9716
9717 @node Invoking guix size
9718 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
9719
9720 @cindex size
9721 @cindex package size
9722 @cindex closure
9723 @cindex @command{guix size}
9724 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
9725 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
9726 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
9727 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
9728 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
9729 @command{guix size} can highlight.
9730
9731 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
9732 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
9733 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
9734 example:
9735
9736 @example
9737 $ guix size coreutils
9738 store item total self
9739 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
9740 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
9741 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
9742 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
9743 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
9744 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
9745 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
9746 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
9747 total: 78.9 MiB
9748 @end example
9749
9750 @cindex closure
9751 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
9752 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
9753 would be returned by:
9754
9755 @example
9756 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
9757 @end example
9758
9759 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
9760 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
9761 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
9762 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
9763 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
9764 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
9765
9766 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
9767 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
9768 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
9769 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
9770 on the system anyway.)
9771
9772 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
9773 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
9774 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
9775 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
9776 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
9777 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
9778 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
9779 Coreutils}).
9780
9781 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
9782 reports information based on the available substitutes
9783 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
9784 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
9785
9786 You can also specify several package names:
9787
9788 @example
9789 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
9790 store item total self
9791 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
9792 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
9793 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
9794 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
9795 @dots{}
9796 total: 102.3 MiB
9797 @end example
9798
9799 @noindent
9800 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
9801 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
9802 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
9803
9804 The available options are:
9805
9806 @table @option
9807
9808 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9809 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
9810 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
9811
9812 @item --sort=@var{key}
9813 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
9814
9815 @table @code
9816 @item self
9817 the size of each item (the default);
9818 @item closure
9819 the total size of the item's closure.
9820 @end table
9821
9822 @item --map-file=@var{file}
9823 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
9824
9825 For the example above, the map looks like this:
9826
9827 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
9828 produced by @command{guix size}}
9829
9830 This option requires that
9831 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
9832 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
9833 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
9834
9835 @item --system=@var{system}
9836 @itemx -s @var{system}
9837 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
9838
9839 @end table
9840
9841 @node Invoking guix graph
9842 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
9843
9844 @cindex DAG
9845 @cindex @command{guix graph}
9846 @cindex package dependencies
9847 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
9848 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
9849 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
9850 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
9851 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
9852 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
9853 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
9854 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
9855 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
9856 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
9857 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language.
9858 The general syntax is:
9859
9860 @example
9861 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9862 @end example
9863
9864 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
9865 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
9866 dependencies:
9867
9868 @example
9869 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9870 @end example
9871
9872 The output looks like this:
9873
9874 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9875
9876 Nice little graph, no?
9877
9878 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
9879 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
9880 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
9881 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
9882 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
9883
9884 @table @code
9885 @item package
9886 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
9887 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
9888 filters out many details.
9889
9890 @item reverse-package
9891 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
9892
9893 @example
9894 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
9895 @end example
9896
9897 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
9898 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
9899 @code{reverse-bag} below.)
9900
9901 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
9902 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
9903 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
9904 @option{--list-dependent}}).
9905
9906 @item bag-emerged
9907 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
9908
9909 For instance, the following command:
9910
9911 @example
9912 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9913 @end example
9914
9915 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
9916
9917 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9918
9919 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
9920 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
9921
9922 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
9923 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
9924 here, for conciseness.
9925
9926 @item bag
9927 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
9928 dependencies.
9929
9930 @item bag-with-origins
9931 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
9932
9933 @item reverse-bag
9934 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
9935 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
9936
9937 @example
9938 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
9939 @end example
9940
9941 @noindent
9942 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
9943 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
9944 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
9945 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
9946
9947 @item derivation
9948 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
9949 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
9950 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
9951 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
9952
9953 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
9954 name instead of a package name, as in:
9955
9956 @example
9957 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
9958 @end example
9959
9960 @item module
9961 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9962 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
9963 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
9964
9965 @example
9966 guix graph -t module guile | dot -Tpdf > module-graph.pdf
9967 @end example
9968 @end table
9969
9970 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
9971 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
9972
9973 @table @code
9974 @item references
9975 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
9976 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9977
9978 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
9979 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
9980
9981 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
9982 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
9983 (which can be big!):
9984
9985 @example
9986 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
9987 @end example
9988
9989 @item referrers
9990 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
9991 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9992
9993 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
9994 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
9995 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
9996 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
9997 to it.
9998
9999 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
10000 collected.
10001
10002 @end table
10003
10004 The available options are the following:
10005
10006 @table @option
10007 @item --type=@var{type}
10008 @itemx -t @var{type}
10009 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
10010 the values listed above.
10011
10012 @item --list-types
10013 List the supported graph types.
10014
10015 @item --backend=@var{backend}
10016 @itemx -b @var{backend}
10017 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
10018
10019 @item --list-backends
10020 List the supported graph backends.
10021
10022 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
10023
10024 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10025 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10026 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
10027
10028 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
10029
10030 @example
10031 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
10032 @end example
10033
10034 @item --system=@var{system}
10035 @itemx -s @var{system}
10036 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
10037
10038 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
10039 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
10040 @end table
10041
10042 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
10043 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
10044 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
10045 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
10046 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
10047 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
10048
10049 @example
10050 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
10051 @end example
10052
10053 So many possibilities, so much fun!
10054
10055 @node Invoking guix publish
10056 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
10057
10058 @cindex @command{guix publish}
10059 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
10060 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
10061 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10062
10063 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
10064 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
10065 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
10066 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
10067 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
10068
10069 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
10070 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
10071 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
10072 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
10073 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
10074
10075 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
10076 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
10077 guix archive}).
10078
10079 The general syntax is:
10080
10081 @example
10082 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
10083 @end example
10084
10085 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
10086 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
10087
10088 @example
10089 guix publish
10090 @end example
10091
10092 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
10093 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
10094
10095 @example
10096 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
10097 @end example
10098
10099 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
10100 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
10101 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
10102 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
10103 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
10104 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
10105 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
10106
10107 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
10108 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
10109 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
10110 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
10111 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
10112 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
10113
10114 @example
10115 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
10116 @end example
10117
10118 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
10119 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
10120
10121 @cindex build logs, publication
10122 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
10123
10124 @example
10125 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
10126 @end example
10127
10128 @noindent
10129 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
10130 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
10131 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
10132 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
10133 running @command{guix-daemon} with @code{--log-compression=gzip} since
10134 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
10135 bzip2 compression.
10136
10137 The following options are available:
10138
10139 @table @code
10140 @item --port=@var{port}
10141 @itemx -p @var{port}
10142 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
10143
10144 @item --listen=@var{host}
10145 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
10146 accept connections from any interface.
10147
10148 @item --user=@var{user}
10149 @itemx -u @var{user}
10150 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
10151 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
10152
10153 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
10154 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
10155 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
10156 one of @code{lzip} and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is omitted, @code{gzip}
10157 is used.
10158
10159 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
10160 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
10161 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
10162
10163 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a small
10164 increase in CPU usage; see
10165 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip Web
10166 page}.
10167
10168 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
10169 the compressed streams are not
10170 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
10171 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
10172 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
10173 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
10174 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
10175 to its responses.
10176
10177 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
10178 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
10179 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
10180 the one they support.
10181
10182 @item --cache=@var{directory}
10183 @itemx -c @var{directory}
10184 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
10185 and only serve archives that are in cache.
10186
10187 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
10188 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
10189 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
10190 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
10191 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
10192 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
10193 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
10194
10195 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
10196 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
10197 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
10198 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
10199 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
10200 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
10201 the best possible bandwidth.
10202
10203 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
10204 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
10205 @option{--workers} below.
10206
10207 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
10208 when they have expired.
10209
10210 @item --workers=@var{N}
10211 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
10212 threads to ``bake'' archives.
10213
10214 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
10215 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
10216 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
10217 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
10218
10219 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
10220 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
10221 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
10222 for as long as @var{ttl}.
10223
10224 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
10225 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
10226 item in the store, may be deleted.
10227
10228 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
10229 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
10230 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
10231
10232 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
10233 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
10234 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
10235
10236 @item --public-key=@var{file}
10237 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
10238 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
10239 the store items being published.
10240
10241 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
10242 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
10243 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
10244 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
10245 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
10246 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
10247
10248 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
10249 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
10250 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
10251 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
10252 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
10253 @end table
10254
10255 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
10256 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
10257 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
10258 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
10259
10260 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
10261 instructions:
10262
10263 @itemize
10264 @item
10265 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
10266
10267 @example
10268 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
10269 /etc/systemd/system/
10270 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
10271 @end example
10272
10273 @item
10274 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
10275
10276 @example
10277 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
10278 # start guix-publish
10279 @end example
10280
10281 @item
10282 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
10283 @end itemize
10284
10285 @node Invoking guix challenge
10286 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
10287
10288 @cindex reproducible builds
10289 @cindex verifiable builds
10290 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
10291 @cindex challenge
10292 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
10293 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
10294 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
10295 answer.
10296
10297 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
10298 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
10299 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
10300 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
10301 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
10302 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
10303 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
10304
10305 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
10306 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
10307 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
10308 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
10309 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
10310 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
10311 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
10312 any given store item.
10313
10314 The command output looks like this:
10315
10316 @smallexample
10317 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
10318 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
10319 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10320 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
10321 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
10322 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
10323 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
10324 differing files:
10325 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
10326 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
10327
10328 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
10329 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
10330 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
10331 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
10332 differing file:
10333 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
10334
10335 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
10336 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
10337 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
10338 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
10339 differing file:
10340 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
10341
10342 @dots{}
10343
10344 6,406 store items were analyzed:
10345 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
10346 - 525 (8.2%) differed
10347 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
10348 @end smallexample
10349
10350 @noindent
10351 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
10352 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
10353 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
10354 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
10355 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
10356
10357 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
10358 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
10359 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
10360 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
10361 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
10362 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
10363 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
10364 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
10365 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
10366 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
10367 more information.
10368
10369 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
10370 to run:
10371
10372 @example
10373 guix challenge git \
10374 --diff=diffoscope \
10375 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
10376 @end example
10377
10378 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
10379 information about files that differ.
10380
10381 Alternately, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
10382 archive}):
10383
10384 @example
10385 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
10386 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
10387 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
10388 @end example
10389
10390 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
10391 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
10392 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
10393 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
10394 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
10395 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
10396 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
10397
10398 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
10399 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
10400 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
10401 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
10402 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
10403 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
10404 the problem.
10405
10406 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
10407 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
10408 same build result as you did with:
10409
10410 @example
10411 $ guix challenge @var{package}
10412 @end example
10413
10414 @noindent
10415 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
10416 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
10417
10418 The general syntax is:
10419
10420 @example
10421 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10422 @end example
10423
10424 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
10425 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
10426 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
10427 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
10428 errors.)
10429
10430 The one option that matters is:
10431
10432 @table @code
10433
10434 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10435 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10436 URLs to compare to.
10437
10438 @item --diff=@var{mode}
10439 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
10440
10441 @table @asis
10442 @item @code{simple} (the default)
10443 Show the list of files that differ.
10444
10445 @item @code{diffoscope}
10446 @itemx @var{command}
10447 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
10448 two directories whose contents do not match.
10449
10450 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
10451 of Diffoscope.
10452
10453 @item @code{none}
10454 Do not show further details about the differences.
10455 @end table
10456
10457 Thus, unless @code{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
10458 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
10459 can compare them.
10460
10461 @item --verbose
10462 @itemx -v
10463 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
10464 information about mismatches.
10465
10466 @end table
10467
10468 @node Invoking guix copy
10469 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
10470
10471 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
10472 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
10473 @cindex sharing store items across machines
10474 @cindex transferring store items across machines
10475 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
10476 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
10477 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
10478 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
10479 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
10480 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
10481
10482 @example
10483 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
10484 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
10485 @end example
10486
10487 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
10488 they are not actually sent.
10489
10490 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
10491 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
10492
10493 @example
10494 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
10495 @end example
10496
10497 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
10498 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
10499 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
10500
10501 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
10502 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
10503 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
10504 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
10505 store item authentication.
10506
10507 The general syntax is:
10508
10509 @example
10510 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
10511 @end example
10512
10513 You must always specify one of the following options:
10514
10515 @table @code
10516 @item --to=@var{spec}
10517 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
10518 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
10519 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
10520 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
10521 @end table
10522
10523 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
10524 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
10525
10526 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
10527 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
10528 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
10529
10530
10531 @node Invoking guix container
10532 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
10533 @cindex container
10534 @cindex @command{guix container}
10535 @quotation Note
10536 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
10537 is subject to radical change in the future.
10538 @end quotation
10539
10540 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
10541 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
10542 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
10543 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
10544 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
10545
10546 The general syntax is:
10547
10548 @example
10549 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
10550 @end example
10551
10552 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
10553 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
10554
10555 The following actions are available:
10556
10557 @table @code
10558 @item exec
10559 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
10560
10561 The syntax is:
10562
10563 @example
10564 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
10565 @end example
10566
10567 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
10568 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
10569 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
10570 will be passed to @var{program}.
10571
10572 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
10573 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
10574 process ID is 9001:
10575
10576 @example
10577 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
10578 @end example
10579
10580 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
10581 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
10582
10583 @end table
10584
10585 @node Invoking guix weather
10586 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
10587
10588 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
10589 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
10590 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
10591 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
10592 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
10593 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
10594 publish}).
10595
10596 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
10597 @cindex availability of substitutes
10598 @cindex substitute availability
10599 @cindex weather, substitute availability
10600 Here's a sample run:
10601
10602 @example
10603 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
10604 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10605 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
10606 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10607 https://guix.example.org
10608 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
10609 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
10610 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
10611 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
10612 33.5 requests per second
10613
10614 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
10615 867 queued builds
10616 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
10617 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
10618 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
10619 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
10620 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
10621 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
10622 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
10623 @end example
10624
10625 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
10626 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
10627 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
10628 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
10629 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
10630 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
10631 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
10632 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
10633 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
10634 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
10635 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
10636
10637 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
10638 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
10639 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
10640 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
10641 those substitutes.
10642
10643 The general syntax is:
10644
10645 @example
10646 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10647 @end example
10648
10649 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
10650 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
10651 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
10652 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}. The
10653 available options are listed below.
10654
10655 @table @code
10656 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10657 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
10658 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
10659 servers is queried.
10660
10661 @item --system=@var{system}
10662 @itemx -s @var{system}
10663 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
10664 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
10665 substitutes for several system types.
10666
10667 @item --manifest=@var{file}
10668 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
10669 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
10670 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
10671 guix package}).
10672
10673 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
10674 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
10675 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
10676 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
10677 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
10678 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
10679 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
10680
10681 @example
10682 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
10683 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10684 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
10685 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
10686 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
10687 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
10688 @dots{}
10689 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
10690 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
10691 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
10692 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
10693 @dots{}
10694 @end example
10695
10696 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
10697 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
10698 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
10699
10700 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
10701 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
10702 fail to build.
10703 @end table
10704
10705 @node Invoking guix processes
10706 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
10707
10708 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
10709 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
10710 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
10711 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
10712 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
10713 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
10714
10715 @example
10716 $ sudo guix processes
10717 SessionPID: 19002
10718 ClientPID: 19090
10719 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
10720
10721 SessionPID: 19402
10722 ClientPID: 19367
10723 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
10724
10725 SessionPID: 19444
10726 ClientPID: 19419
10727 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10728 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
10729 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
10730 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
10731 ChildProcess: 20495: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10732 ChildProcess: 27733: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10733 ChildProcess: 27793: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10734 @end example
10735
10736 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
10737 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
10738 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
10739 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
10740 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
10741
10742 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked by this
10743 session, which corresponds to store items being built or substituted (the
10744 @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when @command{guix processes} is not
10745 running as root.) Last, by looking at the @code{ChildProcess} field, we
10746 understand that these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10747 Setup}).
10748
10749 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
10750 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
10751 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
10752 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
10753
10754 @example
10755 $ sudo guix processes | \
10756 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
10757 ClientPID: 19419
10758 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10759 @end example
10760
10761 @node System Configuration
10762 @chapter System Configuration
10763
10764 @cindex system configuration
10765 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
10766 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
10767 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
10768 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
10769 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
10770
10771 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
10772 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
10773 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
10774 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
10775 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
10776 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
10777 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
10778 the own tools of the system.
10779 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
10780
10781 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
10782 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
10783 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
10784 instance to support new system services.
10785
10786 @menu
10787 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
10788 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
10789 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
10790 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
10791 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
10792 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
10793 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
10794 * Services:: Specifying system services.
10795 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
10796 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
10797 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
10798 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
10799 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
10800 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
10801 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
10802 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
10803 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
10804 @end menu
10805
10806 @node Using the Configuration System
10807 @section Using the Configuration System
10808
10809 The operating system is configured by providing an
10810 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
10811 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
10812 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
10813 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
10814
10815 @findex operating-system
10816 @lisp
10817 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
10818 @end lisp
10819
10820 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
10821 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
10822 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
10823 which case they get a default value.
10824
10825 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
10826 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
10827 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
10828 @command{guix system}.
10829
10830 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
10831
10832 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
10833 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
10834 @cindex UEFI boot
10835 @cindex EFI boot
10836 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
10837 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
10838 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
10839 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
10840 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
10841
10842 @lisp
10843 (bootloader-configuration
10844 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
10845 (target "/boot/efi"))
10846 @end lisp
10847
10848 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
10849 configuration options.
10850
10851 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
10852
10853 @vindex %base-packages
10854 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
10855 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
10856 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
10857 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
10858 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
10859 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
10860 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
10861 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
10862 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
10863 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
10864 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
10865 of a package:
10866
10867 @lisp
10868 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10869 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
10870
10871 (operating-system
10872 ;; ...
10873 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
10874 %base-packages)))
10875 @end lisp
10876
10877 @findex specification->package
10878 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
10879 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
10880 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
10881 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
10882 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
10883 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
10884 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
10885 version:
10886
10887 @lisp
10888 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10889
10890 (operating-system
10891 ;; ...
10892 (packages (append (map specification->package
10893 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
10894 %base-packages)))
10895 @end lisp
10896
10897 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
10898
10899 @cindex services
10900 @vindex %base-services
10901 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
10902 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
10903 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
10904 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
10905 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
10906 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
10907 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
10908 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
10909 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
10910
10911 @cindex customization, of services
10912 @findex modify-services
10913 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
10914 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
10915 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
10916
10917 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
10918 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
10919 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
10920 following in your operating system declaration:
10921
10922 @lisp
10923 (define %my-services
10924 ;; My very own list of services.
10925 (modify-services %base-services
10926 (guix-service-type config =>
10927 (guix-configuration
10928 (inherit config)
10929 (use-substitutes? #f)
10930 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
10931 (mingetty-service-type config =>
10932 (mingetty-configuration
10933 (inherit config)))))
10934
10935 (operating-system
10936 ;; @dots{}
10937 (services %my-services))
10938 @end lisp
10939
10940 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
10941 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
10942 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
10943 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
10944 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
10945 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
10946 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
10947 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
10948 configuration, but with a few modifications.
10949
10950 @cindex encrypted disk
10951 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
10952 root partition, the X11 display
10953 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
10954 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
10955 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
10956
10957 @lisp
10958 @include os-config-desktop.texi
10959 @end lisp
10960
10961 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
10962 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
10963
10964 @lisp
10965 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
10966 @end lisp
10967
10968 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
10969 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
10970 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
10971
10972 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
10973 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
10974 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
10975
10976 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
10977 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
10978 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
10979 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
10980 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
10981 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
10982
10983 @lisp
10984 (remove (lambda (service)
10985 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
10986 %desktop-services)
10987 @end lisp
10988
10989 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
10990
10991 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
10992 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
10993 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
10994 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
10995 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
10996
10997 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
10998 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
10999 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
11000 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
11001 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
11002 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
11003 system, should you ever need to.
11004
11005 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
11006 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
11007 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
11008 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
11009 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
11010 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
11011 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
11012 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
11013 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
11014 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
11015
11016 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
11017 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
11018 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
11019 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
11020 system}).
11021
11022 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
11023
11024 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
11025 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
11026 Monad}):
11027
11028 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
11029 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
11030 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
11031
11032 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
11033 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
11034 instantiate @var{os}.
11035 @end deffn
11036
11037 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
11038 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
11039 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
11040
11041
11042 @node operating-system Reference
11043 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
11044
11045 This section summarizes all the options available in
11046 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
11047 System}).
11048
11049 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
11050 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
11051 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
11052 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
11053
11054 @table @asis
11055 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
11056 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
11057 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
11058 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
11059
11060 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'("quiet")})
11061 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
11062 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
11063
11064 @item @code{bootloader}
11065 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
11066
11067 @item @code{label}
11068 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
11069 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
11070
11071 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
11072 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
11073 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
11074 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
11075
11076 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
11077 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
11078 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
11079 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
11080
11081 @quotation Note
11082 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
11083 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
11084 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
11085 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
11086 Window System.
11087 @end quotation
11088
11089 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
11090 @cindex initrd
11091 @cindex initial RAM disk
11092 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
11093 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
11094
11095 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
11096 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
11097 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
11098 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
11099
11100 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
11101 @cindex firmware
11102 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
11103
11104 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
11105 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
11106 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
11107 supported hardware.
11108
11109 @item @code{host-name}
11110 The host name.
11111
11112 @item @code{hosts-file}
11113 @cindex hosts file
11114 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
11115 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11116 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
11117 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
11118
11119 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
11120 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
11121
11122 @item @code{file-systems}
11123 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
11124
11125 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
11126 @cindex swap devices
11127 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
11128 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11129 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
11130 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
11131 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
11132 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
11133
11134 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
11135 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
11136 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
11137
11138 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
11139 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
11140
11141 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
11142 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
11143 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
11144 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
11145
11146 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
11147
11148 @lisp
11149 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
11150 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
11151 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
11152 (activate-readline)")))
11153 @end lisp
11154
11155 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
11156 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
11157 displayed when users log in on a text console.
11158
11159 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
11160 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
11161 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
11162
11163 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
11164 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
11165 package}).
11166
11167 @item @code{timezone}
11168 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
11169
11170 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
11171 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
11172 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
11173
11174 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
11175 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
11176 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
11177
11178 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
11179 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
11180 run time. @xref{Locales}.
11181
11182 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
11183 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
11184 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
11185 considerations that justify this option.
11186
11187 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
11188 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
11189 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
11190 details.
11191
11192 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
11193 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
11194
11195 @cindex essential services
11196 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
11197 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
11198 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
11199 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
11200 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
11201
11202 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
11203 @cindex PAM
11204 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
11205 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
11206 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
11207
11208 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
11209 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
11210 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
11211
11212 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
11213 @cindex sudoers file
11214 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
11215 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
11216
11217 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
11218 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
11219 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
11220 @code{sudo}.
11221
11222 @end table
11223
11224 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
11225 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
11226 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
11227
11228 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
11229 the definition of the @code{label} field:
11230
11231 @lisp
11232 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
11233
11234 (operating-system
11235 ;; ...
11236 (label (package-full-name
11237 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
11238 @end lisp
11239
11240 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
11241 system definition.
11242 @end deffn
11243
11244 @end deftp
11245
11246 @node File Systems
11247 @section File Systems
11248
11249 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
11250 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
11251 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
11252 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
11253
11254 @lisp
11255 (file-system
11256 (mount-point "/home")
11257 (device "/dev/sda3")
11258 (type "ext4"))
11259 @end lisp
11260
11261 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
11262 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
11263
11264 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
11265 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
11266 contain the following members:
11267
11268 @table @asis
11269 @item @code{type}
11270 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
11271 @code{"ext4"}.
11272
11273 @item @code{mount-point}
11274 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
11275
11276 @item @code{device}
11277 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
11278 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
11279 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
11280 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
11281 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
11282 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
11283 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
11284 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
11285 mounted.}.
11286
11287 @findex file-system-label
11288 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
11289 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
11290 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
11291 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
11292
11293 @lisp
11294 (file-system
11295 (mount-point "/home")
11296 (type "ext4")
11297 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
11298 @end lisp
11299
11300 @findex uuid
11301 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
11302 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
11303 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
11304 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
11305 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
11306 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
11307 like this:
11308
11309 @lisp
11310 (file-system
11311 (mount-point "/home")
11312 (type "ext4")
11313 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
11314 @end lisp
11315
11316 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
11317 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
11318 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
11319 This is required so that
11320 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
11321 corresponding device mapping established.
11322
11323 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
11324 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
11325 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
11326 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
11327 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
11328 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
11329 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
11330 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
11331 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11332 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
11333
11334 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
11335 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to the
11336 file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11337 Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for options for
11338 various file systems.
11339
11340 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
11341 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
11342 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
11343 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
11344 is not automatically mounted.
11345
11346 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
11347 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
11348 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
11349 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
11350 instance, for the root file system.
11351
11352 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
11353 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
11354 errors before being mounted.
11355
11356 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
11357 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
11358
11359 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
11360 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
11361 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
11362 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
11363
11364 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
11365 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
11366 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
11367
11368 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
11369 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
11370 @end table
11371 @end deftp
11372
11373 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
11374 variables.
11375
11376 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
11377 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
11378 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
11379 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
11380 these.
11381 @end defvr
11382
11383 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
11384 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
11385 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
11386 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11387 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
11388 @command{xterm}.
11389 @end defvr
11390
11391 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
11392 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
11393 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
11394 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
11395 @end defvr
11396
11397 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
11398 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
11399 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
11400 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
11401 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
11402
11403 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
11404 read-write in its own ``name space.''
11405 @end defvr
11406
11407 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
11408 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
11409 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
11410 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
11411 @end defvr
11412
11413 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
11414 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
11415 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
11416 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
11417 @end defvr
11418
11419 @node Mapped Devices
11420 @section Mapped Devices
11421
11422 @cindex device mapping
11423 @cindex mapped devices
11424 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
11425 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
11426 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
11427 with additional processing over the data that flows through
11428 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
11429 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
11430 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
11431 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
11432 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
11433 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
11434 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
11435 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
11436 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
11437 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
11438 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
11439 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
11440 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
11441
11442 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
11443 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
11444
11445 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
11446 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
11447 the system boots up.
11448
11449 @table @code
11450 @item source
11451 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
11452 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
11453 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
11454
11455 @item target
11456 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
11457 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
11458 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
11459 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
11460 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
11461 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
11462
11463 @item type
11464 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
11465 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
11466 @end table
11467 @end deftp
11468
11469 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
11470 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
11471 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
11472 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
11473 @end defvr
11474
11475 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
11476 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
11477 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
11478 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
11479 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
11480 @end defvr
11481
11482 @cindex disk encryption
11483 @cindex LUKS
11484 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
11485 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
11486 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
11487 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
11488 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
11489 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
11490 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11491
11492 @lisp
11493 (mapped-device
11494 (source "/dev/sda3")
11495 (target "home")
11496 (type luks-device-mapping))
11497 @end lisp
11498
11499 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
11500 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
11501 command like:
11502
11503 @example
11504 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
11505 @end example
11506
11507 and use it as follows:
11508
11509 @lisp
11510 (mapped-device
11511 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
11512 (target "home")
11513 (type luks-device-mapping))
11514 @end lisp
11515
11516 @cindex swap encryption
11517 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
11518 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
11519 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
11520 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
11521 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
11522
11523 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
11524 may be declared as follows:
11525
11526 @lisp
11527 (mapped-device
11528 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
11529 (target "/dev/md0")
11530 (type raid-device-mapping))
11531 @end lisp
11532
11533 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
11534 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11535 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
11536 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
11537 automatically later.
11538
11539
11540 @node User Accounts
11541 @section User Accounts
11542
11543 @cindex users
11544 @cindex accounts
11545 @cindex user accounts
11546 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
11547 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
11548 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
11549
11550 @lisp
11551 (user-account
11552 (name "alice")
11553 (group "users")
11554 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
11555 "audio" ;sound card
11556 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
11557 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
11558 (comment "Bob's sister")
11559 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
11560 @end lisp
11561
11562 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
11563 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
11564 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
11565 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
11566 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
11567 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
11568 as declared.
11569
11570 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
11571 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
11572 be specified:
11573
11574 @table @asis
11575 @item @code{name}
11576 The name of the user account.
11577
11578 @item @code{group}
11579 @cindex groups
11580 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
11581 this account belongs to.
11582
11583 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
11584 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
11585 account belongs to.
11586
11587 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
11588 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
11589 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
11590 account is created.
11591
11592 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
11593 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
11594
11595 @item @code{home-directory}
11596 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
11597
11598 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
11599 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
11600 if it does not exist yet.
11601
11602 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
11603 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
11604 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11605
11606 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11607 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
11608 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
11609 graphical login managers do not list them.
11610
11611 @anchor{user-account-password}
11612 @cindex password, for user accounts
11613 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11614 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
11615 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
11616 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
11617 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
11618 reconfiguration.
11619
11620 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
11621 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
11622 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
11623
11624 @lisp
11625 (user-account
11626 (name "charlie")
11627 (group "users")
11628
11629 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
11630 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
11631 @end lisp
11632
11633 @quotation Note
11634 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
11635 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
11636 care.
11637 @end quotation
11638
11639 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
11640 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
11641 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
11642
11643 @end table
11644 @end deftp
11645
11646 @cindex groups
11647 User group declarations are even simpler:
11648
11649 @lisp
11650 (user-group (name "students"))
11651 @end lisp
11652
11653 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
11654 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
11655
11656 @table @asis
11657 @item @code{name}
11658 The name of the group.
11659
11660 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
11661 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
11662 automatically allocated when the group is created.
11663
11664 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11665 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
11666 System groups have low numerical IDs.
11667
11668 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11669 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
11670 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
11671
11672 @end table
11673 @end deftp
11674
11675 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
11676 expect:
11677
11678 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
11679 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
11680 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
11681 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
11682 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
11683 @end defvr
11684
11685 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
11686 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
11687 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
11688
11689 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
11690 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
11691 @end defvr
11692
11693 @node Keyboard Layout
11694 @section Keyboard Layout
11695
11696 @cindex keyboard layout
11697 @cindex keymap
11698 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
11699 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
11700 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
11701 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
11702 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
11703 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
11704 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
11705
11706 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
11707 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
11708
11709 @itemize
11710 @item
11711 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
11712 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
11713 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
11714 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
11715
11716 @item
11717 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
11718 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
11719 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11720
11721 @item
11722 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
11723 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11724 @end itemize
11725
11726 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
11727 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
11728
11729 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
11730 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
11731 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
11732 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
11733 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
11734 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
11735 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
11736 about. Here are a few example:
11737
11738 @lisp
11739 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
11740 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
11741 (keyboard-layout "de")
11742
11743 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
11744 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
11745
11746 ;; The Catalan layout.
11747 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
11748
11749 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
11750 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
11751 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
11752 ;; accented letters.
11753 (keyboard-layout "latam"
11754 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
11755
11756 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
11757 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
11758
11759 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
11760 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
11761 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
11762 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
11763 @end lisp
11764
11765 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
11766 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
11767
11768 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
11769 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
11770 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
11771 configuration would look like:
11772
11773 @findex set-xorg-configuration
11774 @lisp
11775 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
11776 ;; and for Xorg.
11777
11778 (operating-system
11779 ;; ...
11780 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
11781 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
11782 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11783 (target "/boot/efi")
11784 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
11785 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
11786 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
11787 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
11788 %desktop-services)))
11789 @end lisp
11790
11791 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
11792 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
11793 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
11794 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
11795 GDM.
11796
11797 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
11798 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
11799
11800 @itemize
11801 @item
11802 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
11803 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
11804
11805 @item
11806 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
11807 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
11808 change the layout to US Dvorak:
11809
11810 @example
11811 setxkbmap us dvorak
11812 @end example
11813
11814 @item
11815 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
11816 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
11817 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
11818 French bépo layout:
11819
11820 @example
11821 loadkeys fr-bepo
11822 @end example
11823 @end itemize
11824
11825 @node Locales
11826 @section Locales
11827
11828 @cindex locale
11829 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
11830 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11831 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
11832 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
11833 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
11834 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
11835
11836 @cindex locale definition
11837 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
11838 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
11839 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
11840
11841 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
11842 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
11843 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
11844 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
11845 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
11846 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
11847 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
11848 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
11849
11850 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
11851 that field may be:
11852
11853 @lisp
11854 (cons (locale-definition
11855 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
11856 %default-locale-definitions)
11857 @end lisp
11858
11859 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
11860 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
11861
11862 @lisp
11863 (list (locale-definition
11864 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
11865 (charset "EUC-JP")))
11866 @end lisp
11867
11868 @vindex LOCPATH
11869 The compiled locale definitions are available at
11870 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
11871 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
11872 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
11873 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11874 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11875
11876 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
11877 locale)} module. Details are given below.
11878
11879 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
11880 This is the data type of a locale definition.
11881
11882 @table @asis
11883
11884 @item @code{name}
11885 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11886 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
11887
11888 @item @code{source}
11889 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
11890 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
11891
11892 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
11893 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
11894 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
11895 IANA}.
11896
11897 @end table
11898 @end deftp
11899
11900 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
11901 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
11902 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
11903 declarations.
11904
11905 @cindex locale name
11906 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
11907 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
11908 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
11909 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
11910 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
11911 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
11912 @end defvr
11913
11914 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
11915
11916 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
11917 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
11918 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
11919 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
11920 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
11921 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
11922 another.
11923
11924 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
11925 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
11926 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
11927 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
11928 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
11929 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
11930 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
11931 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
11932 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
11933 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
11934 programs will not abort.
11935
11936 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
11937 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
11938 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
11939 used to build the system-wide locale data.
11940
11941 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
11942 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11943 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11944
11945 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
11946 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
11947 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
11948 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
11949 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
11950 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
11951
11952 @lisp
11953 (use-package-modules base)
11954
11955 (operating-system
11956 ;; @dots{}
11957 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
11958 @end lisp
11959
11960 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
11961 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
11962 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
11963
11964
11965 @node Services
11966 @section Services
11967
11968 @cindex system services
11969 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
11970 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
11971 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
11972 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
11973 configuring network access.
11974
11975 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
11976 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
11977 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
11978 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
11979 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
11980 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
11981
11982 @example
11983 # herd status
11984 @end example
11985
11986 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
11987 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
11988 service and its associated actions:
11989
11990 @example
11991 # herd doc nscd
11992 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
11993
11994 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
11995 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
11996 @end example
11997
11998 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
11999 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
12000 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
12001
12002 @example
12003 # herd stop nscd
12004 Service nscd has been stopped.
12005 # herd restart xorg-server
12006 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
12007 Service xorg-server has been started.
12008 @end example
12009
12010 The following sections document the available services, starting with
12011 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
12012 declaration.
12013
12014 @menu
12015 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
12016 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
12017 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
12018 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
12019 * X Window:: Graphical display.
12020 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
12021 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
12022 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
12023 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
12024 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
12025 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
12026 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
12027 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
12028 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
12029 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
12030 * Web Services:: Web servers.
12031 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
12032 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
12033 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
12034 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
12035 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
12036 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
12037 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
12038 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
12039 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
12040 * Game Services:: Game servers.
12041 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
12042 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
12043 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
12044 @end menu
12045
12046 @node Base Services
12047 @subsection Base Services
12048
12049 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
12050 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
12051 this module are listed below.
12052
12053 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
12054 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
12055 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
12056 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
12057 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
12058 more.
12059
12060 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
12061 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
12062 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
12063 this:
12064
12065 @lisp
12066 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
12067 (service openssh-service-type))
12068 %base-services)
12069 @end lisp
12070 @end defvr
12071
12072 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
12073 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
12074 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
12075
12076 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
12077 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
12078 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
12079
12080 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
12081 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
12082 @lisp
12083 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
12084 @end lisp
12085
12086 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
12087 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
12088 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
12089 change it to:
12090
12091 @lisp
12092 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
12093 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
12094 @end lisp
12095
12096 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
12097 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
12098 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
12099 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
12100 (see below.)
12101 @end defvr
12102
12103 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
12104 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
12105
12106 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
12107 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
12108 symlink:
12109
12110 @lisp
12111 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
12112 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
12113 @end lisp
12114 @end deffn
12115
12116 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
12117 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
12118 @end deffn
12119
12120 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
12121 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
12122 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
12123 among other things.
12124 @end deffn
12125
12126 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
12127 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
12128
12129 @table @asis
12130
12131 @item @code{motd}
12132 @cindex message of the day
12133 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
12134
12135 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
12136 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
12137 the 'root' account has just been created.
12138
12139 @end table
12140 @end deftp
12141
12142 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
12143 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
12144 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
12145 other things.
12146 @end deffn
12147
12148 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
12149 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
12150 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
12151
12152 @table @asis
12153
12154 @item @code{tty}
12155 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
12156
12157 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12158 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
12159 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
12160 user name and password must be entered to log in.
12161
12162 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
12163 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
12164 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
12165 the name of the log-in program.
12166
12167 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
12168 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
12169 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
12170
12171 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
12172 The Mingetty package to use.
12173
12174 @end table
12175 @end deftp
12176
12177 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
12178 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
12179 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
12180 among other things.
12181 @end deffn
12182
12183 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
12184 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
12185 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
12186 man page for more information.
12187
12188 @table @asis
12189
12190 @item @code{tty}
12191 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
12192 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
12193 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
12194
12195 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
12196 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
12197 from it and use that.
12198
12199 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
12200 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
12201 serial port from it and use that.
12202
12203 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
12204 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
12205 correct values.
12206
12207 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
12208 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
12209 descending order.
12210
12211 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
12212 A string containing the value used for the @code{TERM} environment
12213 variable.
12214
12215 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
12216 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
12217 disabled.
12218
12219 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12220 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
12221 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
12222
12223 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
12224 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
12225
12226 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
12227 This accepts a string containing the "login_host", which will be written
12228 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
12229
12230 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
12231 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
12232 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
12233 specified in @var{login-program}.
12234
12235 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
12236 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
12237
12238 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
12239 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
12240 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
12241
12242 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
12243 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
12244 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
12245
12246 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
12247 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
12248 the login prompt.
12249
12250 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
12251 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
12252 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
12253 Shadow tool suite.
12254
12255 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
12256 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
12257 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
12258 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
12259
12260 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
12261 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
12262 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
12263
12264 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
12265 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
12266 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
12267 systems.
12268
12269 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
12270 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
12271 @file{/etc/issue} file.
12272
12273 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
12274 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
12275 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
12276 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
12277 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
12278 options that could be parsed by the login program.
12279
12280 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
12281 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
12282 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
12283 lazily spawning shells.
12284
12285 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
12286 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
12287 path as a string.
12288
12289 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
12290 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
12291 specified terminal.
12292
12293 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
12294 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
12295 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
12296 character.
12297
12298 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
12299 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
12300 within @var{timeout} seconds.
12301
12302 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
12303 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
12304 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
12305 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
12306 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
12307 Unicode characters.
12308
12309 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
12310 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
12311 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
12312 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
12313 @var{init-string} option.
12314
12315 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
12316 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
12317 locks.
12318
12319 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
12320 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
12321 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
12322
12323 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
12324 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
12325 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
12326 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
12327
12328 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
12329 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
12330 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
12331
12332 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
12333 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean "ignore
12334 all previous characters" (also called a "kill" character) when the user
12335 types their login name.
12336
12337 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
12338 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
12339 to before login.
12340
12341 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
12342 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
12343 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
12344
12345 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
12346 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
12347 @command{login} program.
12348
12349 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12350 This option provides an "escape hatch" for the user to provide arbitrary
12351 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
12352
12353 @end table
12354 @end deftp
12355
12356 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
12357 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
12358 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
12359 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
12360 @end deffn
12361
12362 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
12363 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
12364 implements virtual console log-in.
12365
12366 @table @asis
12367
12368 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
12369 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
12370
12371 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
12372 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
12373 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
12374
12375 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
12376 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
12377
12378 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12379 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
12380 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
12381
12382 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
12383 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
12384
12385 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
12386 The Kmscon package to use.
12387
12388 @end table
12389 @end deftp
12390
12391 @cindex name service cache daemon
12392 @cindex nscd
12393 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
12394 [#:name-services '()]
12395 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
12396 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
12397 Service Switch}, for an example.
12398
12399 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
12400
12401 @table @code
12402 @item invalidate
12403 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
12404 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
12405 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
12406
12407 @example
12408 herd invalidate nscd hosts
12409 @end example
12410
12411 @noindent
12412 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
12413
12414 @item statistics
12415 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
12416 and caches.
12417 @end table
12418
12419 @end deffn
12420
12421 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
12422 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
12423 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
12424 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
12425 @end defvr
12426
12427 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
12428 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
12429 configuration.
12430
12431 @table @asis
12432
12433 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
12434 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
12435 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
12436
12437 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
12438 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
12439 command.
12440
12441 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
12442 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
12443 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
12444
12445 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
12446 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
12447 debugging output is logged.
12448
12449 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
12450 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
12451 below.
12452
12453 @end table
12454 @end deftp
12455
12456 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
12457 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
12458
12459 @table @asis
12460
12461 @item @code{database}
12462 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
12463 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
12464 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
12465 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12466
12467 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
12468 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
12469 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
12470 negative lookup result remains in cache.
12471
12472 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
12473 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
12474 @var{database}.
12475
12476 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
12477 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
12478 them into account.
12479
12480 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
12481 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
12482
12483 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
12484 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
12485
12486 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
12487 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
12488
12489 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
12490 @c settings, so leave them out.
12491
12492 @end table
12493 @end deftp
12494
12495 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
12496 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
12497 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
12498
12499 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
12500 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
12501 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
12502 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
12503 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
12504 @end defvr
12505
12506 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
12507 @cindex syslog
12508 @cindex logging
12509 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
12510 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
12511
12512 @table @asis
12513 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
12514 The syslog daemon to use.
12515
12516 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
12517 The syslog configuration file to use.
12518
12519 @end table
12520 @end deftp
12521
12522 @anchor{syslog-service}
12523 @cindex syslog
12524 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
12525 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
12526
12527 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
12528 information on the configuration file syntax.
12529 @end deffn
12530
12531 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
12532 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
12533 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
12534 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
12535 @end defvr
12536
12537 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
12538 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
12539 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
12540 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
12541
12542 @table @asis
12543 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
12544 The Guix package to use.
12545
12546 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
12547 Name of the group for build user accounts.
12548
12549 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
12550 Number of build user accounts to create.
12551
12552 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
12553 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
12554 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
12555 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
12556 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12557
12558 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
12559 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
12560 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
12561 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
12562 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12563
12564 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
12565 Whether to use substitutes.
12566
12567 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
12568 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
12569
12570 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
12571 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
12572 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
12573 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
12574 disables the timeout.
12575
12576 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
12577 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
12578 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
12579
12580 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12581 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
12582
12583 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
12584 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
12585 are written.
12586
12587 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
12588 The HTTP proxy used for downloading fixed-output derivations and
12589 substitutes.
12590
12591 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
12592 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
12593
12594 @end table
12595 @end deftp
12596
12597 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
12598 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
12599 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
12600 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule} and @code{file->udev-rule} from
12601 @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the creation of such rule files.
12602 @end deffn
12603
12604 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
12605 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
12606 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
12607
12608 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
12609 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
12610 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
12611
12612 @lisp
12613 (define %example-udev-rule
12614 (udev-rule
12615 "90-usb-thing.rules"
12616 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
12617 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
12618 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
12619 @end lisp
12620
12621 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
12622 directory containing all the active udev rules.
12623 @end deffn
12624
12625 Here we show how the default @var{udev-service} can be extended with it.
12626
12627 @lisp
12628 (operating-system
12629 ;; @dots{}
12630 (services
12631 (modify-services %desktop-services
12632 (udev-service-type config =>
12633 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12634 (rules (append (udev-configuration-rules config)
12635 (list %example-udev-rule))))))))
12636 @end lisp
12637
12638 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
12639 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
12640 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
12641
12642 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
12643
12644 @lisp
12645 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
12646 (guix packages) ;for origin
12647 @dots{})
12648
12649 (define %android-udev-rules
12650 (file->udev-rule
12651 "51-android-udev.rules"
12652 (let ((version "20170910"))
12653 (origin
12654 (method url-fetch)
12655 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
12656 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
12657 (sha256
12658 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
12659 @end lisp
12660 @end deffn
12661
12662 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
12663 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
12664 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
12665 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
12666 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
12667 packages android)} module.
12668
12669 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
12670 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
12671 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
12672 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
12673 the rules defined within the @var{android-udev-rules} package. To
12674 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
12675 @var{supplementary-groups} of our @var{user-account} declaration, as
12676 well as in the @var{groups} field of the @var{operating-system} record.
12677
12678 @lisp
12679 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
12680 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
12681 @dots{})
12682
12683 (operating-system
12684 ;; @dots{}
12685 (users (cons (user-acount
12686 ;; @dots{}
12687 (supplementary-groups
12688 '("adbusers" ;for adb
12689 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
12690
12691 (groups (cons (user-group (system? #t) (name "adbusers"))
12692 %base-groups))
12693
12694 ;; @dots{}
12695
12696 (services
12697 (modify-services %desktop-services
12698 (udev-service-type
12699 config =>
12700 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12701 (rules (cons android-udev-rules
12702 (udev-configuration-rules config))))))))
12703 @end lisp
12704
12705 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
12706 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
12707 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
12708 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
12709 readable.
12710 @end defvr
12711
12712 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
12713 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
12714 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
12715 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
12716 @end defvr
12717
12718 @cindex mouse
12719 @cindex gpm
12720 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
12721 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
12722 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
12723 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
12724 and paste text.
12725
12726 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
12727 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
12728 @end defvr
12729
12730 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
12731 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
12732
12733 @table @asis
12734 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
12735 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
12736 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
12737 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
12738 more information.
12739
12740 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
12741 The GPM package to use.
12742
12743 @end table
12744 @end deftp
12745
12746 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
12747 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
12748 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
12749 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
12750 object, as described below.
12751
12752 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
12753 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12754 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
12755 @end deffn
12756
12757 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
12758 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
12759 service.
12760
12761 @table @asis
12762 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
12763 The Guix package to use.
12764
12765 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
12766 The TCP port to listen for connections.
12767
12768 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
12769 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
12770 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
12771
12772 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
12773 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
12774 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
12775 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
12776
12777 @lisp
12778 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
12779 @end lisp
12780
12781 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
12782 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression.
12783
12784 An empty list disables compression altogether.
12785
12786 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
12787 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
12788 publish, @code{--nar-path}}, for details.
12789
12790 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
12791 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
12792 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
12793 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
12794 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
12795 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
12796
12797 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
12798 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
12799 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
12800 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
12801
12802 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
12803 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
12804 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
12805 for more information.
12806 @end table
12807 @end deftp
12808
12809 @anchor{rngd-service}
12810 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
12811 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
12812 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
12813 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
12814 @var{device} does not exist.
12815 @end deffn
12816
12817 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
12818 @cindex session limits
12819 @cindex ulimit
12820 @cindex priority
12821 @cindex realtime
12822 @cindex jackd
12823 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
12824
12825 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
12826 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
12827 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
12828 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
12829 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
12830
12831 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
12832 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
12833
12834 @lisp
12835 (pam-limits-service
12836 (list
12837 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
12838 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
12839 @end lisp
12840
12841 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
12842 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
12843 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
12844 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
12845 @end deffn
12846
12847 @node Scheduled Job Execution
12848 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
12849
12850 @cindex cron
12851 @cindex mcron
12852 @cindex scheduling jobs
12853 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
12854 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
12855 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
12856 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
12857 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
12858 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
12859
12860 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
12861 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
12862 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
12863 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
12864 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
12865 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
12866 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12867
12868 @lisp
12869 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
12870 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12871
12872 (define updatedb-job
12873 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
12874 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
12875 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
12876 (lambda ()
12877 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
12878 "updatedb"
12879 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
12880
12881 (define garbage-collector-job
12882 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
12883 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
12884 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
12885 "guix gc -F 1G"))
12886
12887 (define idutils-job
12888 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
12889 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
12890 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
12891 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
12892 #:user "charlie"))
12893
12894 (operating-system
12895 ;; @dots{}
12896 (services (cons (service mcron-service-type
12897 (mcron-configuration
12898 (jobs (list garbage-collector-job
12899 updatedb-job
12900 idutils-job))))
12901 %base-services)))
12902 @end lisp
12903
12904 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
12905 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
12906 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
12907 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
12908 illustrates that.
12909
12910 @lisp
12911 (define %battery-alert-job
12912 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
12913 #~(job
12914 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
12915 #$(program-file
12916 "battery-alert.scm"
12917 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
12918 '((guix build utils)))
12919 #~(begin
12920 (define %min-level 20)
12921 (use-modules (guix build utils)
12922 (ice-9 popen)
12923 (ice-9 regex)
12924 (ice-9 textual-ports)
12925 (srfi srfi-2))
12926 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
12927 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
12928 OPEN_READ
12929 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
12930 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
12931 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
12932 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
12933 ((< level %min-level)))
12934 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
12935 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
12936 @end lisp
12937
12938 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
12939 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
12940 reference of the mcron service.
12941
12942 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
12943 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
12944
12945 @example
12946 # herd schedule mcron
12947 @end example
12948
12949 @noindent
12950 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
12951 also specify the number of tasks to display:
12952
12953 @example
12954 # herd schedule mcron 10
12955 @end example
12956
12957 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
12958 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
12959 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
12960
12961 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
12962 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
12963 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
12964 mcron jobs to run.
12965 @end defvr
12966
12967 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
12968 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
12969
12970 @table @asis
12971 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
12972 The mcron package to use.
12973
12974 @item @code{jobs}
12975 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
12976 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
12977 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
12978 @end table
12979 @end deftp
12980
12981
12982 @node Log Rotation
12983 @subsection Log Rotation
12984
12985 @cindex rottlog
12986 @cindex log rotation
12987 @cindex logging
12988 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
12989 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
12990 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
12991 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
12992 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12993
12994 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
12995 with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
12996
12997 @lisp
12998 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
12999 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
13000 (use-package-modules base idutils)
13001
13002 (operating-system
13003 ;; @dots{}
13004 (services (cons (service rottlog-service-type)
13005 %base-services)))
13006 @end lisp
13007
13008 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
13009 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
13010 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
13011
13012 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
13013 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
13014
13015 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
13016 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
13017 @end defvr
13018
13019 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
13020 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
13021
13022 @table @asis
13023 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
13024 The Rottlog package to use.
13025
13026 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
13027 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
13028 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
13029
13030 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
13031 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
13032
13033 @item @code{jobs}
13034 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
13035 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
13036 @end table
13037 @end deftp
13038
13039 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
13040 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
13041
13042 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
13043 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
13044 defined like this:
13045
13046 @lisp
13047 (log-rotation
13048 (frequency 'daily)
13049 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
13050 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
13051 "rotate 6"
13052 "notifempty"
13053 "nocompress")))
13054 @end lisp
13055
13056 The list of fields is as follows:
13057
13058 @table @asis
13059 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
13060 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
13061
13062 @item @code{files}
13063 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
13064
13065 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
13066 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
13067 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
13068
13069 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
13070 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
13071 @end table
13072 @end deftp
13073
13074 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
13075 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and of
13076 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
13077 @end defvr
13078
13079 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
13080 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
13081 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
13082 "/var/log/maillog")}.
13083 @end defvr
13084
13085 @node Networking Services
13086 @subsection Networking Services
13087
13088 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
13089 the network interface.
13090
13091 @cindex DHCP, networking service
13092 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
13093 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
13094 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
13095 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
13096 @end defvr
13097
13098 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
13099 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
13100 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
13101 For example:
13102
13103 @lisp
13104 (service dhcpd-service-type
13105 (dhcpd-configuration
13106 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
13107 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
13108 @end lisp
13109 @end deffn
13110
13111 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
13112 @table @asis
13113 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
13114 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
13115 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
13116 directory. The default package is the
13117 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
13118 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
13119 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
13120 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
13121 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
13122 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
13123 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
13124 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
13125 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
13126 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
13127 details.
13128 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
13129 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
13130 will be created if it does not exist.
13131 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
13132 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
13133 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
13134 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
13135 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
13136 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
13137 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
13138 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
13139 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
13140 @end table
13141 @end deftp
13142
13143 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
13144 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
13145 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
13146 @end defvr
13147
13148 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
13149 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
13150 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
13151 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
13152 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
13153 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
13154 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
13155 interface.
13156
13157 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
13158 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
13159 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
13160 to handle.
13161
13162 For example:
13163
13164 @lisp
13165 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
13166 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
13167 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
13168 @end lisp
13169 @end deffn
13170
13171 @cindex wicd
13172 @cindex wireless
13173 @cindex WiFi
13174 @cindex network management
13175 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
13176 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
13177 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
13178
13179 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
13180 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
13181 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
13182 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
13183 @end deffn
13184
13185 @cindex ModemManager
13186
13187 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
13188 This is the service type for the
13189 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
13190 service. The value for this service type is a
13191 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
13192
13193 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13194 Services}).
13195 @end defvr
13196
13197 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
13198 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
13199
13200 @table @asis
13201 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
13202 The ModemManager package to use.
13203
13204 @end table
13205 @end deftp
13206
13207 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
13208 @cindex Modeswitching
13209
13210 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
13211 This is the service type for the
13212 @uref{http://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch} service. The
13213 value for this service type is a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
13214
13215 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
13216 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
13217 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
13218 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
13219 plugged in.
13220
13221 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13222 Services}).
13223 @end defvr
13224
13225 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
13226 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
13227
13228 @table @asis
13229 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
13230 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
13231
13232 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
13233 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
13234 USB_ModeSwitch.
13235
13236 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
13237 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
13238 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
13239 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
13240 file is used.
13241
13242 @end table
13243 @end deftp
13244
13245 @cindex NetworkManager
13246
13247 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
13248 This is the service type for the
13249 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
13250 service. The value for this service type is a
13251 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
13252
13253 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13254 Services}).
13255 @end defvr
13256
13257 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
13258 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
13259
13260 @table @asis
13261 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
13262 The NetworkManager package to use.
13263
13264 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
13265 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
13266 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
13267
13268 @table @samp
13269 @item default
13270 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
13271 provided by currently active connections.
13272
13273 @item dnsmasq
13274 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
13275 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
13276 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
13277
13278 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
13279 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
13280 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
13281 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
13282 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
13283
13284 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
13285 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
13286 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
13287 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
13288 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
13289 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
13290
13291 @example
13292 nmcli connection add type tun \
13293 connection.interface-name tap0 \
13294 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
13295 ipv4.method shared \
13296 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
13297 @end example
13298
13299 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
13300 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
13301 @command{qemu-system-...}.
13302
13303 @item none
13304 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
13305 @end table
13306
13307 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
13308 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
13309 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
13310 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
13311
13312 @end table
13313 @end deftp
13314
13315 @cindex Connman
13316 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
13317 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
13318 a network connection manager.
13319
13320 Its value must be an
13321 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
13322
13323 @lisp
13324 (service connman-service-type
13325 (connman-configuration
13326 (disable-vpn? #t)))
13327 @end lisp
13328
13329 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
13330 @end deffn
13331
13332 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
13333 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
13334
13335 @table @asis
13336 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
13337 The connman package to use.
13338
13339 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
13340 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
13341 @end table
13342 @end deftp
13343
13344 @cindex WPA Supplicant
13345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
13346 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
13347 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
13348 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
13349 @end defvr
13350
13351 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
13352 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
13353
13354 It takes the following parameters:
13355
13356 @table @asis
13357 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
13358 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
13359
13360 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
13361 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
13362
13363 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
13364 Where to store the PID file.
13365
13366 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
13367 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
13368 WPA supplicant will control.
13369
13370 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
13371 Optional configuration file to use.
13372
13373 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
13374 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
13375 @end table
13376 @end deftp
13377
13378 @cindex iptables
13379 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
13380 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
13381 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
13382 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
13383 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
13384 22 is shown below.
13385
13386 @lisp
13387 (service iptables-service-type
13388 (iptables-configuration
13389 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
13390 :INPUT ACCEPT
13391 :FORWARD ACCEPT
13392 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
13393 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
13394 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
13395 COMMIT
13396 "))
13397 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
13398 :INPUT ACCEPT
13399 :FORWARD ACCEPT
13400 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
13401 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
13402 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
13403 COMMIT
13404 "))))
13405 @end lisp
13406 @end defvr
13407
13408 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
13409 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
13410
13411 @table @asis
13412 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
13413 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
13414 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
13415 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
13416 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
13417 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
13418 objects}).
13419 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
13420 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
13421 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
13422 objects}).
13423 @end table
13424 @end deftp
13425
13426 @cindex nftables
13427 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
13428 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
13429 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
13430 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
13431 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
13432 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
13433 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
13434 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
13435
13436 @lisp
13437 (service nftables-service-type)
13438 @end lisp
13439 @end defvr
13440
13441 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
13442 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
13443
13444 @table @asis
13445 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
13446 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
13447 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
13448 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
13449 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
13450 @end table
13451 @end deftp
13452
13453 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
13454 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
13455 @cindex real time clock
13456 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
13457 This is the type of the service running the @uref{http://www.ntp.org,
13458 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
13459 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
13460
13461 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
13462 below.
13463 @end defvr
13464
13465 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
13466 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
13467
13468 @table @asis
13469 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
13470 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
13471 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
13472 definition below.
13473
13474 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
13475 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
13476 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
13477
13478 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
13479 The NTP package to use.
13480 @end table
13481 @end deftp
13482
13483 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
13484 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
13485 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
13486 @end defvr
13487
13488 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
13489 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
13490
13491 @table @asis
13492 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
13493 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
13494 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
13495
13496 @item @code{address}
13497 The address of the server, as a string.
13498
13499 @item @code{options}
13500 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
13501 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
13502 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
13503 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
13504
13505 @example
13506 (ntp-server
13507 (type 'server)
13508 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
13509 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
13510 @end example
13511 @end table
13512 @end deftp
13513
13514 @cindex OpenNTPD
13515 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
13516 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
13517 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
13518 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
13519
13520 @lisp
13521 (service
13522 openntpd-service-type
13523 (openntpd-configuration
13524 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
13525 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
13526 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
13527 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
13528 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
13529
13530 @end lisp
13531 @end deffn
13532
13533 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
13534 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
13535 @var{%ntp-servers}.
13536 @end defvr
13537
13538 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
13539 @table @asis
13540 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
13541 The openntpd executable to use.
13542 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
13543 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
13544 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
13545 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
13546 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
13547 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
13548 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
13549 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
13550 information.
13551 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
13552 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
13553 @item @code{servers} (default: @var{%openntp-servers})
13554 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
13555 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
13556 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
13557 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
13558 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
13559 man-in-the-middle attacks.
13560 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
13561 a constraint.
13562 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
13563 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
13564 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
13565 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
13566 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
13567 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
13568 than 180 seconds.
13569 @end table
13570 @end deftp
13571
13572 @cindex inetd
13573 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
13574 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
13575 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
13576 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
13577 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
13578
13579 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
13580 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
13581 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
13582 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
13583 gateway @code{hostname}:
13584
13585 @lisp
13586 (service
13587 inetd-service-type
13588 (inetd-configuration
13589 (entries (list
13590 (inetd-entry
13591 (name "echo")
13592 (socket-type 'stream)
13593 (protocol "tcp")
13594 (wait? #f)
13595 (user "root"))
13596 (inetd-entry
13597 (node "127.0.0.1")
13598 (name "smtp")
13599 (socket-type 'stream)
13600 (protocol "tcp")
13601 (wait? #f)
13602 (user "root")
13603 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
13604 (arguments
13605 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
13606 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
13607 @end lisp
13608
13609 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
13610 @end deffn
13611
13612 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
13613 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
13614
13615 @table @asis
13616 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
13617 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
13618
13619 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
13620 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
13621 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
13622 @end table
13623 @end deftp
13624
13625 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
13626 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
13627 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
13628 requests.
13629
13630 @table @asis
13631 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
13632 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
13633 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
13634 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
13635 description of all options.
13636 @item @code{name}
13637 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
13638 @item @code{socket-type}
13639 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
13640 @code{'seqpacket}.
13641 @item @code{protocol}
13642 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
13643 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
13644 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
13645 listening to new service requests.
13646 @item @code{user}
13647 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
13648 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
13649 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
13650 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
13651 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
13652 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
13653 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
13654 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
13655 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
13656 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
13657 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
13658 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
13659 @end table
13660
13661 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
13662 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
13663 @end deftp
13664
13665 @cindex Tor
13666 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
13667 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
13668 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
13669 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
13670 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
13671
13672 @end defvr
13673
13674 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
13675 @table @asis
13676 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
13677 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
13678 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
13679 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
13680 implementation.
13681
13682 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
13683 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
13684 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
13685 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13686 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
13687 syntax.
13688
13689 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
13690 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
13691 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
13692 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
13693 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
13694 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
13695
13696 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
13697 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
13698 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
13699 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
13700 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
13701 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
13702 @code{tor} group.
13703
13704 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
13705 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
13706 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
13707 @code{SocksPort} option.
13708 @end table
13709 @end deftp
13710
13711 @cindex hidden service
13712 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
13713 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
13714 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
13715
13716 @example
13717 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
13718 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
13719 @end example
13720
13721 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
13722 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
13723
13724 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
13725 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
13726 service.
13727
13728 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
13729 project's documentation} for more information.
13730 @end deffn
13731
13732 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
13733
13734 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
13735 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
13736 files.
13737
13738 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
13739 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
13740 The value for this service type is a
13741 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
13742
13743 @lisp
13744 (service rsync-service-type)
13745 @end lisp
13746
13747 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
13748 @end deffn
13749
13750 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
13751 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
13752
13753 @table @asis
13754 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
13755 @code{rsync} package to use.
13756
13757 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
13758 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
13759 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
13760 @code{root} user and group.
13761
13762 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
13763 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
13764
13765 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
13766 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
13767
13768 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
13769 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
13770
13771 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
13772 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
13773
13774 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
13775 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13776
13777 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
13778 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13779
13780 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
13781 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
13782
13783 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
13784 I/O timeout in seconds.
13785
13786 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
13787 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
13788
13789 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
13790 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
13791
13792 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13793 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
13794 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
13795
13796 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13797 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
13798
13799 @end table
13800 @end deftp
13801
13802 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
13803 @cindex SSH
13804 @cindex SSH server
13805
13806 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
13807 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
13808 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
13809 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
13810 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
13811 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
13812 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
13813 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
13814 only by root.
13815
13816 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
13817 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
13818 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
13819 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
13820 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
13821
13822 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
13823 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
13824 require interaction.
13825
13826 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
13827 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
13828 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
13829 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
13830
13831 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
13832 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
13833 or addresses.
13834
13835 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
13836 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
13837 root.
13838
13839 The other options should be self-descriptive.
13840 @end deffn
13841
13842 @cindex SSH
13843 @cindex SSH server
13844 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
13845 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
13846 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
13847 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
13848
13849 @lisp
13850 (service openssh-service-type
13851 (openssh-configuration
13852 (x11-forwarding? #t)
13853 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
13854 (authorized-keys
13855 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
13856 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
13857 @end lisp
13858
13859 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
13860
13861 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
13862 example:
13863
13864 @lisp
13865 (service-extension openssh-service-type
13866 (const `(("charlie"
13867 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
13868 @end lisp
13869 @end deffn
13870
13871 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
13872 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
13873
13874 @table @asis
13875 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
13876 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
13877
13878 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
13879 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
13880
13881 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
13882 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
13883 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
13884 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
13885 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
13886
13887 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13888 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
13889 not.
13890
13891 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13892 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
13893 other authentication methods.
13894
13895 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13896 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
13897 false, users have to use other authentication method.
13898
13899 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13900 This is used only by protocol version 2.
13901
13902 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
13903 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
13904 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
13905 @option{-Y} will work.
13906
13907 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13908 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
13909
13910 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13911 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
13912
13913 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
13914 Whether to allow gateway ports.
13915
13916 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
13917 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
13918 PAM).
13919
13920 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
13921 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
13922 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
13923 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
13924 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
13925 module processing for all authentication types.
13926
13927 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
13928 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
13929 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
13930 @code{password-authentication?}.
13931
13932 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
13933 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
13934 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
13935
13936 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
13937 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
13938
13939 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
13940 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
13941 subsystem request.
13942
13943 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
13944 server. Alternately, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
13945 @lisp
13946 (service openssh-service-type
13947 (openssh-configuration
13948 (subsystems
13949 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
13950 @end lisp
13951
13952 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
13953 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
13954
13955 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
13956 @code{man sshd_config}.
13957
13958 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @code{COLORTERM} variable.
13959 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
13960 your shell's ressource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
13961 if this variable is set.
13962
13963 @lisp
13964 (service openssh-service-type
13965 (openssh-configuration
13966 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
13967 @end lisp
13968
13969 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
13970 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
13971 @cindex SSH authorized keys
13972 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
13973 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
13974 keys. For example:
13975
13976 @lisp
13977 (openssh-configuration
13978 (authorized-keys
13979 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
13980 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
13981 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
13982 @end lisp
13983
13984 @noindent
13985 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
13986 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
13987
13988 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
13989 @code{service-extension}.
13990
13991 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
13992 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13993
13994 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
13995 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
13996 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
13997 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
13998
13999 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
14000 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
14001 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
14002 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
14003 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
14004
14005 @lisp
14006 (openssh-configuration
14007 (extra-content "\
14008 Match Address 192.168.0.1
14009 PermitRootLogin yes"))
14010 @end lisp
14011
14012 @end table
14013 @end deftp
14014
14015 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
14016 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
14017 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
14018 object.
14019
14020 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
14021 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
14022
14023 @lisp
14024 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
14025 (port-number 1234)))
14026 @end lisp
14027 @end deffn
14028
14029 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
14030 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
14031
14032 @table @asis
14033 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
14034 The Dropbear package to use.
14035
14036 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
14037 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
14038
14039 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
14040 Whether to enable syslog output.
14041
14042 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
14043 File name of the daemon's PID file.
14044
14045 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14046 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
14047
14048 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
14049 Whether to allow empty passwords.
14050
14051 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
14052 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
14053 @end table
14054 @end deftp
14055
14056 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
14057 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
14058 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
14059 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
14060 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
14061 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
14062
14063 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
14064 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14065 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
14066
14067 @lisp
14068 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
14069
14070 (operating-system
14071 (host-name "mymachine")
14072 ;; ...
14073 (hosts-file
14074 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
14075 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
14076 (plain-file "hosts"
14077 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
14078 %facebook-host-aliases))))
14079 @end lisp
14080
14081 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
14082 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
14083 @end defvr
14084
14085 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
14086
14087 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
14088 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
14089 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
14090 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
14091 Its value must be a @code{zero-configuration} record---see below.
14092
14093 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
14094 resolve @code{.local} host names using
14095 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
14096 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
14097
14098 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
14099 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
14100 @end defvr
14101
14102 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
14103 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
14104
14105 @table @asis
14106
14107 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
14108 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
14109 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
14110
14111 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
14112 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
14113 network.
14114
14115 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
14116 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
14117 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
14118 your local network, you can run:
14119
14120 @example
14121 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
14122 @end example
14123
14124 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
14125 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
14126
14127 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
14128 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
14129 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
14130
14131 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
14132 This is a list of domains to browse.
14133 @end table
14134 @end deftp
14135
14136 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
14137 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
14138 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
14139 object.
14140 @end deffn
14141
14142 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
14143 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
14144 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
14145 through programmatic extension.
14146
14147 @table @asis
14148 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
14149 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
14150
14151 @end table
14152 @end deftp
14153
14154 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
14155 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
14156 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
14157 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
14158 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
14159
14160 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
14161
14162 @lisp
14163 (service pagekite-service-type
14164 (pagekite-configuration
14165 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
14166 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
14167 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
14168 @end lisp
14169 @end defvr
14170
14171 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
14172 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
14173
14174 @table @asis
14175 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
14176 Package object of PageKite.
14177
14178 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
14179 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
14180
14181 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
14182 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
14183 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
14184
14185 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
14186 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
14187 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
14188
14189 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
14190 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
14191 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
14192
14193 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
14194 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
14195 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
14196
14197 @end table
14198 @end deftp
14199
14200 @node X Window
14201 @subsection X Window
14202
14203 @cindex X11
14204 @cindex X Window System
14205 @cindex login manager
14206 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
14207 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
14208 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
14209 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
14210
14211 @cindex GDM
14212 @cindex GNOME, login manager
14213 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
14214 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
14215 features such as automatic screen locking.
14216
14217 @cindex window manager
14218 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
14219 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
14220 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
14221 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
14222
14223 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
14224 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
14225 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
14226 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
14227 (see below.)
14228
14229 @cindex session types (X11)
14230 @cindex X11 session types
14231 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
14232 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
14233 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
14234 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
14235 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
14236
14237 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
14238 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
14239 and/or other X clients.
14240 @end defvr
14241
14242 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
14243 @table @asis
14244 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14245 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
14246 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
14247
14248 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
14249 @code{default-user}.
14250
14251 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
14252 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
14253
14254 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
14255 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
14256
14257 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14258 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14259
14260 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
14261 Script to run before starting a X session.
14262
14263 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
14264 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
14265
14266 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
14267 The GDM package to use.
14268 @end table
14269 @end deftp
14270
14271 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
14272 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
14273
14274 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
14275 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
14276 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
14277
14278 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
14279 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
14280 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
14281 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
14282 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
14283 and tty8.
14284
14285 @lisp
14286 (use-modules (gnu services)
14287 (gnu services desktop)
14288 (gnu services xorg)
14289 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
14290
14291 (operating-system
14292 ;; ...
14293 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
14294 (display ":0")
14295 (vt "vt7")))
14296 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
14297 (display ":1")
14298 (vt "vt8")))
14299 (remove (lambda (service)
14300 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
14301 %desktop-services))))
14302 @end lisp
14303
14304 @end defvr
14305
14306 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
14307 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
14308
14309 @table @asis
14310 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
14311 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
14312
14313 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14314 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
14315 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
14316
14317 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
14318 @code{default-user}.
14319
14320 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
14321 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
14322 The graphical theme to use and its name.
14323
14324 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
14325 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
14326 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
14327
14328 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
14329 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
14330 will be used.
14331
14332 @quotation Note
14333 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
14334 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
14335 false, you will be unable to log in.
14336 @end quotation
14337
14338 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14339 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14340
14341 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
14342 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
14343
14344 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
14345 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
14346
14347 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
14348 The XAuth package to use.
14349
14350 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
14351 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
14352 @command{reboot}.
14353
14354 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
14355 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
14356
14357 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
14358 The SLiM package to use.
14359 @end table
14360 @end deftp
14361
14362 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
14363 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
14364 The default SLiM theme and its name.
14365 @end defvr
14366
14367
14368 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
14369 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
14370
14371 @table @asis
14372 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
14373 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
14374 or "wayland".
14375
14376 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
14377 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
14378
14379 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
14380 Command to run when halting.
14381
14382 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
14383 Command to run when rebooting.
14384
14385 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
14386 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
14387
14388 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
14389 Directory to look for themes.
14390
14391 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
14392 Directory to look for faces.
14393
14394 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
14395 Default PATH to use.
14396
14397 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
14398 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
14399
14400 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
14401 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
14402
14403 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
14404 Remember last user.
14405
14406 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
14407 Remember last session.
14408
14409 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
14410 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
14411
14412 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
14413 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
14414
14415 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
14416 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
14417
14418 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
14419 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
14420
14421 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14422 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14423
14424 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
14425 Path to xauth.
14426
14427 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
14428 Path to Xephyr.
14429
14430 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
14431 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
14432
14433 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
14434 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
14435
14436 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
14437 Script to run before starting a X session.
14438
14439 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
14440 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
14441
14442 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
14443 Minimum VT to use.
14444
14445 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
14446 User to use for auto-login.
14447
14448 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
14449 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
14450
14451 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
14452 Relogin after logout.
14453
14454 @end table
14455 @end deftp
14456
14457 @cindex login manager
14458 @cindex X11 login
14459 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
14460 This is the type of the service to run the
14461 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SSDM display manager}. Its value
14462 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
14463
14464 Here's an example use:
14465
14466 @lisp
14467 (service sddm-service-type
14468 (sddm-configuration
14469 (auto-login-user "alice")
14470 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
14471 @end lisp
14472 @end defvr
14473
14474 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
14475 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
14476 The available fields are:
14477
14478 @table @asis
14479 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
14480 The SDDM package to use.
14481
14482 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
14483 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
14484
14485 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
14486
14487 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
14488 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
14489 automatically.
14490
14491 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
14492 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
14493 auto-login session.
14494 @end table
14495 @end deftp
14496
14497 @cindex Xorg, configuration
14498 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
14499 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
14500 server. Note that there is not Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
14501 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
14502 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
14503
14504 @table @asis
14505 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
14506 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
14507 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
14508
14509 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
14510 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
14511
14512 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
14513 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
14514 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
14515 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
14516
14517 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
14518 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
14519 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
14520 768) (640 480))}.
14521
14522 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
14523 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
14524 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
14525 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
14526 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
14527
14528 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
14529 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
14530 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
14531
14532 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
14533 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
14534 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
14535
14536 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
14537 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
14538
14539 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
14540 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
14541 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
14542 @end table
14543 @end deftp
14544
14545 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
14546 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
14547 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
14548 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
14549
14550 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
14551 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
14552 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
14553 @end deffn
14554
14555 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
14556 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
14557 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
14558 @code{startx}.
14559
14560 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
14561 @end deffn
14562
14563
14564 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
14565 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
14566 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
14567 for it. For example:
14568
14569 @lisp
14570 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
14571 @end lisp
14572
14573 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
14574 @end deffn
14575
14576
14577 @node Printing Services
14578 @subsection Printing Services
14579
14580 @cindex printer support with CUPS
14581 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
14582 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
14583 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
14584
14585 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
14586 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
14587 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
14588 write:
14589 @lisp
14590 (service cups-service-type)
14591 @end lisp
14592 @end deffn
14593
14594 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
14595 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
14596 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
14597 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
14598 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
14599 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
14600 secure connections to the print server.
14601
14602 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
14603 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
14604 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package. You can do that directly,
14605 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
14606
14607 @lisp
14608 (service cups-service-type
14609 (cups-configuration
14610 (web-interface? #t)
14611 (extensions
14612 (list cups-filters escpr hplip-minimal))))
14613 @end lisp
14614
14615 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
14616 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
14617 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
14618
14619 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
14620 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
14621 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
14622 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
14623 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
14624 from some other system; see the end for more details.
14625
14626 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
14627 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
14628 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
14629 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
14630 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
14631 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
14632 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
14633
14634
14635 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
14636
14637 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
14638 The CUPS package.
14639 @end deftypevr
14640
14641 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
14642 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
14643 @end deftypevr
14644
14645 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
14646 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
14647 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
14648
14649 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
14650
14651 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
14652 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14653 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14654 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14655 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14656 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14657 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14658 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
14659
14660 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
14661 @end deftypevr
14662
14663 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
14664 Where CUPS should cache data.
14665
14666 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
14667 @end deftypevr
14668
14669 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
14670 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
14671 writes.
14672
14673 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
14674 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
14675 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
14676 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
14677 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
14678
14679 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
14680 @end deftypevr
14681
14682 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
14683 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14684 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14685 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14686 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14687 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14688 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14689 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
14690
14691 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
14692 @end deftypevr
14693
14694 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
14695 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
14696 kind strings are:
14697
14698 @table @code
14699 @item none
14700 No errors are fatal.
14701
14702 @item all
14703 All of the errors below are fatal.
14704
14705 @item browse
14706 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
14707 to the DNS-SD daemon.
14708
14709 @item config
14710 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
14711
14712 @item listen
14713 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
14714 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
14715
14716 @item log
14717 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
14718
14719 @item permissions
14720 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
14721 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
14722 @end table
14723
14724 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
14725 @end deftypevr
14726
14727 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
14728 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
14729 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
14730
14731 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14732 @end deftypevr
14733
14734 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
14735 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
14736 programs.
14737
14738 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14739 @end deftypevr
14740
14741 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
14742 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
14743
14744 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
14745 @end deftypevr
14746
14747 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
14748 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14749 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14750 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14751 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14752 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14753 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14754 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
14755
14756 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
14757 @end deftypevr
14758
14759 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
14760 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
14761 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
14762
14763 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
14764 @end deftypevr
14765
14766 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
14767 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
14768 data.
14769
14770 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
14771 @end deftypevr
14772
14773 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
14774 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
14775 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
14776 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
14777 used/supported on macOS.
14778
14779 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
14780 @end deftypevr
14781
14782 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
14783 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
14784 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
14785 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
14786 PEM-encoded private keys.
14787
14788 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
14789 @end deftypevr
14790
14791 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
14792 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
14793
14794 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
14795 @end deftypevr
14796
14797 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
14798 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
14799 configuration or state files.
14800
14801 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14802 @end deftypevr
14803
14804 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
14805 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
14806 @end deftypevr
14807
14808 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
14809 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
14810
14811 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
14812 @end deftypevr
14813
14814 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
14815 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
14816 programs.
14817
14818 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14819 @end deftypevr
14820
14821 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
14822 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
14823
14824 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
14825 @end deftypevr
14826 @end deftypevr
14827
14828 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
14829 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
14830 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
14831 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
14832 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
14833 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
14834 level logs all requests.
14835
14836 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
14837 @end deftypevr
14838
14839 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
14840 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
14841 longer required for quotas.
14842
14843 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14844 @end deftypevr
14845
14846 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
14847 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
14848 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
14849 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
14850
14851 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
14852 @end deftypevr
14853
14854 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
14855 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
14856
14857 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
14858 @end deftypevr
14859
14860 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
14861 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
14862
14863 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14864 @end deftypevr
14865
14866 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
14867 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
14868
14869 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14870 @end deftypevr
14871
14872 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
14873 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
14874 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
14875 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
14876 secure printing functions.
14877
14878 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14879 @end deftypevr
14880
14881 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
14882 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
14883 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
14884
14885 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14886 @end deftypevr
14887
14888 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
14889 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
14890
14891 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
14892 @end deftypevr
14893
14894 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
14895 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
14896
14897 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
14898 @end deftypevr
14899
14900 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
14901 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
14902
14903 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
14904 @end deftypevr
14905
14906 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
14907 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
14908 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
14909 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
14910 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
14911
14912 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
14913 @end deftypevr
14914
14915 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
14916 Specifies the default access policy to use.
14917
14918 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
14919 @end deftypevr
14920
14921 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
14922 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
14923
14924 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14925 @end deftypevr
14926
14927 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
14928 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
14929 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
14930 typically within a few milliseconds.
14931
14932 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14933 @end deftypevr
14934
14935 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
14936 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
14937 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
14938 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
14939 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
14940 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
14941
14942 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
14943 @end deftypevr
14944
14945 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
14946 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
14947 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
14948 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
14949 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
14950 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
14951 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
14952 at any time.
14953
14954 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14955 @end deftypevr
14956
14957 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
14958 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
14959 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
14960 lowest priority.
14961
14962 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14963 @end deftypevr
14964
14965 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
14966 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
14967 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
14968 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
14969 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
14970 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
14971 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
14972
14973 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14974 @end deftypevr
14975
14976 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
14977 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
14978 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
14979
14980 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14981 @end deftypevr
14982
14983 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
14984 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
14985 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14986 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14987 @code{retry-current-job}.
14988
14989 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14990 @end deftypevr
14991
14992 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
14993 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
14994 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14995 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14996 @code{retry-current-job}.
14997
14998 Defaults to @samp{5}.
14999 @end deftypevr
15000
15001 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
15002 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
15003
15004 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15005 @end deftypevr
15006
15007 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
15008 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
15009
15010 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15011 @end deftypevr
15012
15013 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
15014 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
15015 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
15016
15017 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15018 @end deftypevr
15019
15020 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
15021 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
15022 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
15023 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
15024 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
15025 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
15026 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
15027 @end deftypevr
15028
15029 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
15030 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
15031 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
15032 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
15033 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
15034 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
15035 ones.
15036
15037 Defaults to @samp{128}.
15038 @end deftypevr
15039
15040 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
15041 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
15042
15043 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
15044
15045 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
15046 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
15047 @end deftypevr
15048
15049 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
15050 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
15051 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
15052
15053 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15054 @end deftypevr
15055
15056 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
15057 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
15058
15059 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15060
15061 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
15062
15063 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
15064 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
15065 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
15066
15067 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15068 @end deftypevr
15069
15070 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
15071 Methods to which this access control applies.
15072
15073 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15074 @end deftypevr
15075
15076 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
15077 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
15078 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
15079
15080 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15081 @end deftypevr
15082 @end deftypevr
15083 @end deftypevr
15084
15085 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
15086 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
15087 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
15088 of the LogLevel setting.
15089
15090 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15091 @end deftypevr
15092
15093 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
15094 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
15095 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
15096
15097 Defaults to @samp{info}.
15098 @end deftypevr
15099
15100 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
15101 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
15102 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
15103
15104 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
15105 @end deftypevr
15106
15107 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
15108 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
15109 the scheduler.
15110
15111 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15112 @end deftypevr
15113
15114 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
15115 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
15116 from a single address.
15117
15118 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15119 @end deftypevr
15120
15121 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
15122 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
15123 job.
15124
15125 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
15126 @end deftypevr
15127
15128 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
15129 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
15130 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
15131 held jobs.
15132
15133 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15134 @end deftypevr
15135
15136 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
15137 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
15138 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
15139
15140 Defaults to @samp{500}.
15141 @end deftypevr
15142
15143 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
15144 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
15145 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
15146
15147 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15148 @end deftypevr
15149
15150 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
15151 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
15152 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
15153
15154 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15155 @end deftypevr
15156
15157 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
15158 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
15159 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
15160
15161 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
15162 @end deftypevr
15163
15164 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
15165 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
15166 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
15167
15168 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
15169 @end deftypevr
15170
15171 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
15172 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
15173 multiple file print job, in seconds.
15174
15175 Defaults to @samp{300}.
15176 @end deftypevr
15177
15178 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
15179 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
15180 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
15181 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
15182 sequences are recognized:
15183
15184 @table @samp
15185 @item %%
15186 insert a single percent character
15187
15188 @item %@{name@}
15189 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
15190
15191 @item %C
15192 insert the number of copies for the current page
15193
15194 @item %P
15195 insert the current page number
15196
15197 @item %T
15198 insert the current date and time in common log format
15199
15200 @item %j
15201 insert the job ID
15202
15203 @item %p
15204 insert the printer name
15205
15206 @item %u
15207 insert the username
15208 @end table
15209
15210 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
15211 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
15212 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
15213 standard items.
15214
15215 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15216 @end deftypevr
15217
15218 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
15219 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
15220 of strings.
15221
15222 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15223 @end deftypevr
15224
15225 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
15226 Specifies named access control policies.
15227
15228 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
15229
15230 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
15231 Name of the policy.
15232 @end deftypevr
15233
15234 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
15235 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
15236 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
15237 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
15238 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
15239 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
15240 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
15241 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
15242 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
15243 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
15244
15245 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
15246 @end deftypevr
15247
15248 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
15249 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
15250 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
15251
15252 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
15253 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
15254 @end deftypevr
15255
15256 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
15257 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
15258 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
15259 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
15260 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
15261 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
15262 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
15263 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
15264 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
15265 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
15266
15267 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
15268 @end deftypevr
15269
15270 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
15271 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
15272 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
15273
15274 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
15275 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
15276 @end deftypevr
15277
15278 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
15279 Access control by IPP operation.
15280
15281 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15282 @end deftypevr
15283 @end deftypevr
15284
15285 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
15286 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
15287 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
15288 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
15289 value applies indefinitely.
15290
15291 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
15292 @end deftypevr
15293
15294 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
15295 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
15296 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
15297 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
15298 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
15299
15300 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15301 @end deftypevr
15302
15303 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
15304 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
15305 restarting the scheduler.
15306
15307 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15308 @end deftypevr
15309
15310 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
15311 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
15312 into bitmaps for a printer.
15313
15314 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
15315 @end deftypevr
15316
15317 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
15318 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
15319
15320 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
15321 @end deftypevr
15322
15323 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
15324 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
15325 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
15326 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
15327 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
15328 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
15329 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
15330 @code{*}.
15331
15332 Defaults to @samp{*}.
15333 @end deftypevr
15334
15335 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
15336 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
15337
15338 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
15339 @end deftypevr
15340
15341 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
15342 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
15343 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
15344 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
15345 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
15346 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
15347 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
15348 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
15349
15350 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
15351 @end deftypevr
15352
15353 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
15354 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
15355 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
15356 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
15357 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
15358
15359 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15360 @end deftypevr
15361
15362 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
15363 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
15364 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
15365 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
15366 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
15367 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
15368 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
15369 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
15370 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
15371 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
15372
15373 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15374 @end deftypevr
15375
15376 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
15377 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
15378 the IPP specifications.
15379
15380 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15381 @end deftypevr
15382
15383 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
15384 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
15385
15386 Defaults to @samp{300}.
15387
15388 @end deftypevr
15389
15390 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
15391 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
15392
15393 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15394 @end deftypevr
15395
15396 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
15397 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
15398 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
15399 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
15400 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
15401 @code{cups-service-type}.
15402
15403 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
15404
15405 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
15406 The CUPS package.
15407 @end deftypevr
15408
15409 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
15410 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
15411 @end deftypevr
15412
15413 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
15414 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
15415 @end deftypevr
15416
15417 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
15418 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
15419 this:
15420
15421 @lisp
15422 (service cups-service-type
15423 (opaque-cups-configuration
15424 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
15425 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
15426 @end lisp
15427
15428
15429 @node Desktop Services
15430 @subsection Desktop Services
15431
15432 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
15433 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
15434 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
15435 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
15436 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
15437
15438 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
15439 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
15440 environment and networking:
15441
15442 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
15443 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
15444 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
15445
15446 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
15447 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
15448 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
15449 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
15450 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
15451 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
15452 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
15453 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
15454 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
15455 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
15456 @end defvr
15457
15458 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
15459 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
15460 Reference, @code{services}}).
15461
15462 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
15463 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type} and
15464 @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type} procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE
15465 and/or Enlightenment to a system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level
15466 services like the backlight adjustment helpers and the power management
15467 utilities are added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
15468 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
15469 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
15470 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds the GNOME
15471 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce service
15472 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
15473 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
15474 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
15475 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
15476 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
15477 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
15478 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
15479 adding a service of type @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE
15480 metapackage to the system profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that
15481 @code{dbus} is extended appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries
15482 are set as setuid, allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other
15483 functionality to work as expetected.
15484
15485 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
15486 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
15487 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
15488 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
15489 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
15490 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
15491 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
15492 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
15493
15494 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
15495 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
15496 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
15497 object (see below.)
15498
15499 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
15500 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
15501 @end defvr
15502
15503 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
15504 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
15505
15506 @table @asis
15507 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
15508 The GNOME package to use.
15509 @end table
15510 @end deftp
15511
15512 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
15513 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
15514 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
15515 (see below.)
15516
15517 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
15518 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
15519 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
15520 with the administrator's password.
15521 @end defvr
15522
15523 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
15524 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
15525
15526 @table @asis
15527 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
15528 The Xfce package to use.
15529 @end table
15530 @end deftp
15531
15532 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
15533 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
15534 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
15535 object (see below.)
15536
15537 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
15538 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
15539 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
15540 @end deffn
15541
15542 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
15543 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
15544
15545 @table @asis
15546 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
15547 The MATE package to use.
15548 @end table
15549 @end deftp
15550
15551 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
15552 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
15553 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
15554 @end deffn
15555
15556 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
15557 @table @asis
15558 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
15559 The enlightenment package to use.
15560 @end table
15561 @end deftp
15562
15563 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
15564 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
15565 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
15566 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
15567 @code{operating-system}:
15568
15569 @lisp
15570 (use-modules (gnu))
15571 (use-service-modules desktop)
15572 (operating-system
15573 ...
15574 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
15575 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
15576 (service xfce-desktop-service)
15577 %desktop-services))
15578 ...)
15579 @end lisp
15580
15581 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
15582 graphical login window.
15583
15584 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
15585 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
15586 are described below.
15587
15588 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
15589 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
15590 support for @var{services}.
15591
15592 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
15593 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
15594 and to be notified of system-wide events.
15595
15596 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
15597 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
15598 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
15599 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
15600 @end deffn
15601
15602 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
15603 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
15604 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
15605 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
15606 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
15607 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
15608
15609 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
15610 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
15611 when the power button is pressed.
15612
15613 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
15614 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
15615 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
15616 their default values are:
15617
15618 @table @code
15619 @item kill-user-processes?
15620 @code{#f}
15621 @item kill-only-users
15622 @code{()}
15623 @item kill-exclude-users
15624 @code{("root")}
15625 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
15626 @code{5}
15627 @item handle-power-key
15628 @code{poweroff}
15629 @item handle-suspend-key
15630 @code{suspend}
15631 @item handle-hibernate-key
15632 @code{hibernate}
15633 @item handle-lid-switch
15634 @code{suspend}
15635 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
15636 @code{ignore}
15637 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
15638 @code{#f}
15639 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
15640 @code{#f}
15641 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
15642 @code{#f}
15643 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
15644 @code{#t}
15645 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
15646 @code{30}
15647 @item idle-action
15648 @code{ignore}
15649 @item idle-action-seconds
15650 @code{(* 30 60)}
15651 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
15652 @code{10}
15653 @item runtime-directory-size
15654 @code{#f}
15655 @item remove-ipc?
15656 @code{#t}
15657 @item suspend-state
15658 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
15659 @item suspend-mode
15660 @code{()}
15661 @item hibernate-state
15662 @code{("disk")}
15663 @item hibernate-mode
15664 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
15665 @item hybrid-sleep-state
15666 @code{("disk")}
15667 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
15668 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
15669 @end table
15670 @end deffn
15671
15672 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
15673 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
15674 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
15675 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
15676 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
15677 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
15678 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
15679 accountsservice web site} for more information.
15680
15681 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
15682 package to expose as a service.
15683 @end deffn
15684
15685 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
15686 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
15687 Return a service that runs the
15688 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
15689 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
15690 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
15691 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
15692 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
15693 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
15694 @end deffn
15695
15696 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
15697 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
15698 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
15699 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
15700 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
15701 @end defvr
15702
15703 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
15704 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
15705 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
15706 configuration settings.
15707
15708 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
15709 notably used by GNOME.
15710 @end defvr
15711
15712 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
15713 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
15714
15715 @table @asis
15716
15717 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
15718 Package to use for @code{upower}.
15719
15720 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
15721 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
15722
15723 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
15724 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
15725
15726 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
15727 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
15728
15729 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
15730 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
15731 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
15732
15733 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
15734 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15735 at which the battery is considered low.
15736
15737 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
15738 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15739 at which the battery is considered critical.
15740
15741 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
15742 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15743 at which action will be taken.
15744
15745 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
15746 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15747 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
15748
15749 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
15750 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15751 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
15752
15753 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
15754 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15755 seconds at which action will be taken.
15756
15757 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
15758 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
15759 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
15760
15761 Possible values are:
15762
15763 @itemize @bullet
15764 @item
15765 @code{'power-off}
15766
15767 @item
15768 @code{'hibernate}
15769
15770 @item
15771 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
15772 @end itemize
15773
15774 @end table
15775 @end deftp
15776
15777 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
15778 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
15779 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
15780 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
15781 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
15782 @end deffn
15783
15784 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
15785 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
15786 service with a D-Bus
15787 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
15788 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
15789 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
15790 site} for more information.
15791 @end deffn
15792
15793 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
15794 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
15795 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
15796 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
15797 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
15798 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
15799 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
15800 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
15801 means that all users are allowed.
15802 @end deffn
15803
15804 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
15805 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
15806 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
15807 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
15808 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
15809 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
15810 know the user's location.
15811 @end defvr
15812
15813 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
15814 [#:whitelist '()] @
15815 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
15816 [#:submit-data? #f]
15817 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
15818 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
15819 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
15820 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
15821 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
15822 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
15823 location databases. See
15824 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
15825 web site} for more information.
15826 @end deffn
15827
15828 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
15829 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
15830 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
15831 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
15832 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
15833 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
15834 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
15835
15836 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
15837 @end deffn
15838
15839 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
15840 This is the type of the service that adds the
15841 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
15842 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below.)
15843
15844 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
15845 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
15846 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
15847 @end defvr
15848
15849 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
15850 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
15851
15852 @table @asis
15853 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
15854 The GNOME keyring package to use.
15855
15856 @item @code{pam-services}
15857 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
15858 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
15859 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
15860 @code{passwd}.
15861
15862 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
15863 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
15864 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
15865 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
15866 without arguments.
15867
15868 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
15869 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
15870 @end table
15871 @end deftp
15872
15873
15874 @node Sound Services
15875 @subsection Sound Services
15876
15877 @cindex sound support
15878 @cindex ALSA
15879 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
15880
15881 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
15882 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
15883 preferred ALSA output driver.
15884
15885 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
15886 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
15887 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
15888 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
15889 record as in this example:
15890
15891 @lisp
15892 (service alsa-service-type)
15893 @end lisp
15894
15895 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
15896 @end deffn
15897
15898 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
15899 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
15900
15901 @table @asis
15902 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
15903 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
15904
15905 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
15906 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
15907 @uref{http://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
15908
15909 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
15910 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
15911 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
15912
15913 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
15914 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
15915
15916 @end table
15917 @end deftp
15918
15919 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
15920 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
15921
15922 @example
15923 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
15924 pcm_type.jack @{
15925 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
15926 @}
15927
15928 # Routing ALSA to jack:
15929 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
15930 pcm.rawjack @{
15931 type jack
15932 playback_ports @{
15933 0 system:playback_1
15934 1 system:playback_2
15935 @}
15936
15937 capture_ports @{
15938 0 system:capture_1
15939 1 system:capture_2
15940 @}
15941 @}
15942
15943 pcm.!default @{
15944 type plug
15945 slave @{
15946 pcm "rawjack"
15947 @}
15948 @}
15949 @end example
15950
15951 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
15952 details.
15953
15954 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
15955 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
15956 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
15957
15958 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
15959 @code{swh-plugins} package:
15960
15961 @lisp
15962 (service ladspa-service-type
15963 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
15964 @end lisp
15965
15966 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
15967 details.
15968
15969 @end deffn
15970
15971 @node Database Services
15972 @subsection Database Services
15973
15974 @cindex database
15975 @cindex SQL
15976 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
15977
15978 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
15979 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
15980 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8''] [#:extension-packages '()]
15981 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
15982 server.
15983
15984 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
15985 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
15986 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
15987
15988 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
15989 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
15990 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
15991 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
15992 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
15993
15994 @cindex postgis
15995 @lisp
15996 (use-package-modules databases geo)
15997
15998 (operating-system
15999 ...
16000 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
16001 ;; proper operation.
16002 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
16003 (services
16004 (cons*
16005 (postgresql-service #:extension-packages (list postgis))
16006 %base-services)))
16007 @end lisp
16008
16009 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
16010 database in this way:
16011
16012 @example
16013 psql -U postgres
16014 > create database postgistest;
16015 > \connect postgistest;
16016 > create extension postgis;
16017 > create extension postgis_topology;
16018 @end example
16019
16020 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
16021 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
16022 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
16023 @end deffn
16024
16025 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
16026 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
16027 database server.
16028
16029 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
16030 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
16031 @end deffn
16032
16033 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
16034 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
16035
16036 @table @asis
16037 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
16038 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
16039 or @var{mysql}.
16040
16041 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
16042 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
16043
16044 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
16045 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
16046 @end table
16047 @end deftp
16048
16049 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
16050 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
16051 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
16052 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
16053 @end defvr
16054
16055 @lisp
16056 (service memcached-service-type)
16057 @end lisp
16058
16059 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
16060 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
16061
16062 @table @asis
16063 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
16064 The Memcached package to use.
16065
16066 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
16067 Network interfaces on which to listen.
16068
16069 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
16070 Port on which to accept connections on,
16071
16072 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
16073 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
16074 listening on a UDP socket.
16075
16076 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
16077 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
16078 @end table
16079 @end deftp
16080
16081 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
16082 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
16083 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
16084 @end defvr
16085
16086 @lisp
16087 (service mongodb-service-type)
16088 @end lisp
16089
16090 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
16091 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
16092
16093 @table @asis
16094 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
16095 The MongoDB package to use.
16096
16097 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
16098 The configuration file for MongoDB.
16099
16100 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
16101 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
16102 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
16103 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
16104 @end table
16105 @end deftp
16106
16107 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
16108 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
16109 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
16110 @end defvr
16111
16112 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
16113 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
16114
16115 @table @asis
16116 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
16117 The Redis package to use.
16118
16119 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
16120 Network interface on which to listen.
16121
16122 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
16123 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
16124 listening on a TCP socket.
16125
16126 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
16127 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
16128 @end table
16129 @end deftp
16130
16131 @node Mail Services
16132 @subsection Mail Services
16133
16134 @cindex mail
16135 @cindex email
16136 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
16137 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
16138 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
16139 in the subsections below.
16140
16141 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
16142
16143 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
16144 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
16145 @end deffn
16146
16147 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
16148 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
16149 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
16150 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
16151 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
16152 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
16153 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
16154 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
16155
16156 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
16157 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
16158
16159 @lisp
16160 (dovecot-service #:config
16161 (dovecot-configuration
16162 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
16163 @end lisp
16164
16165 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
16166 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
16167 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
16168 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
16169 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
16170 from some other system; see the end for more details.
16171
16172 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
16173 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
16174 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
16175 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
16176 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
16177 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
16178 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
16179
16180 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
16181
16182 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
16183 The dovecot package.
16184 @end deftypevr
16185
16186 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
16187 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
16188 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
16189 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
16190 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
16191 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
16192 @end deftypevr
16193
16194 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
16195 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
16196 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
16197
16198 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
16199
16200 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
16201 The name of the protocol.
16202 @end deftypevr
16203
16204 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
16205 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
16206 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
16207 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
16208 @end deftypevr
16209
16210 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
16211 Space separated list of plugins to load.
16212 @end deftypevr
16213
16214 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
16215 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
16216 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
16217 Defaults to @samp{10}.
16218 @end deftypevr
16219
16220 @end deftypevr
16221
16222 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
16223 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
16224 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
16225 @samp{lmtp}.
16226
16227 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
16228
16229 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
16230 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
16231 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
16232 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
16233 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
16234 @end deftypevr
16235
16236 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
16237 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
16238 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
16239 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
16240 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16241
16242 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
16243
16244 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
16245 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
16246 the section name.
16247 @end deftypevr
16248
16249 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
16250 The access mode for the socket.
16251 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
16252 @end deftypevr
16253
16254 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
16255 The user to own the socket.
16256 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16257 @end deftypevr
16258
16259 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
16260 The group to own the socket.
16261 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16262 @end deftypevr
16263
16264
16265 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
16266
16267 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
16268 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
16269 the section name.
16270 @end deftypevr
16271
16272 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
16273 The access mode for the socket.
16274 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
16275 @end deftypevr
16276
16277 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
16278 The user to own the socket.
16279 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16280 @end deftypevr
16281
16282 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
16283 The group to own the socket.
16284 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16285 @end deftypevr
16286
16287
16288 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
16289
16290 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
16291 The protocol to listen for.
16292 @end deftypevr
16293
16294 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
16295 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
16296 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16297 @end deftypevr
16298
16299 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
16300 The port on which to listen.
16301 @end deftypevr
16302
16303 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
16304 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
16305 @samp{required}.
16306 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16307 @end deftypevr
16308
16309 @end deftypevr
16310
16311 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
16312 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
16313 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
16314 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
16315 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
16316
16317 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16318
16319 @end deftypevr
16320
16321 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
16322 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
16323 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
16324 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
16325 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16326
16327 @end deftypevr
16328
16329 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
16330 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
16331 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
16332
16333 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16334
16335 @end deftypevr
16336
16337 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
16338 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
16339 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16340 @end deftypevr
16341
16342 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
16343 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
16344 this.
16345 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
16346 @end deftypevr
16347
16348 @end deftypevr
16349
16350 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
16351 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
16352 constructor.
16353
16354 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
16355
16356 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
16357 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
16358 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16359 @end deftypevr
16360
16361 @end deftypevr
16362
16363 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
16364 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
16365 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
16366
16367 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
16368
16369 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
16370 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
16371 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
16372 @samp{static}.
16373 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
16374 @end deftypevr
16375
16376 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
16377 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
16378 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16379 @end deftypevr
16380
16381 @end deftypevr
16382
16383 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
16384 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
16385 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
16386
16387 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
16388
16389 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
16390 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
16391 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
16392 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
16393 @end deftypevr
16394
16395 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
16396 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16397 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16398 @end deftypevr
16399
16400 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
16401 Override fields from passwd.
16402 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16403 @end deftypevr
16404
16405 @end deftypevr
16406
16407 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
16408 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
16409 constructor.
16410 @end deftypevr
16411
16412 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
16413 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
16414 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
16415
16416 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
16417
16418 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
16419 Name for this namespace.
16420 @end deftypevr
16421
16422 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
16423 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
16424 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
16425 @end deftypevr
16426
16427 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
16428 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
16429 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
16430 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
16431 format.
16432 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16433 @end deftypevr
16434
16435 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
16436 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
16437 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
16438 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16439 @end deftypevr
16440
16441 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
16442 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
16443 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
16444 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16445 @end deftypevr
16446
16447 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
16448 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
16449 namespace has it.
16450 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16451 @end deftypevr
16452
16453 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
16454 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
16455 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
16456 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
16457 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
16458 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
16459 and @samp{mail/}.
16460 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16461 @end deftypevr
16462
16463 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
16464 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
16465 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
16466 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
16467 hides the namespace prefix.
16468 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16469 @end deftypevr
16470
16471 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
16472 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
16473 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
16474 as @code{#t}).
16475 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16476 @end deftypevr
16477
16478 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
16479 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
16480 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16481
16482 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
16483
16484 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
16485 Name for this mailbox.
16486 @end deftypevr
16487
16488 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
16489 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
16490 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
16491 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16492 @end deftypevr
16493
16494 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
16495 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
16496 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
16497 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
16498 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16499 @end deftypevr
16500
16501 @end deftypevr
16502
16503 @end deftypevr
16504
16505 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
16506 Base directory where to store runtime data.
16507 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
16508 @end deftypevr
16509
16510 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
16511 Greeting message for clients.
16512 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
16513 @end deftypevr
16514
16515 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
16516 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
16517 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
16518 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
16519 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
16520 here.
16521 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16522 @end deftypevr
16523
16524 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
16525 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
16526 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16527 @end deftypevr
16528
16529 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
16530 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
16531 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
16532 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
16533 accounts).
16534 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16535 @end deftypevr
16536
16537 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
16538 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
16539 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
16540 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
16541 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
16542 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16543 @end deftypevr
16544
16545 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
16546 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
16547 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
16548 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16549 @end deftypevr
16550
16551 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
16552 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
16553 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
16554 @end deftypevr
16555
16556 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
16557 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
16558 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
16559 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
16560 @end deftypevr
16561
16562 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
16563 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
16564 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
16565 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
16566 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
16567 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
16568 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16569 @end deftypevr
16570
16571 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
16572 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
16573 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
16574 for caching to be used.
16575 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16576 @end deftypevr
16577
16578 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
16579 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
16580 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
16581 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
16582 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
16583 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
16584 authentication.
16585 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
16586 @end deftypevr
16587
16588 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
16589 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
16590 0 disables caching them completely.
16591 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
16592 @end deftypevr
16593
16594 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
16595 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
16596 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
16597 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
16598 realm first.
16599 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16600 @end deftypevr
16601
16602 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
16603 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
16604 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
16605 logins.
16606 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16607 @end deftypevr
16608
16609 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
16610 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
16611 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
16612 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
16613 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
16614 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
16615 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
16616 @end deftypevr
16617
16618 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
16619 Username character translations before it's looked up from
16620 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
16621 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
16622 translated to @samp{@@}.
16623 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16624 @end deftypevr
16625
16626 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
16627 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
16628 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
16629 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
16630 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
16631 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
16632 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
16633 @end deftypevr
16634
16635 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
16636 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
16637 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
16638 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
16639 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
16640 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
16641 choice.
16642 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16643 @end deftypevr
16644
16645 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
16646 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
16647 mechanism.
16648 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
16649 @end deftypevr
16650
16651 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
16652 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
16653 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
16654 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
16655 Defaults to @samp{30}.
16656 @end deftypevr
16657
16658 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
16659 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
16660 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
16661 allow all keytab entries.
16662 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16663 @end deftypevr
16664
16665 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
16666 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
16667 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
16668 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
16669 file.
16670 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16671 @end deftypevr
16672
16673 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
16674 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
16675 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
16676 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
16677 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16678 @end deftypevr
16679
16680 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
16681 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
16682 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
16683 @end deftypevr
16684
16685 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
16686 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
16687 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
16688 @end deftypevr
16689
16690 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
16691 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
16692 fails.
16693 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16694 @end deftypevr
16695
16696 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
16697 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
16698 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
16699 CommonName.
16700 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16701 @end deftypevr
16702
16703 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
16704 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
16705 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
16706 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
16707 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
16708 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
16709 @end deftypevr
16710
16711 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
16712 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
16713 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
16714 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
16715 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16716 @end deftypevr
16717
16718 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
16719 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
16720 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
16721 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16722 @end deftypevr
16723
16724 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
16725 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
16726 has any connections.
16727 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
16728 @end deftypevr
16729
16730 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
16731 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
16732 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
16733 are shared within domain.
16734 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
16735 @end deftypevr
16736
16737 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
16738 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
16739 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
16740 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
16741 @end deftypevr
16742
16743 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
16744 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
16745 @samp{log-path}.
16746 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16747 @end deftypevr
16748
16749 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
16750 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
16751 @samp{info-log-path}.
16752 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16753 @end deftypevr
16754
16755 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
16756 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
16757 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
16758 standard facilities are supported.
16759 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
16760 @end deftypevr
16761
16762 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
16763 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
16764 failed.
16765 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16766 @end deftypevr
16767
16768 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
16769 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
16770 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
16771 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
16772 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
16773 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
16774 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16775 @end deftypevr
16776
16777 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
16778 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
16779 SQL queries.
16780 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16781 @end deftypevr
16782
16783 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
16784 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
16785 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
16786 @samp{auth-debug}.
16787 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16788 @end deftypevr
16789
16790 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
16791 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
16792 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
16793 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16794 @end deftypevr
16795
16796 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
16797 Show protocol level SSL errors.
16798 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16799 @end deftypevr
16800
16801 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
16802 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
16803 strftime(3) format.
16804 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
16805 @end deftypevr
16806
16807 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
16808 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
16809 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
16810 string.
16811 @end deftypevr
16812
16813 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
16814 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
16815 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
16816 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
16817 @end deftypevr
16818
16819 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
16820 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
16821 of possible variables you can use.
16822 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
16823 @end deftypevr
16824
16825 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
16826 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
16827 @table @code
16828 @item %$
16829 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
16830 @item %m
16831 Message-ID
16832 @item %s
16833 Subject
16834 @item %f
16835 From address
16836 @item %p
16837 Physical size
16838 @item %w
16839 Virtual size.
16840 @end table
16841 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
16842 @end deftypevr
16843
16844 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
16845 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
16846 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
16847 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
16848 Dovecot the full location.
16849
16850 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
16851 file (e.g.@: /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
16852 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
16853 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
16854 @samp{mail-location} setting.
16855
16856 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
16857
16858 @table @samp
16859 @item %u
16860 username
16861 @item %n
16862 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
16863 @item %d
16864 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
16865 @item %h
16866 home director
16867 @end table
16868
16869 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
16870 @table @samp
16871 @item maildir:~/Maildir
16872 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
16873 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
16874 @end table
16875 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16876 @end deftypevr
16877
16878 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
16879 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
16880 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
16881 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
16882 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16883 @end deftypevr
16884
16885 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
16886
16887 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16888 @end deftypevr
16889
16890 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
16891 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
16892 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
16893 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
16894 /var/mail.
16895 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16896 @end deftypevr
16897
16898 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
16899 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
16900 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
16901 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
16902 symlinks (e.g.@: if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
16903 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
16904 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
16905 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16906 @end deftypevr
16907
16908 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
16909 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
16910 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
16911 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
16912 names with e.g.@: /path/ or ~user/.
16913 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16914 @end deftypevr
16915
16916 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
16917 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
16918 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
16919 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16920 @end deftypevr
16921
16922 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
16923 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
16924 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
16925 nowadays by default.
16926 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16927 @end deftypevr
16928
16929 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
16930 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
16931 @table @code
16932 @item optimized
16933 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
16934 @item always
16935 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when write()s are delayed
16936 @item never
16937 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
16938 @end table
16939 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
16940 @end deftypevr
16941
16942 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
16943 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
16944 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
16945 this isn't needed.
16946 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16947 @end deftypevr
16948
16949 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
16950 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
16951 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
16952 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16953 @end deftypevr
16954
16955 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
16956 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
16957 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
16958 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
16959 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
16960 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
16961 @end deftypevr
16962
16963 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
16964 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
16965 kB.
16966 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
16967 @end deftypevr
16968
16969 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
16970 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
16971 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
16972 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
16973 is set to 0.
16974 Defaults to @samp{500}.
16975 @end deftypevr
16976
16977 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
16978
16979 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16980 @end deftypevr
16981
16982 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
16983 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
16984 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
16985 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
16986 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16987 @end deftypevr
16988
16989 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
16990
16991 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16992 @end deftypevr
16993
16994 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
16995 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
16996 trying to create new keywords.
16997 Defaults to @samp{50}.
16998 @end deftypevr
16999
17000 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
17001 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
17002 processes (i.e.@: /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
17003 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
17004 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
17005 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
17006 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
17007 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
17008 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
17009 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17010 @end deftypevr
17011
17012 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
17013 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
17014 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
17015 directory (e.g.@: /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
17016 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
17017 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
17018 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/."@: to
17019 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
17020 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17021 @end deftypevr
17022
17023 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
17024 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
17025 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
17026 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
17027 @end deftypevr
17028
17029 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
17030 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
17031 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
17032 @end deftypevr
17033
17034 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
17035 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
17036 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
17037 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17038 @end deftypevr
17039
17040 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
17041 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
17042 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
17043 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
17044 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17045 @end deftypevr
17046
17047 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
17048 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
17049 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
17050 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
17051 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
17052 occur.
17053 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
17054 @end deftypevr
17055
17056 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
17057 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
17058 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
17059 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
17060 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
17061 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
17062 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17063 @end deftypevr
17064
17065 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
17066 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
17067 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
17068 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
17069 causes more disk I/O.
17070 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
17071 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
17072 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17073 @end deftypevr
17074
17075 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
17076 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
17077 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
17078 side effects.
17079 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17080 @end deftypevr
17081
17082 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
17083 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
17084 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
17085 the mail otherwise.
17086 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17087 @end deftypevr
17088
17089 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
17090 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
17091 available:
17092
17093 @table @code
17094 @item dotlock
17095 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
17096 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
17097 need write access to that directory.
17098 @item dotlock-try
17099 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
17100 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
17101 @item fcntl
17102 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
17103 @item flock
17104 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
17105 @item lockf
17106 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
17107 @end table
17108
17109 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
17110 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
17111 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
17112 them simultaneously.
17113 @end deftypevr
17114
17115 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
17116
17117 @end deftypevr
17118
17119 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
17120 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
17121 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
17122 @end deftypevr
17123
17124 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
17125 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
17126 override the lock file after this much time.
17127 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
17128 @end deftypevr
17129
17130 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
17131 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
17132 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
17133 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
17134 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
17135 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
17136 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
17137 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
17138 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
17139 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
17140 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17141 @end deftypevr
17142
17143 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
17144 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
17145 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
17146 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
17147 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17148 @end deftypevr
17149
17150 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
17151 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
17152 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
17153 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
17154 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
17155 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17156 @end deftypevr
17157
17158 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
17159 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
17160 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
17161 updated.
17162 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17163 @end deftypevr
17164
17165 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
17166 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
17167 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
17168 @end deftypevr
17169
17170 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
17171 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
17172 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
17173 disabled.
17174 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
17175 @end deftypevr
17176
17177 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
17178 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
17179 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
17180 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
17181 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17182 @end deftypevr
17183
17184 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
17185 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
17186 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
17187 don't support this for now.
17188
17189 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
17190
17191 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
17192 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17193 @end deftypevr
17194
17195 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
17196 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
17197 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
17198 externally.
17199 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
17200 @end deftypevr
17201
17202 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
17203 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
17204 @table @code
17205 @item posix
17206 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
17207 @item sis posix
17208 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
17209 @item sis-queue posix
17210 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
17211 @end table
17212 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
17213 @end deftypevr
17214
17215 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
17216 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
17217 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
17218 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
17219 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
17220 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
17221 @end deftypevr
17222
17223 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
17224
17225 Defaults to @samp{100}.
17226 @end deftypevr
17227
17228 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
17229
17230 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
17231 @end deftypevr
17232
17233 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
17234 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
17235 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
17236 before they eat up everything.
17237 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
17238 @end deftypevr
17239
17240 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
17241 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
17242 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
17243 at all.
17244 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
17245 @end deftypevr
17246
17247 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
17248 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
17249 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
17250 processes.
17251 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
17252 @end deftypevr
17253
17254 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
17255 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
17256 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
17257 @end deftypevr
17258
17259 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
17260 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
17261 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
17262 @end deftypevr
17263
17264 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
17265 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
17266 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
17267 root.
17268 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
17269 @end deftypevr
17270
17271 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
17272 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
17273 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
17274 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
17275 instead to a different.
17276 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17277 @end deftypevr
17278
17279 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
17280 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
17281 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
17282 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
17283 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
17284 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17285 @end deftypevr
17286
17287 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
17288 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
17289 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17290 @end deftypevr
17291
17292 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
17293 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
17294 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
17295 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17296 @end deftypevr
17297
17298 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
17299 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
17300 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
17301 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
17302 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
17303 @end deftypevr
17304
17305 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
17306 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
17307 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
17308 @end deftypevr
17309
17310 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
17311 SSL ciphers to use.
17312 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
17313 @end deftypevr
17314
17315 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
17316 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
17317 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17318 @end deftypevr
17319
17320 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
17321 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
17322 %d expands to recipient domain.
17323 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
17324 @end deftypevr
17325
17326 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17327 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
17328 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
17329 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17330 @end deftypevr
17331
17332 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
17333 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
17334 bouncing the mail.
17335 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17336 @end deftypevr
17337
17338 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
17339 Binary to use for sending mails.
17340 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
17341 @end deftypevr
17342
17343 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
17344 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
17345 sendmail.
17346 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17347 @end deftypevr
17348
17349 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
17350 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
17351 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
17352 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
17353 @end deftypevr
17354
17355 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
17356 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
17357 variables:
17358
17359 @table @code
17360 @item %n
17361 CRLF
17362 @item %r
17363 reason
17364 @item %s
17365 original subject
17366 @item %t
17367 recipient
17368 @end table
17369 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
17370 @end deftypevr
17371
17372 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
17373 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
17374 address.
17375 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
17376 @end deftypevr
17377
17378 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
17379 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
17380 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
17381 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
17382 X-Original-To.
17383 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17384 @end deftypevr
17385
17386 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
17387 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
17388 it?.
17389 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17390 @end deftypevr
17391
17392 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
17393 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
17394 subscribed?.
17395 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17396 @end deftypevr
17397
17398 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
17399 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
17400 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
17401 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
17402 often.
17403 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
17404 @end deftypevr
17405
17406 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
17407 IMAP logout format string:
17408 @table @code
17409 @item %i
17410 total number of bytes read from client
17411 @item %o
17412 total number of bytes sent to client.
17413 @end table
17414 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
17415 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
17416 @end deftypevr
17417
17418 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
17419 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
17420 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
17421 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17422 @end deftypevr
17423
17424 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
17425 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
17426 is IDLEing.
17427 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
17428 @end deftypevr
17429
17430 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
17431 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
17432 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
17433 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
17434 support-email.
17435 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17436 @end deftypevr
17437
17438 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
17439 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
17440 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17441 @end deftypevr
17442
17443 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
17444 Workarounds for various client bugs:
17445
17446 @table @code
17447 @item delay-newmail
17448 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
17449 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
17450 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
17451 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
17452 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
17453 "Headers Only".
17454
17455 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
17456 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
17457 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
17458 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
17459
17460 @item tb-lsub-flags
17461 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
17462 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
17463 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
17464 @end table
17465 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17466 @end deftypevr
17467
17468 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
17469 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
17470 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17471 @end deftypevr
17472
17473
17474 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
17475 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
17476 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
17477 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
17478 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
17479
17480 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
17481 and running. In that case, you can pass an
17482 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
17483 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
17484 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
17485
17486 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
17487
17488 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
17489 The dovecot package.
17490 @end deftypevr
17491
17492 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
17493 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
17494 @end deftypevr
17495
17496 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
17497 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
17498
17499 @lisp
17500 (dovecot-service #:config
17501 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
17502 (string "")))
17503 @end lisp
17504
17505 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
17506
17507 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
17508 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
17509 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
17510 as in this example:
17511
17512 @lisp
17513 (service opensmtpd-service-type
17514 (opensmtpd-configuration
17515 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
17516 @end lisp
17517 @end deffn
17518
17519 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
17520 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
17521
17522 @table @asis
17523 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
17524 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
17525
17526 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
17527 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
17528 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
17529 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
17530 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
17531
17532 @end table
17533 @end deftp
17534
17535 @subsubheading Exim Service
17536
17537 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
17538 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
17539 @cindex SMTP
17540
17541 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
17542 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
17543 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
17544 as in this example:
17545
17546 @lisp
17547 (service exim-service-type
17548 (exim-configuration
17549 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
17550 @end lisp
17551 @end deffn
17552
17553 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
17554 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
17555 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
17556
17557 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
17558 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
17559
17560 @table @asis
17561 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
17562 Package object of the Exim server.
17563
17564 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
17565 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
17566 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
17567 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
17568 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
17569 variables.
17570
17571 @end table
17572 @end deftp
17573
17574 @subsubheading Getmail service
17575
17576 @cindex IMAP
17577 @cindex POP
17578
17579 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
17580 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
17581 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
17582 @end deffn
17583
17584 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
17585
17586 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
17587 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
17588
17589 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
17590
17591 @end deftypevr
17592
17593 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
17594 The getmail package to use.
17595
17596 @end deftypevr
17597
17598 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
17599 The user to run getmail as.
17600
17601 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
17602
17603 @end deftypevr
17604
17605 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
17606 The group to run getmail as.
17607
17608 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
17609
17610 @end deftypevr
17611
17612 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
17613 The getmail directory to use.
17614
17615 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
17616
17617 @end deftypevr
17618
17619 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
17620 The getmail configuration file to use.
17621
17622 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
17623
17624 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
17625 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
17626
17627 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
17628
17629 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
17630 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
17631 and @samp{static}.
17632
17633 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
17634
17635 @end deftypevr
17636
17637 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
17638 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
17639
17640 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17641
17642 @end deftypevr
17643
17644 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
17645 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
17646
17647 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17648
17649 @end deftypevr
17650
17651 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
17652 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
17653
17654 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17655
17656 @end deftypevr
17657
17658 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
17659 Override fields from passwd.
17660
17661 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17662
17663 @end deftypevr
17664
17665 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
17666 Override fields from passwd.
17667
17668 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17669
17670 @end deftypevr
17671
17672 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
17673 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation
17674
17675 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17676
17677 @end deftypevr
17678
17679 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
17680 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation
17681
17682 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17683
17684 @end deftypevr
17685
17686 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
17687 CA certificates to use
17688
17689 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17690
17691 @end deftypevr
17692
17693 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17694 Extra retriever parameters
17695
17696 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17697
17698 @end deftypevr
17699
17700 @end deftypevr
17701
17702 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
17703 What to do with retrieved messages.
17704
17705 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
17706
17707 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
17708 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
17709 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
17710
17711 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17712
17713 @end deftypevr
17714
17715 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
17716 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
17717 chosen type.
17718
17719 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17720
17721 @end deftypevr
17722
17723 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17724 Extra destination parameters
17725
17726 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17727
17728 @end deftypevr
17729
17730 @end deftypevr
17731
17732 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
17733 Configure getmail.
17734
17735 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
17736
17737 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
17738 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
17739 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
17740 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
17741 about each of it's actions.
17742
17743 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17744
17745 @end deftypevr
17746
17747 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
17748 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
17749 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
17750
17751 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17752
17753 @end deftypevr
17754
17755 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
17756 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
17757 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
17758 be left on the server.
17759
17760 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17761
17762 @end deftypevr
17763
17764 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
17765 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
17766 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
17767 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
17768 disabled this feature.
17769
17770 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17771
17772 @end deftypevr
17773
17774 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
17775 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
17776 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
17777 disables this feature.
17778
17779 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17780
17781 @end deftypevr
17782
17783 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
17784 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
17785 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
17786
17787 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17788
17789 @end deftypevr
17790
17791 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
17792 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
17793 @samp{0} disables this feature.
17794
17795 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17796
17797 @end deftypevr
17798
17799 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
17800 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
17801
17802 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17803
17804 @end deftypevr
17805
17806 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
17807 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
17808
17809 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17810
17811 @end deftypevr
17812
17813 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
17814 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
17815 @samp{""} disables this feature.
17816
17817 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17818
17819 @end deftypevr
17820
17821 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
17822 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
17823 logger.
17824
17825 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17826
17827 @end deftypevr
17828
17829 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
17830 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
17831 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
17832 information lines.
17833
17834 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17835
17836 @end deftypevr
17837
17838 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17839 Extra options to include.
17840
17841 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17842
17843 @end deftypevr
17844
17845 @end deftypevr
17846
17847 @end deftypevr
17848
17849 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
17850 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
17851 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
17852 extension.
17853
17854 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17855
17856 @end deftypevr
17857
17858 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
17859 Environment variables to set for getmail.
17860
17861 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17862
17863 @end deftypevr
17864
17865 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
17866
17867 @cindex email aliases
17868 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
17869
17870 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
17871 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
17872 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
17873
17874 @lisp
17875 (service mail-aliases-service-type
17876 '(("postmaster" "bob")
17877 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
17878 @end lisp
17879 @end deffn
17880
17881 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
17882 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
17883 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
17884 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
17885 where to deliver this user's mail.
17886
17887 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
17888 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
17889 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
17890 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
17891 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
17892
17893 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17894 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17895
17896 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
17897 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
17898 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
17899 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
17900
17901 @lisp
17902 (service imap4d-service-type
17903 (imap4d-configuration
17904 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
17905 @end lisp
17906 @end deffn
17907
17908 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
17909 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
17910
17911 @table @asis
17912 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
17913 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
17914
17915 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
17916 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
17917 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
17918 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
17919
17920 @end table
17921 @end deftp
17922
17923 @node Messaging Services
17924 @subsection Messaging Services
17925
17926 @cindex messaging
17927 @cindex jabber
17928 @cindex XMPP
17929 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
17930 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
17931
17932 @subsubheading Prosody Service
17933
17934 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
17935 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
17936 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
17937 record as in this example:
17938
17939 @lisp
17940 (service prosody-service-type
17941 (prosody-configuration
17942 (modules-enabled (cons "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
17943 (int-components
17944 (list
17945 (int-component-configuration
17946 (hostname "conference.example.net")
17947 (plugin "muc")
17948 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
17949 (virtualhosts
17950 (list
17951 (virtualhost-configuration
17952 (domain "example.net"))))))
17953 @end lisp
17954
17955 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
17956
17957 @end deffn
17958
17959 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
17960 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
17961 Prosody to serve.
17962
17963 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
17964 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
17965
17966 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
17967 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
17968 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
17969
17970 @example
17971 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
17972 @end example
17973
17974 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
17975 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
17976 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
17977 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
17978 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
17979
17980 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
17981 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
17982 some other system; see the end for more details.
17983
17984 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
17985 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
17986
17987 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
17988 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
17989 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
17990 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
17991 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
17992 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
17993 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
17994
17995 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
17996
17997 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
17998 The Prosody package.
17999 @end deftypevr
18000
18001 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
18002 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
18003 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
18004 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
18005 @end deftypevr
18006
18007 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
18008 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
18009 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
18010 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18011 @end deftypevr
18012
18013 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
18014 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
18015 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
18016 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
18017 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
18018 @end deftypevr
18019
18020 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
18021 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
18022 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
18023 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
18024 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
18025 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18026 @end deftypevr
18027
18028 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
18029 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
18030 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
18031 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18032 @end deftypevr
18033
18034 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
18035 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
18036 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
18037 Documentation on modules can be found at:
18038 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
18039 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
18040 @end deftypevr
18041
18042 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
18043 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
18044 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
18045 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18046 @end deftypevr
18047
18048 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
18049 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
18050 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
18051 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
18052 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
18053 @end deftypevr
18054
18055 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
18056 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
18057 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
18058 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18059 @end deftypevr
18060
18061 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
18062 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
18063 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
18064 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
18065 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
18066
18067 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
18068
18069 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
18070 This determines what handshake to use.
18071 @end deftypevr
18072
18073 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
18074 Path to your private key file.
18075 @end deftypevr
18076
18077 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
18078 Path to your certificate file.
18079 @end deftypevr
18080
18081 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
18082 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
18083 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
18084 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
18085 @end deftypevr
18086
18087 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
18088 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
18089 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
18090 @end deftypevr
18091
18092 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
18093 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
18094 @code{set_verify()} flags).
18095 @end deftypevr
18096
18097 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
18098 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
18099 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
18100 LuaSec source.
18101 @end deftypevr
18102
18103 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
18104 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
18105 trusted root certificate.
18106 @end deftypevr
18107
18108 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
18109 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
18110 clients, and in what order.
18111 @end deftypevr
18112
18113 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
18114 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
18115 can create such a file with:
18116 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
18117 @end deftypevr
18118
18119 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
18120 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
18121 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
18122 @end deftypevr
18123
18124 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
18125 A list of "extra" verification options.
18126 @end deftypevr
18127
18128 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
18129 Password for encrypted private keys.
18130 @end deftypevr
18131
18132 @end deftypevr
18133
18134 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
18135 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
18136 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
18137 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18138 @end deftypevr
18139
18140 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
18141 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
18142 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
18143 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
18144 @end deftypevr
18145
18146 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
18147 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
18148 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
18149 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18150 @end deftypevr
18151
18152 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
18153 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
18154 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
18155 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
18156 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18157 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18158 @end deftypevr
18159
18160 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
18161 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
18162 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
18163 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
18164 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18165 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18166 @end deftypevr
18167
18168 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
18169 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
18170 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
18171 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18172 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18173 @end deftypevr
18174
18175 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
18176 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
18177 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
18178 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
18179 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
18180 about using the hashed backend. See also
18181 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
18182 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
18183 @end deftypevr
18184
18185 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
18186 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
18187 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
18188 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
18189 @end deftypevr
18190
18191 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
18192 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
18193 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
18194 @end deftypevr
18195
18196 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
18197 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
18198 @end deftypevr
18199
18200 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
18201 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
18202 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
18203 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
18204 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
18205 @end deftypevr
18206
18207 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
18208 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
18209 example if you want your users to have addresses like
18210 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
18211 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
18212
18213 Note: the name "virtual" host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
18214 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
18215 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
18216 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
18217 have just one VirtualHost entry.
18218
18219 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
18220
18221 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
18222
18223 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18224 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
18225 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
18226 @end deftypevr
18227
18228 @end deftypevr
18229
18230 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
18231 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
18232 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
18233 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
18234 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
18235
18236 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
18237 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
18238 to use for the component.
18239
18240 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
18241 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18242
18243 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
18244
18245 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18246 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18247 Hostname of the component.
18248 @end deftypevr
18249
18250 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
18251 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
18252 @end deftypevr
18253
18254 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
18255 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
18256 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
18257
18258 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
18259 in the "Chatrooms" documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
18260 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
18261
18262 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
18263
18264 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
18265
18266 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
18267 The name to return in service discovery responses.
18268 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
18269 @end deftypevr
18270
18271 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
18272 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
18273 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
18274 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
18275 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
18276 restricts to service administrators only.
18277 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18278 @end deftypevr
18279
18280 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
18281 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
18282 just joined the room.
18283 Defaults to @samp{20}.
18284 @end deftypevr
18285
18286 @end deftypevr
18287
18288 @end deftypevr
18289
18290 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
18291 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
18292 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
18293 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
18294 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18295
18296 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
18297
18298 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18299 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
18300 Password which the component will use to log in.
18301 @end deftypevr
18302
18303 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18304 Hostname of the component.
18305 @end deftypevr
18306
18307 @end deftypevr
18308
18309 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
18310 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
18311 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
18312 @end deftypevr
18313
18314 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
18315 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
18316 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
18317 @end deftypevr
18318
18319 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
18320 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
18321 @end deftypevr
18322
18323 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
18324 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
18325 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
18326 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
18327 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
18328 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
18329
18330 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
18331 The prosody package.
18332 @end deftypevr
18333
18334 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
18335 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
18336 @end deftypevr
18337
18338 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
18339 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
18340
18341 @lisp
18342 (service prosody-service-type
18343 (opaque-prosody-configuration
18344 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
18345 @end lisp
18346
18347 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
18348
18349 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
18350
18351 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
18352 @cindex IRC gateway
18353 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
18354 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
18355
18356 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
18357 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
18358 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
18359 below).
18360
18361 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
18362 services:
18363
18364 @lisp
18365 (service bitlbee-service-type)
18366 @end lisp
18367 @end defvr
18368
18369 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
18370 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
18371
18372 @table @asis
18373 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18374 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
18375 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
18376 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
18377
18378 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
18379 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
18380 networking interface.
18381
18382 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
18383 The BitlBee package to use.
18384
18385 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
18386 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
18387
18388 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
18389 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
18390 @end table
18391 @end deftp
18392
18393 @subsubheading Quassel Service
18394
18395 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
18396 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
18397 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
18398 central core.
18399
18400 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
18401 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
18402 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
18403 (see below).
18404 @end defvr
18405
18406 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
18407 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
18408
18409 @table @asis
18410 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
18411 The Quassel package to use.
18412
18413 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
18414 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
18415 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
18416 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
18417 @var{port}.
18418
18419 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
18420 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
18421 and Error.
18422 @end table
18423 @end deftp
18424
18425 @node Telephony Services
18426 @subsection Telephony Services
18427
18428 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
18429 @cindex VoIP server
18430 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
18431 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
18432 (VoIP) suite.
18433
18434 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
18435 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
18436 look like this:
18437
18438 @lisp
18439 (service murmur-service-type
18440 (murmur-configuration
18441 (welcome-text
18442 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
18443 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
18444 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
18445 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
18446 @end lisp
18447
18448 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
18449 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
18450
18451 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
18452 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
18453 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
18454 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
18455 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
18456 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
18457 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
18458 rights and create some channels.
18459
18460 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
18461
18462 @table @asis
18463 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
18464 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
18465
18466 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
18467 User who will run the Murmur server.
18468
18469 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
18470 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
18471
18472 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
18473 Port on which the server will listen.
18474
18475 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
18476 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
18477
18478 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
18479 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
18480
18481 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
18482 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
18483
18484 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
18485 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
18486
18487 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
18488 File name of the sqlite database.
18489 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
18490
18491 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
18492 File name of the log file.
18493 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
18494
18495 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
18496 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
18497 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
18498
18499 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
18500 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
18501
18502 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
18503 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
18504 when violating the autoban limits.
18505
18506 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
18507 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
18508 before switching over to opus audio codec.
18509
18510 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
18511 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
18512
18513 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
18514 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
18515
18516 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
18517 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
18518
18519 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
18520 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
18521
18522 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
18523 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
18524
18525 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
18526 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
18527 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
18528
18529 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
18530 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
18531 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
18532
18533 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
18534 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
18535
18536 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
18537 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
18538 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
18539 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
18540
18541 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
18542
18543 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
18544 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
18545
18546 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
18547 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
18548
18549 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
18550 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
18551 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
18552 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
18553
18554 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
18555 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
18556
18557 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
18558 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
18559
18560 @lisp
18561 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
18562 @end lisp
18563 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
18564 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
18565 @lisp
18566 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
18567 @end lisp
18568
18569 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
18570 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
18571 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
18572 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
18573 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
18574
18575 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
18576 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
18577 in SSL/TLS.
18578
18579 This option is specified using
18580 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
18581 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
18582
18583 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
18584 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
18585 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
18586 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
18587
18588 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
18589 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
18590 to connect to it.
18591
18592 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
18593 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
18594
18595 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
18596 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
18597 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
18598 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
18599
18600 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
18601
18602 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
18603 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
18604 @end table
18605 @end deftp
18606
18607 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
18608 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
18609
18610 @table @asis
18611 @item @code{name}
18612 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
18613
18614 @item @code{password}
18615 A password to identify your registration.
18616 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
18617
18618 @item @code{url}
18619 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
18620 site.
18621
18622 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
18623 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
18624 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
18625 @end table
18626 @end deftp
18627
18628
18629
18630 @node Monitoring Services
18631 @subsection Monitoring Services
18632
18633 @subsubheading Tailon Service
18634
18635 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
18636 viewing and searching log files.
18637
18638 The following example will configure the service with default values.
18639 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
18640
18641 @lisp
18642 (service tailon-service-type)
18643 @end lisp
18644
18645 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
18646 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
18647
18648 @lisp
18649 (service tailon-service-type
18650 (tailon-configuration
18651 (config-file
18652 (tailon-configuration-file
18653 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
18654 @end lisp
18655
18656
18657 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
18658 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
18659 This type has the following parameters:
18660
18661 @table @asis
18662 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
18663 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
18664 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
18665 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
18666
18667 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
18668 can be used:
18669
18670 @lisp
18671 (service tailon-service-type
18672 (tailon-configuration
18673 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
18674 @end lisp
18675
18676 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
18677 The tailon package to use.
18678
18679 @end table
18680 @end deftp
18681
18682 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
18683 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
18684 This type has the following parameters:
18685
18686 @table @asis
18687 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
18688 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
18689 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
18690 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
18691 subsection.
18692
18693 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
18694 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
18695
18696 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
18697 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
18698
18699 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
18700 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
18701
18702 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
18703 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
18704
18705 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
18706 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
18707
18708 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
18709 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
18710
18711 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
18712 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
18713
18714 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
18715 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
18716 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
18717 wrap lines.
18718
18719 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
18720 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
18721 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
18722 @code{"basic"}.
18723
18724 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
18725 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
18726 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
18727 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
18728 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
18729
18730 @lisp
18731 (tailon-configuration-file
18732 (http-auth "basic")
18733 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
18734 ("user2" . "password2"))))
18735 @end lisp
18736
18737 @end table
18738 @end deftp
18739
18740
18741 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
18742 @cindex darkstat
18743 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
18744 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
18745
18746 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
18747 This is the service type for the
18748 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
18749 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
18750 this example:
18751
18752 @lisp
18753 (service darkstat-service-type
18754 (darkstat-configuration
18755 (interface "eno1")))
18756 @end lisp
18757 @end defvar
18758
18759 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
18760 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
18761
18762 @table @asis
18763 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
18764 The darkstat package to use.
18765
18766 @item @code{interface}
18767 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
18768
18769 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
18770 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
18771
18772 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18773 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18774
18775 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
18776 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
18777 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
18778
18779 @end table
18780 @end deftp
18781
18782 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
18783
18784 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
18785 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
18786 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
18787 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
18788 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
18789
18790 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18791 This is the service type for the
18792 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
18793 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}
18794 record as in this example:
18795
18796 @lisp
18797 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18798 (prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18799 (web-listen-address ":9100")))
18800 @end lisp
18801 @end defvar
18802
18803 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18804 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
18805
18806 @table @asis
18807 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
18808 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
18809
18810 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
18811 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18812
18813 @end table
18814 @end deftp
18815
18816 @subsubheading Zabbix server
18817 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
18818 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
18819 and disk space consumption:
18820
18821 @itemize
18822 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
18823 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
18824 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
18825 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
18826 @item Native high performance agents.
18827 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
18828 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
18829 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
18830 @end itemize
18831
18832 @c %start of fragment
18833
18834 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
18835
18836 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
18837 The zabbix-server package.
18838
18839 @end deftypevr
18840
18841 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
18842 User who will run the Zabbix server.
18843
18844 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18845
18846 @end deftypevr
18847
18848 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
18849 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
18850
18851 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18852
18853 @end deftypevr
18854
18855 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
18856 Database host name.
18857
18858 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
18859
18860 @end deftypevr
18861
18862 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
18863 Database name.
18864
18865 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18866
18867 @end deftypevr
18868
18869 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
18870 Database user.
18871
18872 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18873
18874 @end deftypevr
18875
18876 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
18877 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
18878 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
18879
18880 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18881
18882 @end deftypevr
18883
18884 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
18885 Database port.
18886
18887 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
18888
18889 @end deftypevr
18890
18891 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18892 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18893
18894 @itemize @bullet
18895 @item
18896 @code{system} - syslog.
18897
18898 @item
18899 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
18900
18901 @item
18902 @code{console} - standard output.
18903
18904 @end itemize
18905
18906 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18907
18908 @end deftypevr
18909
18910 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
18911 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
18912
18913 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
18914
18915 @end deftypevr
18916
18917 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
18918 Name of PID file.
18919
18920 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
18921
18922 @end deftypevr
18923
18924 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
18925 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
18926 certificate verification.
18927
18928 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
18929
18930 @end deftypevr
18931
18932 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
18933 Location of SSL client certificates.
18934
18935 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
18936
18937 @end deftypevr
18938
18939 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
18940 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
18941
18942 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18943
18944 @end deftypevr
18945
18946 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
18947 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
18948 configuration file.
18949
18950 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18951
18952 @end deftypevr
18953
18954 @c %end of fragment
18955
18956 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
18957 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
18958
18959 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
18960
18961 @c %start of fragment
18962
18963 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
18964
18965 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
18966 The zabbix-agent package.
18967
18968 @end deftypevr
18969
18970 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
18971 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
18972
18973 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18974
18975 @end deftypevr
18976
18977 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
18978 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
18979
18980 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18981
18982 @end deftypevr
18983
18984 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18985 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
18986 must match hostname as configured on the server.
18987
18988 Defaults to @samp{"Zabbix server"}.
18989
18990 @end deftypevr
18991
18992 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18993 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18994
18995 @itemize @bullet
18996 @item
18997 @code{system} - syslog.
18998
18999 @item
19000 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
19001
19002 @item
19003 @code{console} - standard output.
19004
19005 @end itemize
19006
19007 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19008
19009 @end deftypevr
19010
19011 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
19012 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
19013
19014 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
19015
19016 @end deftypevr
19017
19018 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
19019 Name of PID file.
19020
19021 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
19022
19023 @end deftypevr
19024
19025 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
19026 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
19027 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
19028 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
19029
19030 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
19031
19032 @end deftypevr
19033
19034 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
19035 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
19036 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
19037 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
19038
19039 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
19040
19041 @end deftypevr
19042
19043 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
19044 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
19045
19046 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19047
19048 @end deftypevr
19049
19050 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
19051 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
19052 configuration file.
19053
19054 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19055
19056 @end deftypevr
19057
19058 @c %end of fragment
19059
19060 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
19061 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
19062
19063 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
19064
19065 @c %start of fragment
19066
19067 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
19068
19069 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
19070 NGINX configuration.
19071
19072 @end deftypevr
19073
19074 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
19075 Database host name.
19076
19077 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
19078
19079 @end deftypevr
19080
19081 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
19082 Database port.
19083
19084 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
19085
19086 @end deftypevr
19087
19088 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
19089 Database name.
19090
19091 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19092
19093 @end deftypevr
19094
19095 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
19096 Database user.
19097
19098 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19099
19100 @end deftypevr
19101
19102 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
19103 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
19104
19105 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19106
19107 @end deftypevr
19108
19109 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
19110 Secret file which will be appended to @file{zabbix.conf.php} file. This
19111 file contains credentials for use by Zabbix front-end. You are expected
19112 to create it manually.
19113
19114 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19115
19116 @end deftypevr
19117
19118 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
19119 Zabbix server hostname.
19120
19121 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
19122
19123 @end deftypevr
19124
19125 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
19126 Zabbix server port.
19127
19128 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
19129
19130 @end deftypevr
19131
19132
19133 @c %end of fragment
19134
19135 @node Kerberos Services
19136 @subsection Kerberos Services
19137 @cindex Kerberos
19138
19139 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
19140 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
19141
19142 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
19143
19144 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
19145 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
19146 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
19147 operating system declaration.
19148 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
19149
19150 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
19151 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
19152 Other implementations have not been tested.
19153
19154 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
19155 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
19156 @end defvr
19157
19158 @noindent
19159 Here is an example of its use:
19160 @lisp
19161 (service krb5-service-type
19162 (krb5-configuration
19163 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
19164 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
19165 (realms (list
19166 (krb5-realm
19167 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
19168 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
19169 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
19170 (krb5-realm
19171 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
19172 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
19173 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
19174 @end lisp
19175
19176 @noindent
19177 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
19178 @itemize
19179 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
19180 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
19181 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
19182 specified by clients;
19183 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
19184 @end itemize
19185
19186 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
19187 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
19188 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
19189 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
19190 documentation.
19191
19192
19193 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
19194 @cindex realm, kerberos
19195 @table @asis
19196 @item @code{name}
19197 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
19198 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
19199 converted to upper case.
19200
19201 @item @code{admin-server}
19202 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
19203 running.
19204
19205 @item @code{kdc}
19206 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
19207 for the realm.
19208 @end table
19209 @end deftp
19210
19211 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
19212
19213 @table @asis
19214 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
19215 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
19216 known to be weak will be accepted.
19217
19218 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
19219 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
19220 realm for the client.
19221 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
19222 If this value is @code{#f}
19223 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
19224 such as @command{kinit}.
19225
19226 @item @code{realms}
19227 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
19228 access.
19229 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
19230 field.
19231 @end table
19232 @end deftp
19233
19234
19235 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
19236 @cindex pam-krb5
19237
19238 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
19239 management via Kerberos.
19240 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
19241 users using Kerberos.
19242
19243 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
19244 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
19245 @end defvr
19246
19247 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
19248 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
19249 This type has the following parameters:
19250 @table @asis
19251 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
19252 The pam-krb5 package to use.
19253
19254 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
19255 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
19256 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
19257 @end table
19258 @end deftp
19259
19260
19261 @node LDAP Services
19262 @subsection LDAP Services
19263 @cindex LDAP
19264 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
19265
19266 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
19267 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
19268 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
19269 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
19270 Switch} for detailed information.
19271
19272 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
19273 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
19274 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
19275
19276 @lisp
19277 (use-service-modules authentication)
19278 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
19279 ...
19280 (operating-system
19281 ...
19282 (services
19283 (cons*
19284 (service nslcd-service-type)
19285 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
19286 %base-services))
19287 (name-service-switch
19288 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
19289 (name-service (name "files"))
19290 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
19291 (name-service-switch
19292 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
19293 (password services)
19294 (shadow services)
19295 (group services)
19296 (netgroup services)
19297 (gshadow services)))))
19298 @end lisp
19299
19300 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
19301
19302 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
19303
19304 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
19305 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
19306
19307 @end deftypevr
19308
19309 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
19310 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
19311 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
19312 The default is to start 5 threads.
19313
19314 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19315
19316 @end deftypevr
19317
19318 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
19319 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
19320
19321 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
19322
19323 @end deftypevr
19324
19325 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
19326 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
19327
19328 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
19329
19330 @end deftypevr
19331
19332 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
19333 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
19334 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols "none"
19335 or "syslog", or an absolute file name. The LEVEL argument is optional
19336 and specifies the log level. The log level may be one of the following
19337 symbols: "crit", "error", "warning", "notice", "info" or "debug". All
19338 messages with the specified log level or higher are logged.
19339
19340 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
19341
19342 @end deftypevr
19343
19344 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
19345 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
19346 used with the following servers as fall-back.
19347
19348 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
19349
19350 @end deftypevr
19351
19352 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
19353 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
19354 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
19355
19356 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19357
19358 @end deftypevr
19359
19360 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
19361 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
19362 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
19363
19364 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19365
19366 @end deftypevr
19367
19368 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
19369 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
19370 applicable when used with binddn.
19371
19372 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19373
19374 @end deftypevr
19375
19376 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
19377 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
19378 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
19379
19380 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19381
19382 @end deftypevr
19383
19384 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
19385 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
19386 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
19387 rootpwmoddn
19388
19389 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19390
19391 @end deftypevr
19392
19393 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
19394 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
19395 authentication.
19396
19397 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19398
19399 @end deftypevr
19400
19401 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
19402 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
19403
19404 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19405
19406 @end deftypevr
19407
19408 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
19409 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
19410 authentication.
19411
19412 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19413
19414 @end deftypevr
19415
19416 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
19417 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
19418 authentication.
19419
19420 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19421
19422 @end deftypevr
19423
19424 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
19425 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
19426 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
19427 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
19428 performed or not.
19429
19430 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19431
19432 @end deftypevr
19433
19434 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
19435 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
19436
19437 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19438
19439 @end deftypevr
19440
19441 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
19442 The directory search base.
19443
19444 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
19445
19446 @end deftypevr
19447
19448 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
19449 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
19450 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
19451 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
19452
19453 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
19454
19455 @end deftypevr
19456
19457 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
19458 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
19459 to never dereference aliases.
19460
19461 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19462
19463 @end deftypevr
19464
19465 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
19466 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
19467 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
19468
19469 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19470
19471 @end deftypevr
19472
19473 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
19474 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
19475 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
19476 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
19477 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
19478
19479 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19480
19481 @end deftypevr
19482
19483 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
19484 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
19485 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
19486
19487 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19488
19489 @end deftypevr
19490
19491 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
19492 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
19493 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
19494
19495 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19496
19497 @end deftypevr
19498
19499 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
19500 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
19501 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
19502 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
19503
19504 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19505
19506 @end deftypevr
19507
19508 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
19509 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
19510 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
19511 out connections.
19512
19513 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19514
19515 @end deftypevr
19516
19517 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
19518 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
19519 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
19520 failure and the first retry.
19521
19522 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19523
19524 @end deftypevr
19525
19526 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
19527 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
19528 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
19529 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
19530
19531 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19532
19533 @end deftypevr
19534
19535 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
19536 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
19537 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
19538 SSL.
19539
19540 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19541
19542 @end deftypevr
19543
19544 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
19545 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
19546 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
19547
19548 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19549
19550 @end deftypevr
19551
19552 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
19553 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
19554 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
19555
19556 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19557
19558 @end deftypevr
19559
19560 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
19561 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
19562
19563 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19564
19565 @end deftypevr
19566
19567 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
19568 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
19569 using GnuTLS.
19570
19571 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19572
19573 @end deftypevr
19574
19575 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
19576 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
19577
19578 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19579
19580 @end deftypevr
19581
19582 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
19583 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
19584 client TLS authentication.
19585
19586 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19587
19588 @end deftypevr
19589
19590 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
19591 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
19592 authentication.
19593
19594 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19595
19596 @end deftypevr
19597
19598 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
19599 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
19600 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
19601 request paged results.
19602
19603 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19604
19605 @end deftypevr
19606
19607 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
19608 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
19609 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
19610 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
19611
19612 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19613
19614 @end deftypevr
19615
19616 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
19617 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
19618 the specified value are ignored.
19619
19620 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19621
19622 @end deftypevr
19623
19624 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
19625 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
19626 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
19627
19628 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19629
19630 @end deftypevr
19631
19632 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
19633 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
19634 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
19635
19636 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19637
19638 @end deftypevr
19639
19640 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
19641 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
19642 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
19643 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
19644 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
19645 groups.
19646
19647 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19648
19649 @end deftypevr
19650
19651 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
19652 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
19653 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
19654 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
19655 groups assigned on login.
19656
19657 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19658
19659 @end deftypevr
19660
19661 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
19662 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
19663 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
19664 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
19665 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
19666 most configurations.
19667
19668 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19669
19670 @end deftypevr
19671
19672 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
19673 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
19674 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
19675 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
19676
19677 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19678
19679 @end deftypevr
19680
19681 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
19682 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
19683 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
19684 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
19685 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
19686
19687 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19688
19689 @end deftypevr
19690
19691 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
19692 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
19693 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
19694
19695 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19696
19697 @end deftypevr
19698
19699 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
19700 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
19701 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
19702 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
19703 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
19704 It should return at least one entry.
19705
19706 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19707
19708 @end deftypevr
19709
19710 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
19711 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
19712 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
19713 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
19714
19715 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19716
19717 @end deftypevr
19718
19719 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
19720 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
19721 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
19722 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
19723 changing their password.
19724
19725 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19726
19727 @end deftypevr
19728
19729 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
19730 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
19731
19732 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19733
19734 @end deftypevr
19735
19736 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
19737
19738
19739 @node Web Services
19740 @subsection Web Services
19741
19742 @cindex web
19743 @cindex www
19744 @cindex HTTP
19745 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
19746 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
19747
19748 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
19749
19750 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
19751 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
19752 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
19753 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
19754
19755 A simple example configuration is given below.
19756
19757 @lisp
19758 (service httpd-service-type
19759 (httpd-configuration
19760 (config
19761 (httpd-config-file
19762 (server-name "www.example.com")
19763 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
19764 @end lisp
19765
19766 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
19767 the configuration.
19768
19769 @lisp
19770 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
19771 (list
19772 (httpd-virtualhost
19773 "*:80"
19774 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
19775 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
19776 "\n")))))
19777 @end lisp
19778 @end deffn
19779
19780 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
19781 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
19782 given below.
19783
19784 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
19785 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
19786
19787 @table @asis
19788 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
19789 The httpd package to use.
19790
19791 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19792 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
19793
19794 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
19795 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
19796 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
19797 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
19798 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
19799
19800 @end table
19801 @end deffn
19802
19803 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
19804 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
19805
19806 @table @asis
19807 @item @code{name}
19808 The name of the module.
19809
19810 @item @code{file}
19811 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
19812 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
19813 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
19814 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
19815
19816 @end table
19817 @end deffn
19818
19819 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
19820 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
19821 @end defvr
19822
19823 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
19824 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
19825
19826 @table @asis
19827 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
19828 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
19829 additional configuration.
19830
19831 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
19832 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
19833
19834 @lisp
19835 (service httpd-service-type
19836 (httpd-configuration
19837 (config
19838 (httpd-config-file
19839 (modules (cons*
19840 (httpd-module
19841 (name "proxy_module")
19842 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
19843 (httpd-module
19844 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
19845 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
19846 %default-httpd-modules))
19847 (extra-config (list "\
19848 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
19849 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
19850 </FilesMatch>"))))))
19851 (service php-fpm-service-type
19852 (php-fpm-configuration
19853 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
19854 (socket-group "httpd")))
19855 @end lisp
19856
19857 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
19858 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
19859 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
19860 taken as relative to the server root.
19861
19862 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
19863 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
19864 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
19865 itself.
19866
19867 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specifyed
19868 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
19869 @code{ServerName}.
19870
19871 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
19872 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
19873
19874 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
19875 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
19876 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
19877 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
19878 protocol to use.
19879
19880 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19881 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
19882 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
19883 configured correctly.
19884
19885 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
19886 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
19887
19888 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19889 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
19890
19891 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19892 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
19893
19894 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
19895 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
19896 of the configuration file.
19897
19898 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
19899 list.
19900
19901 @end table
19902 @end deffn
19903
19904 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
19905 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
19906
19907 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
19908
19909 @lisp
19910 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
19911 (list
19912 (httpd-virtualhost
19913 "*:80"
19914 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
19915 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
19916 "\n")))))
19917 @end lisp
19918
19919 @table @asis
19920 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
19921 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
19922
19923 @item @code{contents}
19924 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
19925 of strings and G-expressions.
19926
19927 @end table
19928 @end deffn
19929
19930 @subsubheading NGINX
19931
19932 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
19933 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
19934 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
19935
19936 A simple example configuration is given below.
19937
19938 @lisp
19939 (service nginx-service-type
19940 (nginx-configuration
19941 (server-blocks
19942 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19943 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19944 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
19945 @end lisp
19946
19947 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
19948 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
19949 blocks, as in this example:
19950
19951 @lisp
19952 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
19953 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19954 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
19955 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
19956 @end lisp
19957 @end deffn
19958
19959 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
19960 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
19961 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
19962 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
19963 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
19964 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
19965 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
19966 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
19967
19968 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
19969 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
19970 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
19971 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
19972
19973 @table @asis
19974 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
19975 The nginx package to use.
19976
19977 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
19978 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
19979
19980 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
19981 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
19982 files.
19983
19984 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
19985 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
19986 file, the elements should be of type
19987 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
19988
19989 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
19990 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
19991 HTTPS.
19992 @lisp
19993 (service nginx-service-type
19994 (nginx-configuration
19995 (server-blocks
19996 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19997 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19998 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
19999 @end lisp
20000
20001 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
20002 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
20003 file, the elements should be of type
20004 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
20005
20006 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
20007 when combined with @code{locations} in the
20008 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
20009 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
20010 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
20011 requests with two servers.
20012
20013 @lisp
20014 (service
20015 nginx-service-type
20016 (nginx-configuration
20017 (server-blocks
20018 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20019 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
20020 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
20021 (locations
20022 (list
20023 (nginx-location-configuration
20024 (uri "/path1")
20025 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
20026 (upstream-blocks
20027 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
20028 (name "server-proxy")
20029 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
20030 "server2.example.com")))))))
20031 @end lisp
20032
20033 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
20034 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
20035 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
20036 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
20037 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
20038 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
20039
20040 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
20041 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
20042 nginx-configuration record.
20043
20044 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
20045 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
20046 use the size of the processors cache line.
20047
20048 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
20049 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
20050
20051 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
20052 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
20053 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
20054
20055 @lisp
20056 (modules
20057 (list
20058 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
20059 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")))
20060 @end lisp
20061
20062 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
20063 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
20064 valued G-expression.
20065
20066 @end table
20067 @end deffn
20068
20069 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
20070 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
20071 This type has the following parameters:
20072
20073 @table @asis
20074 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
20075 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
20076 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
20077 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
20078 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
20079
20080 @lisp
20081 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
20082 @end lisp
20083
20084 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
20085 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
20086 default server for connections matching no other server.
20087
20088 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
20089 Root of the website nginx will serve.
20090
20091 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
20092 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
20093 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
20094 server block.
20095
20096 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
20097 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
20098 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
20099
20100 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
20101 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
20102 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
20103
20104 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
20105 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
20106 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
20107
20108 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
20109 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
20110 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
20111
20112 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
20113 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
20114
20115 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
20116 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
20117
20118 @end table
20119 @end deftp
20120
20121 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
20122 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
20123 block. This type has the following parameters:
20124
20125 @table @asis
20126 @item @code{name}
20127 Name for this group of servers.
20128
20129 @item @code{servers}
20130 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
20131 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
20132 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
20133 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
20134 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
20135 explicitly.
20136
20137 @end table
20138 @end deftp
20139
20140 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
20141 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
20142 block. This type has the following parameters:
20143
20144 @table @asis
20145 @item @code{uri}
20146 URI which this location block matches.
20147
20148 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
20149 @item @code{body}
20150 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
20151 many
20152 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
20153 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
20154 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
20155 http://upstream-name;")}.
20156
20157 @end table
20158 @end deftp
20159
20160 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
20161 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
20162 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
20163 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
20164 parameters:
20165
20166 @table @asis
20167 @item @code{name}
20168 Name to identify this location block.
20169
20170 @item @code{body}
20171 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
20172 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
20173 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
20174 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
20175
20176 @end table
20177 @end deftp
20178
20179 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
20180 @cindex Varnish
20181 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
20182 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
20183 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
20184 creates one request to the back-end.
20185
20186 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
20187 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
20188 @end defvr
20189
20190 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
20191 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
20192 This type has the following parameters:
20193
20194 @table @asis
20195 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
20196 The Varnish package to use.
20197
20198 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
20199 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
20200 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
20201 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
20202 directory name.
20203
20204 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
20205 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
20206
20207 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
20208 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
20209
20210 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
20211 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
20212 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
20213 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
20214 VCL syntax.
20215
20216 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
20217 For example, to mirror @url{http://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
20218 can do something along these lines:
20219
20220 @lisp
20221 (define %gnu-mirror
20222 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
20223 "vcl 4.1;
20224 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
20225
20226 (operating-system
20227 ;; @dots{}
20228 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
20229 (varnish-configuration
20230 (listen '(":80"))
20231 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
20232 %base-services)))
20233 @end lisp
20234
20235 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
20236 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
20237
20238 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
20239 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
20240 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
20241
20242 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
20243 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
20244
20245 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
20246 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
20247
20248 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
20249 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
20250
20251 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
20252 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
20253
20254 @end table
20255 @end deftp
20256
20257 @subsubheading Patchwork
20258 @cindex Patchwork
20259 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
20260 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
20261
20262 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
20263 Service type for Patchwork.
20264 @end defvr
20265
20266 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
20267 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
20268
20269 @lisp
20270 (service patchwork-service-type
20271 (patchwork-configuration
20272 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
20273 (settings-module
20274 (patchwork-settings-module
20275 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
20276 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
20277 (getmail-retriever-config
20278 (getmail-retriever-configuration
20279 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
20280 (server "imap.example.com")
20281 (port 993)
20282 (username "patchwork")
20283 (password-command
20284 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
20285 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
20286 (extra-parameters
20287 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
20288
20289 @end lisp
20290
20291 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
20292 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
20293 within the HTTPD service.
20294
20295 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
20296 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
20297 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
20298
20299 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
20300 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
20301 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
20302
20303 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
20304 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
20305 following parameters:
20306
20307 @table @asis
20308 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
20309 The Patchwork package to use.
20310
20311 @item @code{domain}
20312 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
20313 host.
20314
20315 @item @code{settings-module}
20316 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
20317 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
20318 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
20319 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
20320 store.
20321
20322 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
20323 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
20324
20325 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
20326 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
20327 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
20328 delivered to Patchwork.
20329
20330 @end table
20331 @end deftp
20332
20333 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
20334 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
20335 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
20336 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
20337 has the following parameters:
20338
20339 @table @asis
20340 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
20341 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
20342 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
20343
20344 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
20345 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
20346 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
20347
20348 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
20349 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
20350
20351 This setting relates to Django.
20352
20353 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
20354 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
20355 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
20356
20357 This is a Django setting.
20358
20359 @item @code{default-from-email}
20360 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
20361
20362 This is a Patchwork setting.
20363
20364 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
20365 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
20366 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
20367
20368 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
20369 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
20370
20371 This is a Django setting.
20372
20373 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
20374 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
20375 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
20376
20377 This is a Django setting.
20378
20379 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
20380 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
20381 messages will be shown.
20382
20383 This is a Django setting.
20384
20385 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
20386 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
20387
20388 This is a Patchwork setting.
20389
20390 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
20391 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
20392
20393 This is a Patchwork setting.
20394
20395 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
20396 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
20397
20398 This is a Patchwork setting.
20399
20400 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
20401 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
20402
20403 @end table
20404 @end deftp
20405
20406 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
20407 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
20408
20409 @table @asis
20410 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
20411 The database engine to use.
20412
20413 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
20414 The name of the database to use.
20415
20416 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
20417 The user to connect to the database as.
20418
20419 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
20420 The password to use when connecting to the database.
20421
20422 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
20423 The host to make the database connection to.
20424
20425 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
20426 The port on which to connect to the database.
20427
20428 @end table
20429 @end deftp
20430
20431 @subsubheading Mumi
20432
20433 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
20434 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
20435 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
20436 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
20437 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
20438 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
20439
20440 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
20441 This is the service type for Mumi.
20442 @end defvr
20443
20444 @subsubheading FastCGI
20445 @cindex fastcgi
20446 @cindex fcgiwrap
20447 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
20448 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
20449 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
20450 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
20451 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
20452 support for it in Guix.
20453
20454 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
20455 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
20456 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
20457 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
20458 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
20459 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
20460
20461 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
20462 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
20463 @end defvr
20464
20465 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
20466 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
20467 This type has the following parameters:
20468 @table @asis
20469 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20470 The fcgiwrap package to use.
20471
20472 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
20473 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
20474 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
20475 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
20476 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
20477 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
20478
20479 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20480 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20481 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
20482 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
20483 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
20484 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
20485
20486 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
20487 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
20488 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
20489 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
20490 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
20491 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
20492 @end table
20493 @end deftp
20494
20495 @cindex php-fpm
20496 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
20497 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
20498
20499 These features include:
20500 @itemize @bullet
20501 @item Adaptive process spawning
20502 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
20503 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
20504 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
20505 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
20506 @item Stdout & stderr logging
20507 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
20508 @item Accelerated upload support
20509 @item Support for a "slowlog"
20510 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
20511 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
20512 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
20513 @end itemize
20514 ...@: and much more.
20515
20516 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
20517 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
20518 @end defvr
20519
20520 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
20521 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
20522 @table @asis
20523 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
20524 The php package to use.
20525 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
20526 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
20527 @table @asis
20528 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
20529 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
20530 @item @code{"port"}
20531 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
20532 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
20533 Listen on a unix socket.
20534 @end table
20535
20536 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20537 User who will own the php worker processes.
20538 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20539 Group of the worker processes.
20540 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20541 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
20542 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
20543 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
20544 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
20545 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
20546 once the service has started.
20547 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
20548 Log for the php-fpm master process.
20549 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
20550 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
20551 Must be one of:
20552 @table @asis
20553 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
20554 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
20555 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
20556 @end table
20557 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
20558 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
20559 and displayed in their browsers.
20560 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
20561 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
20562 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
20563 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
20564 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
20565 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
20566 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
20567 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
20568 An optional override of the whole configuration.
20569 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
20570 @end table
20571 @end deftp
20572
20573 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
20574 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
20575 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
20576 based on it's configured limits.
20577 @table @asis
20578 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20579 Maximum of worker processes.
20580 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
20581 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
20582 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
20583 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
20584 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
20585 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
20586 @end table
20587 @end deftp
20588
20589 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
20590 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
20591 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
20592 are created.
20593 @table @asis
20594 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20595 Maximum of worker processes.
20596 @end table
20597 @end deftp
20598
20599 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
20600 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
20601 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
20602 requests arrive.
20603 @table @asis
20604 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20605 Maximum of worker processes.
20606 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
20607 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
20608 @end table
20609 @end deftp
20610
20611
20612 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-fpm-location @
20613 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
20614 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
20615 (version-major (package-version php)) @
20616 "-fpm.sock")]
20617 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
20618 @end deffn
20619
20620 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
20621 @lisp
20622 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
20623 (service php-fpm-service-type)
20624 (service nginx-service-type
20625 (nginx-server-configuration
20626 (server-name '("example.com"))
20627 (root "/srv/http/")
20628 (locations
20629 (list (nginx-php-location)))
20630 (listen '("80"))
20631 (ssl-certificate #f)
20632 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
20633 %base-services))
20634 @end lisp
20635
20636 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
20637 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
20638 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
20639 the hash of a user's email address.
20640
20641 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
20642 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
20643 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
20644 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
20645 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
20646 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
20647 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
20648 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
20649 @end deffn
20650
20651 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
20652 @lisp
20653 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
20654 #:configuration
20655 (nginx-server-configuration
20656 (server-name '("example.com"))))
20657 ...
20658 %base-services))
20659 @end lisp
20660
20661 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
20662
20663 @cindex hpcguix-web
20664 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
20665 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
20666 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
20667 clusters.
20668
20669 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
20670 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
20671 @end defvr
20672
20673 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
20674 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
20675
20676 @table @asis
20677 @item @code{specs}
20678 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
20679 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
20680
20681 @table @asis
20682 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
20683 The page title prefix.
20684
20685 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
20686 The @command{guix} command.
20687
20688 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
20689 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
20690
20691 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
20692 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
20693
20694 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
20695 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
20696
20697 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
20698 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
20699
20700 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
20701 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
20702 the latest instances of the given channels.
20703 @end table
20704
20705 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
20706 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
20707 complete example}.
20708
20709 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
20710 The hpcguix-web package to use.
20711 @end table
20712 @end deftp
20713
20714 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
20715
20716 @lisp
20717 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
20718 (hpcguix-web-configuration
20719 (specs
20720 #~(define site-config
20721 (hpcweb-configuration
20722 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
20723 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
20724 @end lisp
20725
20726 @quotation Note
20727 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
20728 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
20729 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
20730 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
20731
20732 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
20733 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
20734 more information on X.509 certificates.
20735 @end quotation
20736
20737 @node Certificate Services
20738 @subsection Certificate Services
20739
20740 @cindex Web
20741 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
20742 @cindex Let's Encrypt
20743 @cindex TLS certificates
20744 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
20745 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
20746 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
20747 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
20748 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
20749 authenticity.
20750
20751 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
20752 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
20753 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
20754 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
20755 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
20756 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
20757 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
20758 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
20759 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
20760 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
20761 signature.
20762
20763 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
20764 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
20765 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
20766 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
20767 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
20768 with different permissions).
20769
20770 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
20771 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
20772 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
20773 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
20774 some reason.
20775
20776 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
20777 can be found there:
20778 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
20779
20780 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
20781 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
20782 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
20783
20784 @lisp
20785 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
20786 (program-file
20787 "nginx-deploy-hook"
20788 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
20789 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
20790
20791 (service certbot-service-type
20792 (certbot-configuration
20793 (email "foo@@example.net")
20794 (certificates
20795 (list
20796 (certificate-configuration
20797 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
20798 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
20799 (certificate-configuration
20800 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
20801 @end lisp
20802
20803 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
20804 @end defvr
20805
20806 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
20807 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
20808 This type has the following parameters:
20809
20810 @table @asis
20811 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
20812 The certbot package to use.
20813
20814 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
20815 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
20816 files.
20817
20818 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
20819 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
20820 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
20821 and several @code{domains}.
20822
20823 @item @code{email}
20824 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
20825 account notifications.
20826
20827 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
20828 Size of the RSA key.
20829
20830 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
20831 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
20832 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
20833 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
20834 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
20835 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
20836 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
20837 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
20838 these nginx configuration data types.
20839
20840 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
20841 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
20842 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
20843
20844 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
20845 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
20846 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
20847
20848 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
20849 @end table
20850 @end deftp
20851
20852 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
20853 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
20854 This type has the following parameters:
20855
20856 @table @asis
20857 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
20858 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
20859 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
20860 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
20861
20862 Its default is the first provided domain.
20863
20864 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
20865 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
20866 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
20867
20868 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
20869 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
20870 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
20871 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
20872 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
20873 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
20874 requesting machine.
20875
20876 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20877 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
20878 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
20879 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
20880 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
20881 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
20882
20883 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20884 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
20885 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
20886 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
20887 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
20888 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
20889
20890 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20891 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
20892 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
20893 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
20894 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
20895 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
20896 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
20897 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
20898
20899 @end table
20900 @end deftp
20901
20902 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
20903 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
20904 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
20905 @node DNS Services
20906 @subsection DNS Services
20907 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
20908 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
20909
20910 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
20911 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
20912 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
20913 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
20914 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
20915 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
20916
20917 @subsubheading Knot Service
20918
20919 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
20920 and one slave, is:
20921
20922 @lisp
20923 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
20924 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
20925 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
20926 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
20927 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
20928
20929 (define master-zone
20930 (knot-zone-configuration
20931 (domain "example.org")
20932 (zone (zone-file
20933 (origin "example.org")
20934 (entries example.org.zone)))))
20935
20936 (define slave-zone
20937 (knot-zone-configuration
20938 (domain "plop.org")
20939 (dnssec-policy "default")
20940 (master (list "plop-master"))))
20941
20942 (define plop-master
20943 (knot-remote-configuration
20944 (id "plop-master")
20945 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
20946
20947 (operating-system
20948 ;; ...
20949 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
20950 (knot-configuration
20951 (remotes (list plop-master))
20952 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
20953 ;; ...
20954 %base-services)))
20955 @end lisp
20956
20957 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
20958 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
20959
20960 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
20961 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
20962 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
20963 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
20964 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
20965 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
20966 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
20967
20968 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
20969 @end deffn
20970
20971 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
20972 Data type representing a key.
20973 This type has the following parameters:
20974
20975 @table @asis
20976 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20977 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
20978 be unique and must not be empty.
20979
20980 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
20981 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
20982 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
20983 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
20984
20985 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
20986 The secret key itself.
20987
20988 @end table
20989 @end deftp
20990
20991 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
20992 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
20993 This type has the following parameters:
20994
20995 @table @asis
20996 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20997 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
20998 unique and must not be empty.
20999
21000 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
21001 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
21002 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
21003 address match is not required.
21004
21005 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
21006 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
21007 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
21008 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
21009
21010 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
21011 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
21012 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
21013 and @code{'update}.
21014
21015 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
21016 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
21017 false, listed actions are allowed.
21018
21019 @end table
21020 @end deftp
21021
21022 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
21023 Data type represnting a record entry in a zone file.
21024 This type has the following parameters:
21025
21026 @table @asis
21027 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
21028 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
21029 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
21030 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
21031 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
21032 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
21033
21034 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
21035 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
21036
21037 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
21038 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
21039 partially @code{"CH"}.
21040
21041 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
21042 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
21043 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
21044 defined.
21045
21046 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
21047 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
21048 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
21049 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
21050
21051 @end table
21052 @end deftp
21053
21054 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
21055 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
21056 This type has the following parameters:
21057
21058 @table @asis
21059 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
21060 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
21061 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
21062 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
21063 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
21064 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
21065 field of the @code{zone-file}.
21066
21067 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
21068 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
21069
21070 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
21071 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
21072 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
21073 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
21074 to an IP address in the list of entries.
21075
21076 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
21077 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
21078 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
21079
21080 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
21081 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
21082 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
21083 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
21084
21085 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
21086 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
21087 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
21088 @code{(string->duration)}.
21089
21090 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
21091 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
21092 to do so a first time.
21093
21094 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
21095 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
21096 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
21097 and check again that it still exists.
21098
21099 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
21100 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
21101 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
21102
21103 @end table
21104 @end deftp
21105
21106 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
21107 Data type representing a remote configuration.
21108 This type has the following parameters:
21109
21110 @table @asis
21111 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21112 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
21113 be unique and must not be empty.
21114
21115 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
21116 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
21117 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
21118 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
21119
21120 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
21121 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
21122 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
21123 The default is to choose at random.
21124
21125 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
21126 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
21127 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
21128
21129 @end table
21130 @end deftp
21131
21132 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
21133 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
21134 This type has the following parameters:
21135
21136 @table @asis
21137 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21138 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
21139
21140 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
21141 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
21142
21143 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
21144 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
21145 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
21146 For the pem backend, the string reprensents a path in the file system.
21147
21148 @end table
21149 @end deftp
21150
21151 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
21152 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
21153 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
21154 use keys that you generate.
21155
21156 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
21157 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
21158 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
21159 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
21160 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
21161 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
21162
21163 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
21164 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
21165 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
21166 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
21167 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
21168
21169 This type has the following parameters:
21170
21171 @table @asis
21172 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21173 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
21174
21175 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
21176 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
21177 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
21178 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
21179 was setup by this service).
21180
21181 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
21182 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
21183
21184 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
21185 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
21186
21187 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
21188 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
21189
21190 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
21191 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
21192 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
21193
21194 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
21195 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
21196 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
21197
21198 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
21199 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
21200 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
21201
21202 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21203 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
21204
21205 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
21206 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
21207 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
21208
21209 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
21210 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
21211
21212 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
21213 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
21214
21215 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
21216 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
21217
21218 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
21219 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
21220
21221 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
21222 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
21223 name before hashing.
21224
21225 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21226 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
21227
21228 @end table
21229 @end deftp
21230
21231 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
21232 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
21233 This type has the following parameters:
21234
21235 @table @asis
21236 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
21237 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
21238
21239 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
21240 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
21241 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
21242
21243 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
21244 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
21245 must contain a zone-file record.
21246
21247 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
21248 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
21249 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
21250
21251 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
21252 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
21253 masters.
21254
21255 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
21256 A list of slave remote identifiers.
21257
21258 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
21259 A list of acl identifiers.
21260
21261 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
21262 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
21263
21264 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
21265 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
21266
21267 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
21268 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
21269 synchronization.
21270
21271 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
21272 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
21273 are:
21274
21275 @itemize
21276 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
21277 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
21278 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
21279 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
21280 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
21281 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
21282 automatically.
21283 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
21284 @end itemize
21285
21286 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
21287 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
21288 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
21289 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
21290 default value from Knot is used.
21291
21292 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
21293 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
21294 so the default value from Knot is used.
21295
21296 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
21297 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
21298 default value from Knot is used.
21299
21300 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
21301 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
21302 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
21303 value from Knot is used.
21304
21305 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
21306 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
21307 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
21308 on this zone.
21309
21310 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
21311 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
21312
21313 @end table
21314 @end deftp
21315
21316 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
21317 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
21318 This type has the following parameters:
21319
21320 @table @asis
21321 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
21322 The Knot package.
21323
21324 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
21325 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
21326
21327 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
21328 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
21329 included at the top of the configuration file.
21330
21331 @cindex secrets, Knot service
21332 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
21333 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
21334 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
21335 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
21336 to the @code{includes} list.
21337
21338 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
21339 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
21340 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
21341 tsig key:
21342
21343 @example
21344 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
21345 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
21346 @end example
21347
21348 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
21349 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
21350 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
21351 to that key.
21352
21353 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
21354
21355 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
21356 An ip address on which to listen.
21357
21358 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
21359 An ip address on which to listen.
21360
21361 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
21362 A port on which to listen.
21363
21364 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
21365 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
21366
21367 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
21368 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
21369
21370 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
21371 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
21372
21373 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
21374 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
21375
21376 @end table
21377 @end deftp
21378
21379 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
21380
21381 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
21382 This this the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
21383 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
21384
21385 @lisp
21386 (service knot-resolver-service-type
21387 (knot-resolver-configuration
21388 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
21389 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
21390 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
21391 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
21392 cache.size = 100 * MB
21393 "))))
21394 @end lisp
21395
21396 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
21397 @end deffn
21398
21399 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
21400 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
21401
21402 @table @asis
21403 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
21404 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
21405
21406 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
21407 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
21408 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
21409
21410 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
21411 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
21412
21413 @end table
21414 @end deftp
21415
21416
21417 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
21418
21419 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
21420 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
21421 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
21422
21423 @lisp
21424 (service dnsmasq-service-type
21425 (dnsmasq-configuration
21426 (no-resolv? #t)
21427 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
21428 @end lisp
21429 @end deffn
21430
21431 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
21432 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
21433
21434 @table @asis
21435 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
21436 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
21437
21438 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
21439 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
21440
21441 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
21442 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
21443 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
21444
21445 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
21446 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
21447 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
21448
21449 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
21450 Listen on the given IP addresses.
21451
21452 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
21453 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
21454
21455 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
21456 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
21457
21458 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
21459 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
21460
21461 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
21462 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
21463 disables caching.
21464
21465 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
21466 When false, disable negative caching.
21467
21468 @end table
21469 @end deftp
21470
21471 @subsubheading ddclient Service
21472
21473 @cindex ddclient
21474 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
21475 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
21476 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
21477
21478 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
21479 configuration:
21480
21481 @lisp
21482 (service ddclient-service-type)
21483 @end lisp
21484
21485 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
21486 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
21487 @code{secret-file} below.) You are expected to create this file manually, in
21488 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
21489 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
21490 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}.) See the examples in the
21491 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
21492
21493 @c %start of fragment
21494
21495 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
21496
21497 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
21498 The ddclient package.
21499
21500 @end deftypevr
21501
21502 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
21503 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
21504
21505 Defaults to @samp{300}.
21506
21507 @end deftypevr
21508
21509 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
21510 Use syslog for the output.
21511
21512 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21513
21514 @end deftypevr
21515
21516 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
21517 Mail to user.
21518
21519 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
21520
21521 @end deftypevr
21522
21523 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
21524 Mail failed update to user.
21525
21526 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
21527
21528 @end deftypevr
21529
21530 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
21531 The ddclient PID file.
21532
21533 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
21534
21535 @end deftypevr
21536
21537 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
21538 Enable SSL support.
21539
21540 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21541
21542 @end deftypevr
21543
21544 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
21545 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
21546 program.
21547
21548 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
21549
21550 @end deftypevr
21551
21552 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
21553 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
21554
21555 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
21556
21557 @end deftypevr
21558
21559 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
21560 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
21561 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
21562 create it manually.
21563
21564 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
21565
21566 @end deftypevr
21567
21568 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
21569 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
21570
21571 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21572
21573 @end deftypevr
21574
21575
21576 @c %end of fragment
21577
21578
21579 @node VPN Services
21580 @subsection VPN Services
21581 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
21582 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
21583
21584 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
21585 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
21586 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
21587 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
21588
21589 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
21590 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
21591
21592 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
21593 @end deffn
21594
21595 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
21596 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
21597
21598 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
21599
21600 Both can be run simultaneously.
21601 @end deffn
21602
21603 @c %automatically generated documentation
21604
21605 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
21606
21607 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
21608 The OpenVPN package.
21609
21610 @end deftypevr
21611
21612 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
21613 The OpenVPN pid file.
21614
21615 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
21616
21617 @end deftypevr
21618
21619 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
21620 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
21621 servers.
21622
21623 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
21624
21625 @end deftypevr
21626
21627 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
21628 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
21629
21630 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
21631
21632 @end deftypevr
21633
21634 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
21635 The certificate authority to check connections against.
21636
21637 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
21638
21639 @end deftypevr
21640
21641 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
21642 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
21643 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
21644
21645 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
21646
21647 @end deftypevr
21648
21649 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
21650 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
21651 certificate is @code{cert}.
21652
21653 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
21654
21655 @end deftypevr
21656
21657 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
21658 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
21659
21660 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21661
21662 @end deftypevr
21663
21664 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
21665 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
21666
21667 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21668
21669 @end deftypevr
21670
21671 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
21672 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
21673 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
21674
21675 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21676
21677 @end deftypevr
21678
21679 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
21680 Verbosity level.
21681
21682 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21683
21684 @end deftypevr
21685
21686 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
21687 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
21688 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
21689
21690 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21691
21692 @end deftypevr
21693
21694 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
21695 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
21696
21697 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21698
21699 @end deftypevr
21700
21701 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
21702 Bind to a specific local port number.
21703
21704 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21705
21706 @end deftypevr
21707
21708 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
21709 Retry resolving server address.
21710
21711 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21712
21713 @end deftypevr
21714
21715 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
21716 A list of remote servers to connect to.
21717
21718 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21719
21720 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
21721
21722 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
21723 Server name.
21724
21725 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
21726
21727 @end deftypevr
21728
21729 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
21730 Port number the server listens to.
21731
21732 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21733
21734 @end deftypevr
21735
21736 @end deftypevr
21737 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
21738
21739 @c %automatically generated documentation
21740
21741 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
21742
21743 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
21744 The OpenVPN package.
21745
21746 @end deftypevr
21747
21748 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
21749 The OpenVPN pid file.
21750
21751 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
21752
21753 @end deftypevr
21754
21755 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
21756 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
21757 servers.
21758
21759 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
21760
21761 @end deftypevr
21762
21763 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
21764 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
21765
21766 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
21767
21768 @end deftypevr
21769
21770 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
21771 The certificate authority to check connections against.
21772
21773 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
21774
21775 @end deftypevr
21776
21777 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
21778 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
21779 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
21780
21781 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
21782
21783 @end deftypevr
21784
21785 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
21786 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
21787 certificate is @code{cert}.
21788
21789 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
21790
21791 @end deftypevr
21792
21793 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
21794 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
21795
21796 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21797
21798 @end deftypevr
21799
21800 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
21801 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
21802
21803 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21804
21805 @end deftypevr
21806
21807 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
21808 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
21809 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
21810
21811 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21812
21813 @end deftypevr
21814
21815 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
21816 Verbosity level.
21817
21818 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21819
21820 @end deftypevr
21821
21822 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
21823 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
21824 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
21825
21826 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21827
21828 @end deftypevr
21829
21830 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
21831 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
21832
21833 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21834
21835 @end deftypevr
21836
21837 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
21838 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
21839
21840 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
21841
21842 @end deftypevr
21843
21844 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
21845 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
21846
21847 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21848
21849 @end deftypevr
21850
21851 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
21852 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
21853
21854 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
21855
21856 @end deftypevr
21857
21858 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
21859 The file that records client IPs.
21860
21861 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
21862
21863 @end deftypevr
21864
21865 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
21866 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
21867
21868 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21869
21870 @end deftypevr
21871
21872 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
21873 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
21874
21875 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21876
21877 @end deftypevr
21878
21879 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
21880 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
21881 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
21882 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
21883 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
21884 down.
21885
21886 @end deftypevr
21887
21888 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
21889 The maximum number of clients.
21890
21891 Defaults to @samp{100}.
21892
21893 @end deftypevr
21894
21895 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
21896 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
21897 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
21898
21899 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
21900
21901 @end deftypevr
21902
21903 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
21904 The list of configuration for some clients.
21905
21906 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21907
21908 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
21909
21910 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
21911 Client name.
21912
21913 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
21914
21915 @end deftypevr
21916
21917 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
21918 Client own network
21919
21920 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21921
21922 @end deftypevr
21923
21924 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
21925 Client VPN IP.
21926
21927 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21928
21929 @end deftypevr
21930
21931 @end deftypevr
21932
21933
21934 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
21935
21936
21937 @node Network File System
21938 @subsection Network File System
21939 @cindex NFS
21940
21941 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
21942 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
21943 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
21944
21945 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
21946 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
21947 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
21948
21949 @subsubheading NFS Service
21950 @cindex NFS, server
21951
21952 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
21953 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
21954 the locations that NFS expects.
21955
21956 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
21957 A service type for a complete NFS server.
21958 @end defvr
21959
21960 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
21961 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
21962 of its subsystems.
21963
21964 It has the following parameters:
21965 @table @asis
21966 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
21967 The nfs-utils package to use.
21968
21969 @item @code{nfs-version} (default: @code{#f})
21970 If a string value is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon will be
21971 limited to supporting the given version of the NFS protocol.
21972
21973 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
21974 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
21975 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
21976 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
21977 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
21978
21979 @lisp
21980 (nfs-configuration
21981 (exports
21982 '(("/export"
21983 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
21984 @end lisp
21985
21986 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
21987 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
21988
21989 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
21990 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
21991
21992 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
21993 The rpcbind package to use.
21994
21995 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
21996 The local NFSv4 domain name.
21997
21998 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
21999 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
22000
22001 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
22002 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
22003
22004 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22005 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22006
22007 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
22008 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
22009 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
22010 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
22011 @end table
22012 @end deftp
22013
22014 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
22015 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
22016
22017 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
22018 @cindex rpcbind
22019
22020 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
22021 universal addresses.
22022 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
22023 started when a dependent service starts.
22024
22025 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
22026 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
22027 @end defvr
22028
22029
22030 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
22031 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
22032 This type has the following parameters:
22033 @table @asis
22034 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
22035 The rpcbind package to use.
22036
22037 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
22038 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
22039 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
22040 instance.
22041 @end table
22042 @end deftp
22043
22044
22045 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
22046 @cindex pipefs
22047 @cindex rpc_pipefs
22048
22049 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
22050 between the kernel and user space programs.
22051
22052 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
22053 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
22054 @end defvr
22055
22056 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
22057 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
22058 This type has the following parameters:
22059 @table @asis
22060 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22061 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
22062 @end table
22063 @end deftp
22064
22065
22066 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
22067 @cindex GSSD
22068 @cindex GSS
22069 @cindex global security system
22070
22071 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
22072 based protocols.
22073 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
22074 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
22075 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
22076
22077 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
22078 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
22079 @end defvr
22080
22081 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
22082 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
22083 This type has the following parameters:
22084 @table @asis
22085 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
22086 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
22087
22088 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22089 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22090
22091 @end table
22092 @end deftp
22093
22094
22095 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
22096 @cindex idmapd
22097 @cindex name mapper
22098
22099 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
22100 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
22101
22102 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
22103 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
22104 @end defvr
22105
22106 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
22107 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
22108 This type has the following parameters:
22109 @table @asis
22110 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
22111 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
22112
22113 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22114 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22115
22116 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
22117 The local NFSv4 domain name.
22118 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
22119 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
22120
22121 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
22122 The verbosity level of the daemon.
22123
22124 @end table
22125 @end deftp
22126
22127 @node Continuous Integration
22128 @subsection Continuous Integration
22129
22130 @cindex continuous integration
22131 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
22132 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
22133 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
22134
22135 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
22136
22137 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
22138 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
22139 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
22140 @end defvr
22141
22142 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
22143 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
22144 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
22145 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
22146 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
22147
22148 @lisp
22149 (define %cuirass-specs
22150 #~(list
22151 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
22152 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
22153 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
22154 (#:proc-input . "guix")
22155 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
22156 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
22157 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
22158 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
22159 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
22160 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
22161 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
22162 (#:load-path . ".")
22163 (#:branch . "master")
22164 (#:no-compile? . #t))
22165 ((#:name . "config")
22166 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
22167 (#:load-path . ".")
22168 (#:branch . "master")
22169 (#:no-compile? . #t))
22170 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
22171 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
22172 (#:load-path . ".")
22173 (#:branch . "master")
22174 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
22175
22176 (service cuirass-service-type
22177 (cuirass-configuration
22178 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
22179 @end lisp
22180
22181 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
22182 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
22183 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
22184
22185 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
22186 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
22187
22188 @table @asis
22189 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
22190 Location of the log file.
22191
22192 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
22193 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
22194
22195 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
22196 Location of the repository cache.
22197
22198 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
22199 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
22200
22201 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
22202 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
22203
22204 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
22205 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
22206 Cuirass jobs.
22207
22208 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
22209 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
22210 added specifications.
22211
22212 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
22213 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
22214 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
22215 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
22216
22217 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
22218 Port number used by the HTTP server.
22219
22220 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
22221 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
22222 accept connections from localhost.
22223
22224 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
22225 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
22226 where a specification is an association list
22227 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
22228 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
22229 above.
22230
22231 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
22232 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
22233 from source.
22234
22235 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
22236 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
22237
22238 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
22239 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
22240 packages locally.
22241
22242 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
22243 The Cuirass package to use.
22244 @end table
22245 @end deftp
22246
22247 @node Power Management Services
22248 @subsection Power Management Services
22249
22250 @cindex tlp
22251 @cindex power management with TLP
22252 @subsubheading TLP daemon
22253
22254 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
22255 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
22256
22257 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
22258 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
22259 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
22260 source is detected. More information can be found at
22261 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
22262
22263 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
22264 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
22265 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
22266 write:
22267 @lisp
22268 (service tlp-service-type)
22269 @end lisp
22270 @end deffn
22271
22272 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
22273 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
22274
22275 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
22276 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
22277 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
22278 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
22279 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
22280
22281 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
22282 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
22283 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
22284 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
22285 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
22286 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
22287 @c the churn as TLP updates.
22288
22289 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
22290
22291 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
22292 The TLP package.
22293
22294 @end deftypevr
22295
22296 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
22297 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
22298
22299 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22300
22301 @end deftypevr
22302
22303 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
22304 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
22305 and BAT.
22306
22307 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
22308
22309 @end deftypevr
22310
22311 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
22312 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
22313 before syncing on AC.
22314
22315 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22316
22317 @end deftypevr
22318
22319 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
22320 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
22321
22322 Defaults to @samp{2}.
22323
22324 @end deftypevr
22325
22326 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
22327 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
22328
22329 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22330
22331 @end deftypevr
22332
22333 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
22334 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22335
22336 Defaults to @samp{60}.
22337
22338 @end deftypevr
22339
22340 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
22341 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
22342 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
22343 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
22344
22345 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22346
22347 @end deftypevr
22348
22349 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
22350 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22351
22352 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22353
22354 @end deftypevr
22355
22356 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
22357 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
22358
22359 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22360
22361 @end deftypevr
22362
22363 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
22364 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
22365
22366 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22367
22368 @end deftypevr
22369
22370 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
22371 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
22372
22373 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22374
22375 @end deftypevr
22376
22377 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
22378 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
22379
22380 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22381
22382 @end deftypevr
22383
22384 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
22385 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
22386 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
22387
22388 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22389
22390 @end deftypevr
22391
22392 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
22393 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
22394 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
22395
22396 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22397
22398 @end deftypevr
22399
22400 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
22401 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22402
22403 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22404
22405 @end deftypevr
22406
22407 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
22408 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22409
22410 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22411
22412 @end deftypevr
22413
22414 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
22415 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
22416
22417 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22418
22419 @end deftypevr
22420
22421 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
22422 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
22423
22424 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22425
22426 @end deftypevr
22427
22428 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
22429 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
22430 used under light load conditions.
22431
22432 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22433
22434 @end deftypevr
22435
22436 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
22437 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
22438
22439 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22440
22441 @end deftypevr
22442
22443 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
22444 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
22445
22446 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22447
22448 @end deftypevr
22449
22450 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
22451 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
22452 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
22453
22454 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22455
22456 @end deftypevr
22457
22458 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
22459 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
22460 performance, normal, powersave.
22461
22462 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22463
22464 @end deftypevr
22465
22466 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
22467 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
22468
22469 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
22470
22471 @end deftypevr
22472
22473 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
22474 Hard disk devices.
22475
22476 @end deftypevr
22477
22478 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
22479 Hard disk advanced power management level.
22480
22481 @end deftypevr
22482
22483 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
22484 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
22485
22486 @end deftypevr
22487
22488 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
22489 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
22490 declared hard disk.
22491
22492 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22493
22494 @end deftypevr
22495
22496 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
22497 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22498
22499 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22500
22501 @end deftypevr
22502
22503 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
22504 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
22505 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
22506 noop.
22507
22508 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22509
22510 @end deftypevr
22511
22512 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
22513 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
22514 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
22515
22516 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
22517
22518 @end deftypevr
22519
22520 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
22521 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
22522
22523 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
22524
22525 @end deftypevr
22526
22527 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
22528 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
22529
22530 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22531
22532 @end deftypevr
22533
22534 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
22535 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
22536 mode.
22537
22538 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22539
22540 @end deftypevr
22541
22542 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
22543 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22544
22545 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22546
22547 @end deftypevr
22548
22549 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
22550 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
22551
22552 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22553
22554 @end deftypevr
22555
22556 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
22557 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
22558 default, performance, powersave.
22559
22560 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22561
22562 @end deftypevr
22563
22564 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
22565 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
22566
22567 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
22568
22569 @end deftypevr
22570
22571 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
22572 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
22573 auto, default.
22574
22575 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
22576
22577 @end deftypevr
22578
22579 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
22580 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
22581
22582 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
22583
22584 @end deftypevr
22585
22586 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
22587 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
22588 performance.
22589
22590 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22591
22592 @end deftypevr
22593
22594 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
22595 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
22596
22597 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
22598
22599 @end deftypevr
22600
22601 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
22602 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
22603
22604 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22605
22606 @end deftypevr
22607
22608 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
22609 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
22610
22611 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22612
22613 @end deftypevr
22614
22615 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
22616 Wifi power saving mode.
22617
22618 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22619
22620 @end deftypevr
22621
22622 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
22623 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
22624
22625 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22626
22627 @end deftypevr
22628
22629 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
22630 Disable wake on LAN.
22631
22632 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22633
22634 @end deftypevr
22635
22636 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
22637 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
22638 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
22639
22640 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22641
22642 @end deftypevr
22643
22644 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
22645 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
22646
22647 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22648
22649 @end deftypevr
22650
22651 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
22652 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
22653
22654 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22655
22656 @end deftypevr
22657
22658 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
22659 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
22660 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
22661 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
22662
22663 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22664
22665 @end deftypevr
22666
22667 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
22668 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
22669
22670 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
22671
22672 @end deftypevr
22673
22674 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
22675 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
22676 and auto.
22677
22678 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
22679
22680 @end deftypevr
22681
22682 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
22683 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
22684
22685 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22686
22687 @end deftypevr
22688
22689 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
22690 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
22691 ones.
22692
22693 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22694
22695 @end deftypevr
22696
22697 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
22698 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
22699
22700 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22701
22702 @end deftypevr
22703
22704 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
22705 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
22706 Power Management.
22707
22708 @end deftypevr
22709
22710 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
22711 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
22712
22713 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22714
22715 @end deftypevr
22716
22717 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
22718 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
22719
22720 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22721
22722 @end deftypevr
22723
22724 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
22725 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
22726
22727 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22728
22729 @end deftypevr
22730
22731 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
22732 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
22733 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
22734
22735 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22736
22737 @end deftypevr
22738
22739 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
22740 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
22741
22742 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22743
22744 @end deftypevr
22745
22746 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
22747 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
22748 shutdown on system startup.
22749
22750 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22751
22752 @end deftypevr
22753
22754 @cindex thermald
22755 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
22756 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
22757
22758 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
22759 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
22760
22761 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
22762 This is the service type for
22763 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
22764 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
22765 of processors and preventing overheating.
22766 @end defvr
22767
22768 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
22769 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
22770
22771 @table @asis
22772 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
22773 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
22774
22775 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
22776 Package object of thermald.
22777
22778 @end table
22779 @end deftp
22780
22781 @node Audio Services
22782 @subsection Audio Services
22783
22784 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
22785 (the Music Player Daemon).
22786
22787 @cindex mpd
22788 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
22789
22790 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
22791 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
22792 of clients.
22793
22794 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
22795 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
22796
22797 @lisp
22798 (service mpd-service-type
22799 (mpd-configuration
22800 (user "bob")
22801 (port "6666")))
22802 @end lisp
22803
22804 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
22805 The service type for @command{mpd}
22806 @end defvr
22807
22808 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
22809 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
22810
22811 @table @asis
22812 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
22813 The user to run mpd as.
22814
22815 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
22816 The directory to scan for music files.
22817
22818 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
22819 The directory to store playlists.
22820
22821 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
22822 The location of the music database.
22823
22824 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
22825 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
22826
22827 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
22828 The location of the sticker database.
22829
22830 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
22831 The port to run mpd on.
22832
22833 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
22834 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
22835 an absolute path can be specified here.
22836
22837 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
22838 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
22839
22840 @end table
22841 @end deftp
22842
22843 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
22844 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
22845
22846 @table @asis
22847 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
22848 The name of the audio output.
22849
22850 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
22851 The type of audio output.
22852
22853 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
22854 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
22855 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
22856 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
22857 state is restored.
22858
22859 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
22860 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
22861 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
22862 @code{httpd} output plugin.
22863
22864 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
22865 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
22866 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
22867 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
22868
22869 @item @code{mixer-type}
22870 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
22871 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
22872 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
22873 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
22874 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
22875
22876 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()"})
22877 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
22878 the audio output configuration.
22879
22880 @end table
22881 @end deftp
22882
22883 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
22884 an HTTP audio streaming output.
22885
22886 @lisp
22887 (service mpd-service-type
22888 (mpd-configuration
22889 (outputs
22890 (list (mpd-output
22891 (name "streaming")
22892 (type "httpd")
22893 (mixer-type 'null)
22894 (extra-options
22895 `((encoder . "vorbis")
22896 (port . "8080"))))))))
22897 @end lisp
22898
22899
22900 @node Virtualization Services
22901 @subsection Virtualization services
22902
22903 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
22904 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
22905 services.
22906
22907 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
22908 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
22909 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
22910 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
22911
22912 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
22913 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
22914 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
22915
22916 @lisp
22917 (service libvirt-service-type
22918 (libvirt-configuration
22919 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
22920 (tls-port "16555")))
22921 @end lisp
22922 @end deffn
22923
22924 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
22925 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
22926
22927 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
22928 Libvirt package.
22929
22930 @end deftypevr
22931
22932 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
22933 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
22934 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
22935
22936 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
22937 this capability.
22938
22939 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22940
22941 @end deftypevr
22942
22943 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
22944 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
22945 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
22946
22947 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
22948 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
22949 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
22950
22951 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22952
22953 @end deftypevr
22954
22955 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
22956 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
22957 service name
22958
22959 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
22960
22961 @end deftypevr
22962
22963 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
22964 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
22965 or service name
22966
22967 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
22968
22969 @end deftypevr
22970
22971 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
22972 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
22973
22974 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
22975
22976 @end deftypevr
22977
22978 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
22979 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
22980
22981 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
22982 Avahi daemon.
22983
22984 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22985
22986 @end deftypevr
22987
22988 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
22989 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
22990 broadcast network.
22991
22992 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
22993
22994 @end deftypevr
22995
22996 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
22997 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
22998 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
22999 becoming root.
23000
23001 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
23002
23003 @end deftypevr
23004
23005 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
23006 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
23007 VM status only.
23008
23009 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
23010
23011 @end deftypevr
23012
23013 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
23014 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
23015 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
23016 everyone (eg, 0777)
23017
23018 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
23019
23020 @end deftypevr
23021
23022 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
23023 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
23024 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
23025 the access to.
23026
23027 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
23028
23029 @end deftypevr
23030
23031 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
23032 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
23033
23034 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
23035
23036 @end deftypevr
23037
23038 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
23039 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
23040 permissions allow anyone to connect
23041
23042 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
23043
23044 @end deftypevr
23045
23046 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
23047 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
23048 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
23049 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
23050
23051 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
23052
23053 @end deftypevr
23054
23055 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
23056 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
23057 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
23058 scenario.
23059
23060 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
23061
23062 @end deftypevr
23063
23064 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
23065 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
23066 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
23067 by certificates.
23068
23069 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
23070 by using 'sasl' for this option
23071
23072 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
23073
23074 @end deftypevr
23075
23076 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
23077 API access control scheme.
23078
23079 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
23080 drivers can place restrictions on this.
23081
23082 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23083
23084 @end deftypevr
23085
23086 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
23087 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
23088 loaded.
23089
23090 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23091
23092 @end deftypevr
23093
23094 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
23095 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
23096 loaded.
23097
23098 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23099
23100 @end deftypevr
23101
23102 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
23103 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
23104 is loaded.
23105
23106 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23107
23108 @end deftypevr
23109
23110 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
23111 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
23112 CRL is loaded.
23113
23114 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23115
23116 @end deftypevr
23117
23118 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
23119 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
23120
23121 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
23122 certificates.
23123
23124 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23125
23126 @end deftypevr
23127
23128 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
23129 Disable verification of client certificates.
23130
23131 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
23132 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
23133 rejected.
23134
23135 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23136
23137 @end deftypevr
23138
23139 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
23140 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
23141
23142 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23143
23144 @end deftypevr
23145
23146 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
23147 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
23148 the SASL authentication mechanism.
23149
23150 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23151
23152 @end deftypevr
23153
23154 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
23155 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
23156 usually "NORMAL" unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
23157 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
23158
23159 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
23160
23161 @end deftypevr
23162
23163 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
23164 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
23165 sockets combined.
23166
23167 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
23168
23169 @end deftypevr
23170
23171 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
23172 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
23173 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
23174 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
23175
23176 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
23177
23178 @end deftypevr
23179
23180 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
23181 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
23182 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
23183
23184 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23185
23186 @end deftypevr
23187
23188 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
23189 Number of workers to start up initially.
23190
23191 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23192
23193 @end deftypevr
23194
23195 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
23196 Maximum number of worker threads.
23197
23198 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
23199 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
23200 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
23201
23202 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23203
23204 @end deftypevr
23205
23206 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
23207 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
23208 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
23209 executed in this pool.
23210
23211 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23212
23213 @end deftypevr
23214
23215 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
23216 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
23217
23218 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23219
23220 @end deftypevr
23221
23222 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
23223 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
23224 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
23225 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
23226
23227 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23228
23229 @end deftypevr
23230
23231 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
23232 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
23233
23234 Defaults to @samp{1}.
23235
23236 @end deftypevr
23237
23238 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
23239 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
23240
23241 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23242
23243 @end deftypevr
23244
23245 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
23246 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
23247
23248 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23249
23250 @end deftypevr
23251
23252 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
23253 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
23254
23255 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23256
23257 @end deftypevr
23258
23259 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
23260 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
23261
23262 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23263
23264 @end deftypevr
23265
23266 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
23267 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
23268
23269 Defaults to @samp{3}.
23270
23271 @end deftypevr
23272
23273 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
23274 Logging filters.
23275
23276 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
23277 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
23278
23279 @itemize @bullet
23280 @item
23281 x:name
23282
23283 @item
23284 x:+name
23285
23286 @end itemize
23287
23288 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
23289 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
23290 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
23291 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
23292 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
23293 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
23294 where matching messages should be logged:
23295
23296 @itemize @bullet
23297 @item
23298 1: DEBUG
23299
23300 @item
23301 2: INFO
23302
23303 @item
23304 3: WARNING
23305
23306 @item
23307 4: ERROR
23308
23309 @end itemize
23310
23311 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
23312 need to be separated by spaces.
23313
23314 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
23315
23316 @end deftypevr
23317
23318 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
23319 Logging outputs.
23320
23321 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
23322 for an output can be:
23323
23324 @table @code
23325 @item x:stderr
23326 output goes to stderr
23327
23328 @item x:syslog:name
23329 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
23330
23331 @item x:file:file_path
23332 output to a file, with the given filepath
23333
23334 @item x:journald
23335 output to journald logging system
23336
23337 @end table
23338
23339 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
23340
23341 @itemize @bullet
23342 @item
23343 1: DEBUG
23344
23345 @item
23346 2: INFO
23347
23348 @item
23349 3: WARNING
23350
23351 @item
23352 4: ERROR
23353
23354 @end itemize
23355
23356 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
23357 spaces.
23358
23359 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
23360
23361 @end deftypevr
23362
23363 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
23364 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
23365
23366 @itemize @bullet
23367 @item
23368 0: disable all auditing
23369
23370 @item
23371 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
23372
23373 @item
23374 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
23375
23376 @end itemize
23377
23378 Defaults to @samp{1}.
23379
23380 @end deftypevr
23381
23382 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
23383 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
23384
23385 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23386
23387 @end deftypevr
23388
23389 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
23390 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
23391
23392 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23393
23394 @end deftypevr
23395
23396 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
23397 Source to read host UUID.
23398
23399 @itemize @bullet
23400 @item
23401 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
23402
23403 @item
23404 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
23405
23406 @end itemize
23407
23408 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
23409 be generated.
23410
23411 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
23412
23413 @end deftypevr
23414
23415 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
23416 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
23417 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
23418 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
23419 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
23420
23421 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23422
23423 @end deftypevr
23424
23425 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
23426 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
23427 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
23428 broken.
23429
23430 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
23431 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
23432 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
23433 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
23434 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
23435 keepalive messages.
23436
23437 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23438
23439 @end deftypevr
23440
23441 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
23442 Same as above but for admin interface.
23443
23444 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23445
23446 @end deftypevr
23447
23448 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
23449 Same as above but for admin interface.
23450
23451 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23452
23453 @end deftypevr
23454
23455 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
23456 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
23457
23458 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
23459 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
23460 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
23461
23462 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23463
23464 @end deftypevr
23465
23466 @c %end of autogenerated docs
23467
23468 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
23469 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
23470 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
23471
23472 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
23473 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
23474 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
23475 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
23476 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
23477
23478 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
23479 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
23480 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
23481
23482 @lisp
23483 (service virtlog-service-type
23484 (virtlog-configuration
23485 (max-clients 1000)))
23486 @end lisp
23487 @end deffn
23488
23489 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
23490 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
23491
23492 Defaults to @samp{3}.
23493
23494 @end deftypevr
23495
23496 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
23497 Logging filters.
23498
23499 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
23500 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
23501
23502 @itemize @bullet
23503 @item
23504 x:name
23505
23506 @item
23507 x:+name
23508
23509 @end itemize
23510
23511 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
23512 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
23513 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
23514 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
23515 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
23516 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
23517 where matching messages should be logged:
23518
23519 @itemize @bullet
23520 @item
23521 1: DEBUG
23522
23523 @item
23524 2: INFO
23525
23526 @item
23527 3: WARNING
23528
23529 @item
23530 4: ERROR
23531
23532 @end itemize
23533
23534 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
23535 need to be separated by spaces.
23536
23537 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
23538
23539 @end deftypevr
23540
23541 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
23542 Logging outputs.
23543
23544 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
23545 for an output can be:
23546
23547 @table @code
23548 @item x:stderr
23549 output goes to stderr
23550
23551 @item x:syslog:name
23552 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
23553
23554 @item x:file:file_path
23555 output to a file, with the given filepath
23556
23557 @item x:journald
23558 output to journald logging system
23559
23560 @end table
23561
23562 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
23563
23564 @itemize @bullet
23565 @item
23566 1: DEBUG
23567
23568 @item
23569 2: INFO
23570
23571 @item
23572 3: WARNING
23573
23574 @item
23575 4: ERROR
23576
23577 @end itemize
23578
23579 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
23580 spaces.
23581
23582 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
23583
23584 @end deftypevr
23585
23586 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
23587 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
23588 sockets combined.
23589
23590 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
23591
23592 @end deftypevr
23593
23594 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
23595 Maximum file size before rolling over.
23596
23597 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
23598
23599 @end deftypevr
23600
23601 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
23602 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
23603
23604 Defaults to @samp{3}
23605
23606 @end deftypevr
23607
23608 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
23609
23610 @cindex emulation
23611 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
23612 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
23613 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
23614 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
23615 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
23616 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
23617
23618 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
23619 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
23620 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
23621 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
23622 emulated:
23623
23624 @lisp
23625 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
23626 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
23627 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64" "mips64el"))))
23628 @end lisp
23629
23630 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
23631 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
23632 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
23633 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
23634 @end defvr
23635
23636 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
23637 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
23638
23639 @table @asis
23640 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
23641 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
23642 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
23643
23644 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
23645 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
23646 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
23647 @code{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
23648 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
23649 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
23650
23651 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
23652 service:
23653
23654 @lisp
23655 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
23656 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
23657 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
23658 (guix-support? #t)))
23659 @end lisp
23660
23661 You can run:
23662
23663 @example
23664 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
23665 @end example
23666
23667 @noindent
23668 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
23669 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
23670 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
23671 access to!
23672
23673 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
23674 The QEMU package to use.
23675 @end table
23676 @end deftp
23677
23678 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
23679 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
23680 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
23681 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
23682 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
23683 @end deffn
23684
23685 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
23686 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
23687 @end deffn
23688
23689 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
23690 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
23691 @end deffn
23692
23693 @node Version Control Services
23694 @subsection Version Control Services
23695
23696 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
23697 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
23698 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
23699 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
23700 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
23701 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
23702 @code{cgit-service-type}.
23703
23704 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
23705
23706 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
23707 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
23708
23709 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
23710 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
23711 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
23712 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
23713 @file{/srv/git}.
23714
23715 @end deffn
23716
23717 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
23718 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
23719
23720 @table @asis
23721 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
23722 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
23723
23724 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
23725 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
23726 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
23727
23728 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
23729 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
23730 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
23731 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
23732 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
23733
23734 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
23735 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
23736 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
23737 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
23738 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
23739 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
23740 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
23741
23742 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
23743 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
23744 all.
23745
23746 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
23747 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
23748
23749 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
23750 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
23751
23752 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
23753 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
23754 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
23755
23756 @end table
23757 @end deftp
23758
23759 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
23760 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
23761 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
23762 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
23763 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
23764 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
23765 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
23766 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
23767 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
23768 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
23769
23770 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
23771 over HTTP.
23772
23773 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
23774 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-http-service}.
23775
23776 @table @asis
23777 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
23778 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
23779
23780 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
23781 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
23782
23783 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
23784 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
23785 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
23786
23787 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @file{/git/})
23788 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @code{/git/} prefix, this
23789 will map @code{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
23790 @code{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
23791 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
23792
23793 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
23794 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
23795 Services}.
23796 @end table
23797 @end deftp
23798
23799 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
23800 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
23801 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
23802 server.
23803
23804 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
23805 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
23806 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
23807 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
23808 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
23809
23810 @lisp
23811 (service nginx-service-type
23812 (nginx-configuration
23813 (server-blocks
23814 (list
23815 (nginx-server-configuration
23816 (listen '("443 ssl"))
23817 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
23818 (ssl-certificate
23819 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
23820 (ssl-certificate-key
23821 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
23822 (locations
23823 (list
23824 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
23825 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
23826 @end lisp
23827
23828 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
23829 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
23830 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
23831 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
23832 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
23833 @end deffn
23834
23835 @subsubheading Cgit Service
23836
23837 @cindex Cgit service
23838 @cindex Git, web interface
23839 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
23840 repositories written in C.
23841
23842 The following example will configure the service with default values.
23843 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
23844
23845 @lisp
23846 (service cgit-service-type)
23847 @end lisp
23848
23849 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
23850 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
23851
23852 @c %start of fragment
23853
23854 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
23855
23856 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
23857 The CGIT package.
23858
23859 @end deftypevr
23860
23861 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
23862 NGINX configuration.
23863
23864 @end deftypevr
23865
23866 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
23867 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
23868 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
23869
23870 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23871
23872 @end deftypevr
23873
23874 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
23875 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
23876 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
23877
23878 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23879
23880 @end deftypevr
23881
23882 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
23883 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
23884 access.
23885
23886 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23887
23888 @end deftypevr
23889
23890 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
23891 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
23892 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
23893
23894 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
23895
23896 @end deftypevr
23897
23898 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
23899 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
23900
23901 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
23902
23903 @end deftypevr
23904
23905 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
23906 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23907 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
23908
23909 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
23910
23911 @end deftypevr
23912
23913 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
23914 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23915 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
23916
23917 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23918
23919 @end deftypevr
23920
23921 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
23922 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23923 version of the repository summary page.
23924
23925 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23926
23927 @end deftypevr
23928
23929 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
23930 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23931 version of the repository index page.
23932
23933 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23934
23935 @end deftypevr
23936
23937 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
23938 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
23939 scanning a path for Git repositories.
23940
23941 Defaults to @samp{15}.
23942
23943 @end deftypevr
23944
23945 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
23946 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23947 version of the repository about page.
23948
23949 Defaults to @samp{15}.
23950
23951 @end deftypevr
23952
23953 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
23954 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23955 version of snapshots.
23956
23957 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23958
23959 @end deftypevr
23960
23961 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
23962 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
23963 caching is disabled.
23964
23965 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23966
23967 @end deftypevr
23968
23969 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
23970 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
23971
23972 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23973
23974 @end deftypevr
23975
23976 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
23977 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
23978 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
23979
23980 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23981
23982 @end deftypevr
23983
23984 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
23985 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
23986
23987 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23988
23989 @end deftypevr
23990
23991 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
23992 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
23993
23994 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23995
23996 @end deftypevr
23997
23998 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
23999 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
24000 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
24001 ordering.
24002
24003 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
24004
24005 @end deftypevr
24006
24007 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
24008 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
24009
24010 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
24011
24012 @end deftypevr
24013
24014 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
24015 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
24016 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
24017 places throughout the cgit interface.
24018
24019 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24020
24021 @end deftypevr
24022
24023 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
24024 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
24025 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
24026
24027 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24028
24029 @end deftypevr
24030
24031 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
24032 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
24033 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
24034 repository log page.
24035
24036 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24037
24038 @end deftypevr
24039
24040 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
24041 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
24042 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
24043
24044 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24045
24046 @end deftypevr
24047
24048 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
24049 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
24050 log view.
24051
24052 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24053
24054 @end deftypevr
24055
24056 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
24057 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
24058 clones.
24059
24060 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24061
24062 @end deftypevr
24063
24064 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
24065 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
24066 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
24067
24068 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24069
24070 @end deftypevr
24071
24072 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
24073 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
24074 each repo in the repository index.
24075
24076 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24077
24078 @end deftypevr
24079
24080 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
24081 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
24082 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
24083
24084 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24085
24086 @end deftypevr
24087
24088 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
24089 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
24090 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
24091
24092 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24093
24094 @end deftypevr
24095
24096 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
24097 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
24098 branches in the summary and refs views.
24099
24100 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24101
24102 @end deftypevr
24103
24104 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
24105 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
24106 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
24107 commit view.
24108
24109 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24110
24111 @end deftypevr
24112
24113 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
24114 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
24115 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
24116 commit view.
24117
24118 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24119
24120 @end deftypevr
24121
24122 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
24123 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
24124 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
24125
24126 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24127
24128 @end deftypevr
24129
24130 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
24131 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
24132 set any repo specific settings.
24133
24134 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24135
24136 @end deftypevr
24137
24138 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
24139 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
24140
24141 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
24142
24143 @end deftypevr
24144
24145 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
24146 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24147 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
24148 "generated by..."@: message).
24149
24150 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24151
24152 @end deftypevr
24153
24154 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
24155 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24156 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
24157
24158 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24159
24160 @end deftypevr
24161
24162 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
24163 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24164 verbatim at the top of all pages.
24165
24166 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24167
24168 @end deftypevr
24169
24170 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
24171 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
24172 file is parsed.
24173
24174 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24175
24176 @end deftypevr
24177
24178 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
24179 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24180 verbatim above the repository index.
24181
24182 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24183
24184 @end deftypevr
24185
24186 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
24187 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24188 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
24189
24190 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24191
24192 @end deftypevr
24193
24194 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
24195 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
24196 in the servers timezone.
24197
24198 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24199
24200 @end deftypevr
24201
24202 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
24203 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
24204 on all cgit pages.
24205
24206 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
24207
24208 @end deftypevr
24209
24210 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
24211 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
24212
24213 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24214
24215 @end deftypevr
24216
24217 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
24218 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
24219 page.
24220
24221 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24222
24223 @end deftypevr
24224
24225 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
24226 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
24227
24228 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24229
24230 @end deftypevr
24231
24232 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
24233 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
24234
24235 Defaults to @samp{50}.
24236
24237 @end deftypevr
24238
24239 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
24240 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
24241
24242 Defaults to @samp{80}.
24243
24244 @end deftypevr
24245
24246 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
24247 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
24248 page.
24249
24250 Defaults to @samp{50}.
24251
24252 @end deftypevr
24253
24254 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
24255 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
24256 on the repository index page.
24257
24258 Defaults to @samp{80}.
24259
24260 @end deftypevr
24261
24262 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
24263 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
24264
24265 Defaults to @samp{0}.
24266
24267 @end deftypevr
24268
24269 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
24270 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
24271 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
24272
24273 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24274
24275 @end deftypevr
24276
24277 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
24278 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
24279
24280 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
24281 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
24282 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
24283
24284 @end deftypevr
24285
24286 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
24287 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
24288
24289 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24290
24291 @end deftypevr
24292
24293 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
24294 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24295 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
24296
24297 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24298
24299 @end deftypevr
24300
24301 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
24302 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
24303
24304 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24305
24306 @end deftypevr
24307
24308 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
24309 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
24310 disabled.
24311
24312 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24313
24314 @end deftypevr
24315
24316 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
24317 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
24318 header on all pages.
24319
24320 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24321
24322 @end deftypevr
24323
24324 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
24325 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
24326 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
24327 all subdirectories will be loaded.
24328
24329 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24330
24331 @end deftypevr
24332
24333 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
24334 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
24335
24336 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24337
24338 @end deftypevr
24339
24340 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
24341 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
24342 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
24343 removed for the URL and name.
24344
24345 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24346
24347 @end deftypevr
24348
24349 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
24350 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
24351
24352 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
24353
24354 @end deftypevr
24355
24356 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
24357 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
24358
24359 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24360
24361 @end deftypevr
24362
24363 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
24364 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
24365
24366 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
24367
24368 @end deftypevr
24369
24370 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
24371 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
24372
24373 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
24374
24375 @end deftypevr
24376
24377 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
24378 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24379 verbatim below thef "about" link on the repository index page.
24380
24381 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24382
24383 @end deftypevr
24384
24385 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
24386 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
24387
24388 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24389
24390 @end deftypevr
24391
24392 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
24393 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
24394 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
24395 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
24396 directories, considered as "hidden". Note that this does not apply to
24397 the ".git" directory in non-bare repos.
24398
24399 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24400
24401 @end deftypevr
24402
24403 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
24404 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
24405 generates links for.
24406
24407 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24408
24409 @end deftypevr
24410
24411 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
24412 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
24413 @code{scan-path}).
24414
24415 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
24416
24417 @end deftypevr
24418
24419 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
24420 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
24421 after this option will inherit the current section name.
24422
24423 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24424
24425 @end deftypevr
24426
24427 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
24428 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
24429 repository listing by name.
24430
24431 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24432
24433 @end deftypevr
24434
24435 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
24436 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
24437 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
24438
24439 Defaults to @samp{0}.
24440
24441 @end deftypevr
24442
24443 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
24444 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
24445 default.
24446
24447 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24448
24449 @end deftypevr
24450
24451 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
24452 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
24453 the tree view.
24454
24455 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24456
24457 @end deftypevr
24458
24459 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
24460 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository "summary"
24461 view.
24462
24463 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24464
24465 @end deftypevr
24466
24467 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
24468 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
24469 "summary" view.
24470
24471 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24472
24473 @end deftypevr
24474
24475 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
24476 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository "summary"
24477 view.
24478
24479 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24480
24481 @end deftypevr
24482
24483 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
24484 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
24485 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
24486
24487 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24488
24489 @end deftypevr
24490
24491 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
24492 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
24493
24494 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
24495
24496 @end deftypevr
24497
24498 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
24499 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
24500
24501 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24502
24503 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
24504
24505 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
24506 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
24507 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
24508
24509 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24510
24511 @end deftypevr
24512
24513 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
24514 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
24515
24516 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24517
24518 @end deftypevr
24519
24520 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
24521 The relative URL used to access the repository.
24522
24523 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24524
24525 @end deftypevr
24526
24527 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
24528 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
24529
24530 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24531
24532 @end deftypevr
24533
24534 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
24535 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
24536 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
24537
24538 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24539
24540 @end deftypevr
24541
24542 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
24543 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
24544
24545 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24546
24547 @end deftypevr
24548
24549 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
24550 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
24551
24552 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24553
24554 @end deftypevr
24555
24556 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
24557 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
24558 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
24559 ordering.
24560
24561 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24562
24563 @end deftypevr
24564
24565 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
24566 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
24567 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
24568 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or "master" if
24569 there is no suitable HEAD.
24570
24571 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24572
24573 @end deftypevr
24574
24575 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
24576 The value to show as repository description.
24577
24578 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24579
24580 @end deftypevr
24581
24582 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
24583 The value to show as repository homepage.
24584
24585 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24586
24587 @end deftypevr
24588
24589 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
24590 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
24591
24592 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24593
24594 @end deftypevr
24595
24596 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
24597 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24598 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
24599
24600 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24601
24602 @end deftypevr
24603
24604 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
24605 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24606 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
24607
24608 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24609
24610 @end deftypevr
24611
24612 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
24613 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24614 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
24615
24616 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24617
24618 @end deftypevr
24619
24620 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
24621 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
24622 branches in the summary and refs views.
24623
24624 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24625
24626 @end deftypevr
24627
24628 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
24629 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
24630 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
24631
24632 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24633
24634 @end deftypevr
24635
24636 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
24637 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
24638 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
24639
24640 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24641
24642 @end deftypevr
24643
24644 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
24645 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
24646 repository index.
24647
24648 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24649
24650 @end deftypevr
24651
24652 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
24653 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
24654
24655 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24656
24657 @end deftypevr
24658
24659 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
24660 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
24661 on this repo’s pages.
24662
24663 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24664
24665 @end deftypevr
24666
24667 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
24668 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
24669
24670 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24671
24672 @end deftypevr
24673
24674 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
24675 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
24676
24677 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24678
24679 @end deftypevr
24680
24681 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
24682 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24683 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
24684 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
24685
24686 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24687
24688 @end deftypevr
24689
24690 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
24691 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24692 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
24693 listing.
24694
24695 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24696
24697 @end deftypevr
24698
24699 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
24700 Override the default maximum statistics period.
24701
24702 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24703
24704 @end deftypevr
24705
24706 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
24707 The value to show as repository name.
24708
24709 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24710
24711 @end deftypevr
24712
24713 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
24714 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
24715
24716 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24717
24718 @end deftypevr
24719
24720 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
24721 An absolute path to the repository directory.
24722
24723 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24724
24725 @end deftypevr
24726
24727 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
24728 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
24729 the "About" page for this repo.
24730
24731 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24732
24733 @end deftypevr
24734
24735 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
24736 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
24737 after this option will inherit the current section name.
24738
24739 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24740
24741 @end deftypevr
24742
24743 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
24744 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
24745
24746 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24747
24748 @end deftypevr
24749
24750 @end deftypevr
24751
24752 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
24753 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
24754
24755 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24756
24757 @end deftypevr
24758
24759
24760 @c %end of fragment
24761
24762 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
24763 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
24764 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
24765 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
24766
24767 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
24768
24769 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
24770 The cgit package.
24771 @end deftypevr
24772
24773 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
24774 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
24775 @end deftypevr
24776
24777 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
24778 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
24779
24780 @lisp
24781 (service cgit-service-type
24782 (opaque-cgit-configuration
24783 (cgitrc "")))
24784 @end lisp
24785
24786 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
24787
24788 @cindex Gitolite service
24789 @cindex Git, hosting
24790 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
24791 repositories on a central server.
24792
24793 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
24794 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
24795
24796 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
24797 user, and the provided SSH public key.
24798
24799 @lisp
24800 (service gitolite-service-type
24801 (gitolite-configuration
24802 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
24803 "yourname.pub"
24804 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
24805 @end lisp
24806
24807 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
24808 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
24809 following command to clone the admin repository.
24810
24811 @example
24812 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
24813 @end example
24814
24815 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
24816 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
24817 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
24818 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
24819
24820 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
24821 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
24822
24823 @table @asis
24824 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
24825 Gitolite package to use.
24826
24827 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
24828 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
24829 Gitolite over SSH.
24830
24831 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
24832 Group to use for Gitolite.
24833
24834 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
24835 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
24836
24837 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
24838 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
24839 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
24840
24841 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
24842 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
24843 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
24844 within the gitolite-admin repository.
24845
24846 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
24847
24848 @lisp
24849 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
24850 @end lisp
24851
24852 @end table
24853 @end deftp
24854
24855 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
24856 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
24857
24858 @table @asis
24859 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
24860 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
24861 contents.
24862
24863 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
24864 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
24865 like cgit or gitweb.
24866
24867 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
24868 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the "config" keyword. This
24869 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
24870
24871 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
24872 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
24873
24874 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
24875 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
24876
24877 @end table
24878 @end deftp
24879
24880
24881 @node Game Services
24882 @subsection Game Services
24883
24884 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
24885 @cindex wesnothd
24886 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
24887 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
24888 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
24889
24890 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
24891 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
24892 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
24893 configuration, instantiate it as:
24894
24895 @lisp
24896 (service wesnothd-service-type)
24897 @end lisp
24898 @end defvar
24899
24900 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
24901 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
24902
24903 @table @asis
24904 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
24905 The wesnoth server package to use.
24906
24907 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
24908 The port to bind the server to.
24909 @end table
24910 @end deftp
24911
24912
24913 @node PAM Mount Service
24914 @subsection PAM Mount Service
24915 @cindex pam-mount
24916
24917 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
24918 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
24919 volume format supported by the system.
24920
24921 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
24922 Service type for PAM Mount support.
24923 @end defvar
24924
24925 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
24926 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
24927
24928 It takes the following parameters:
24929
24930 @table @asis
24931 @item @code{rules}
24932 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
24933 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
24934
24935 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
24936 Guile Reference Manual}), and the the default ones don't mount anything
24937 for anyone at login:
24938
24939 @lisp
24940 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
24941 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
24942 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
24943 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
24944 "allow_root" "allow_other")
24945 ","))))
24946 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
24947 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
24948 (hup "0")
24949 (term "no")
24950 (kill "no")))
24951 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
24952 (remove "true"))))
24953 @end lisp
24954
24955 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
24956 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
24957 encrypted @code{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
24958 the partition where he stores his data:
24959
24960 @lisp
24961 (define pam-mount-rules
24962 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
24963 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
24964 (fstype "crypt")
24965 (path "/dev/sda2")
24966 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
24967 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
24968 (fstype "auto")
24969 (path "/dev/sdb3")
24970 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
24971 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
24972 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
24973 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
24974 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
24975 "allow_root" "allow_other")
24976 ","))))
24977 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
24978 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
24979 (hup "0")
24980 (term "no")
24981 (kill "no")))
24982 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
24983 (remove "true")))))
24984
24985 (service pam-mount-service-type
24986 (pam-mount-configuration
24987 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
24988 @end lisp
24989
24990 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
24991 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
24992 @end table
24993 @end deftp
24994
24995
24996 @node Guix Services
24997 @subsection Guix Services
24998
24999 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
25000 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
25001 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
25002 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
25003
25004 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
25005 interface.
25006
25007 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
25008 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
25009 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
25010 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
25011 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
25012 @end defvar
25013
25014 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
25015 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
25016
25017 @table @asis
25018 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
25019 The Guix Data Service package to use.
25020
25021 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
25022 The system user to run the service as.
25023
25024 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
25025 The system group to run the service as.
25026
25027 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
25028 The port to bind the web service to.
25029
25030 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
25031 The host to bind the web service to.
25032
25033 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
25034 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
25035 configured to listen to.
25036
25037 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
25038 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
25039 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
25040 list.
25041
25042 @end table
25043 @end deftp
25044
25045
25046 @node Miscellaneous Services
25047 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
25048
25049 @cindex fingerprint
25050 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
25051
25052 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
25053 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
25054
25055 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
25056 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
25057 reading capability.
25058
25059 @lisp
25060 (service fprintd-service-type)
25061 @end lisp
25062 @end defvr
25063
25064 @cindex sysctl
25065 @subsubheading System Control Service
25066
25067 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
25068 parameters at boot.
25069
25070 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
25071 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
25072 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
25073 instantiated as:
25074
25075 @lisp
25076 (service sysctl-service-type
25077 (sysctl-configuration
25078 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
25079 @end lisp
25080 @end defvr
25081
25082 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
25083 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
25084
25085 @table @asis
25086 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
25087 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
25088
25089 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
25090 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
25091 @end table
25092 @end deftp
25093
25094 @cindex pcscd
25095 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
25096
25097 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
25098 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
25099 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
25100 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
25101 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
25102
25103 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
25104 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
25105 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
25106 configuration, instantiate it as:
25107
25108 @lisp
25109 (service pcscd-service-type)
25110 @end lisp
25111 @end defvr
25112
25113 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
25114 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
25115
25116 @table @asis
25117 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
25118 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
25119 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
25120 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
25121 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
25122 @end table
25123 @end deftp
25124
25125 @cindex lirc
25126 @subsubheading Lirc Service
25127
25128 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
25129
25130 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
25131 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
25132 [#:extra-options '()]
25133 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
25134 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
25135
25136 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
25137 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
25138 for details.
25139
25140 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
25141 passed to @command{lircd}.
25142 @end deffn
25143
25144 @cindex spice
25145 @subsubheading Spice Service
25146
25147 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
25148
25149 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
25150 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
25151 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
25152 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
25153 @end deffn
25154
25155 @cindex inputattach
25156 @subsubheading inputattach Service
25157
25158 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
25159 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
25160 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
25161 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
25162 Xorg display server.
25163
25164 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
25165 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
25166 dispatches events from it.
25167 @end deffn
25168
25169 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
25170 @table @asis
25171 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
25172 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
25173 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
25174
25175 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
25176 The device file to connect to the device.
25177
25178 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
25179 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
25180 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
25181
25182 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
25183 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
25184 @end table
25185 @end deftp
25186
25187 @subsection Dictionary Services
25188 @cindex dictionary
25189 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
25190
25191 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
25192 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
25193 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25194
25195 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
25196 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
25197 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
25198
25199 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
25200 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
25201 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25202 @end deffn
25203
25204 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
25205 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
25206
25207 @table @asis
25208 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
25209 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
25210
25211 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
25212 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
25213 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
25214 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25215
25216 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
25217 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
25218
25219 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
25220 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
25221 @end table
25222 @end deftp
25223
25224 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
25225 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
25226
25227 @table @asis
25228 @item @code{name}
25229 Name of the handler (module instance).
25230
25231 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
25232 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
25233 the module has the same name as the handler.
25234 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25235
25236 @item @code{options}
25237 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
25238 @end table
25239 @end deftp
25240
25241 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
25242 Data type representing a dictionary database.
25243
25244 @table @asis
25245 @item @code{name}
25246 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
25247
25248 @item @code{handler}
25249 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
25250 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25251
25252 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
25253 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
25254 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
25255
25256 @item @code{options}
25257 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
25258 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25259 @end table
25260 @end deftp
25261
25262 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
25263 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
25264 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
25265 @end defvr
25266
25267 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
25268
25269 @lisp
25270 (dicod-service #:config
25271 (dicod-configuration
25272 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
25273 (name "wordnet")
25274 (module "dictorg")
25275 (options
25276 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
25277 (databases (list (dicod-database
25278 (name "wordnet")
25279 (complex? #t)
25280 (handler "wordnet")
25281 (options '("database=wn")))
25282 %dicod-database:gcide))))
25283 @end lisp
25284
25285 @cindex Docker
25286 @subsubheading Docker Service
25287
25288 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
25289
25290 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
25291
25292 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
25293 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
25294 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
25295
25296 @end defvr
25297
25298 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
25299 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
25300
25301 @table @asis
25302
25303 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
25304 The Docker package to use.
25305
25306 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
25307 The Containerd package to use.
25308
25309 @end table
25310 @end deftp
25311
25312 @cindex Audit
25313 @subsubheading Auditd Service
25314
25315 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
25316
25317 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
25318
25319 This is the type of the service that runs
25320 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
25321 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
25322
25323 Examples of things that can be tracked:
25324
25325 @enumerate
25326 @item
25327 File accesses
25328 @item
25329 System calls
25330 @item
25331 Invoked commands
25332 @item
25333 Failed login attempts
25334 @item
25335 Firewall filtering
25336 @item
25337 Network access
25338 @end enumerate
25339
25340 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
25341 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
25342 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
25343 of auditctl into @file{/etc/audit/audit.rules}.
25344 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
25345 to view a report of all recorded events.
25346 The audit daemon usually logs into the directory @file{/var/log/audit}.
25347
25348 @end defvr
25349
25350 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
25351 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
25352
25353 @table @asis
25354
25355 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
25356 The audit package to use.
25357
25358 @end table
25359 @end deftp
25360
25361 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
25362 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
25363 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
25364 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
25365 service is the Singularity package to use.
25366
25367 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
25368 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
25369 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
25370 @end defvr
25371
25372 @cindex Nix
25373 @subsubheading Nix service
25374
25375 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
25376
25377 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
25378
25379 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
25380 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
25381 how to use it:
25382
25383 @lisp
25384 (use-modules (gnu))
25385 (use-service-modules nix)
25386 (use-package-modules package-management)
25387
25388 (operating-system
25389 ;; @dots{}
25390 (packages (append (list nix)
25391 %base-packages))
25392
25393 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
25394 %base-services)))
25395 @end lisp
25396
25397 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
25398
25399 @itemize
25400 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
25401 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
25402
25403 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
25404 @end itemize
25405
25406 @example
25407 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
25408 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
25409 @end example
25410
25411 @end defvr
25412
25413 @node Setuid Programs
25414 @section Setuid Programs
25415
25416 @cindex setuid programs
25417 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
25418 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
25419 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
25420 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
25421 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
25422 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
25423 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
25424 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
25425 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
25426
25427 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
25428 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
25429 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
25430 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
25431 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
25432 should be setuid root.
25433
25434 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
25435 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
25436 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
25437 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
25438 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
25439
25440 @example
25441 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
25442 @end example
25443
25444 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
25445 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
25446
25447 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
25448 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
25449
25450 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
25451 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
25452 @end defvr
25453
25454 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
25455 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
25456 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
25457 store.
25458
25459 @node X.509 Certificates
25460 @section X.509 Certificates
25461
25462 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
25463 @cindex X.509 certificates
25464 @cindex TLS
25465 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
25466 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
25467 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
25468 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
25469 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
25470 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
25471
25472 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
25473 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
25474 out-of-the-box.
25475
25476 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
25477 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
25478 certificates can be found.
25479
25480 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
25481 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
25482 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
25483 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
25484 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
25485 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
25486
25487 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
25488 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
25489 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
25490 to the certificates installed globally.
25491
25492 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
25493 can also install their own certificate package in
25494 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
25495 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
25496 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
25497 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
25498 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
25499 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
25500 would typically run something like:
25501
25502 @example
25503 $ guix install nss-certs
25504 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
25505 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
25506 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
25507 @end example
25508
25509 As another example, R requires the @code{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
25510 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
25511 something like this:
25512
25513 @example
25514 $ guix install nss-certs
25515 $ export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
25516 @end example
25517
25518 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
25519 variable in the relevant documentation.
25520
25521
25522 @node Name Service Switch
25523 @section Name Service Switch
25524
25525 @cindex name service switch
25526 @cindex NSS
25527 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
25528 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
25529 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
25530 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
25531 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
25532 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
25533 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
25534 C Library Reference Manual}).
25535
25536 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
25537 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
25538 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
25539 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
25540 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
25541 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
25542
25543 @cindex nss-mdns
25544 @cindex .local, host name lookup
25545 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
25546 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
25547 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
25548 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
25549
25550 @lisp
25551 (name-service-switch
25552 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
25553
25554 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
25555 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
25556 (name-service
25557 (name "mdns_minimal")
25558
25559 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
25560 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
25561 ;; no need to try the next methods.
25562 (reaction (lookup-specification
25563 (not-found => return))))
25564
25565 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
25566 (name-service
25567 (name "dns"))
25568
25569 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
25570 (name-service
25571 (name "mdns")))))
25572 @end lisp
25573
25574 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
25575 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
25576 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
25577
25578 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
25579 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
25580 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
25581 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
25582 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
25583 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
25584 @code{nscd-service}}).
25585
25586 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
25587 configurations.
25588
25589 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
25590 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
25591 @code{name-service-switch} object.
25592 @end defvr
25593
25594 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
25595 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
25596 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
25597 @end defvr
25598
25599 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
25600 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
25601 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
25602 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25603 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
25604 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
25605 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
25606 run @command{guix system}.
25607
25608 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
25609
25610 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
25611 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
25612 system databases.
25613
25614 @table @code
25615 @item aliases
25616 @itemx ethers
25617 @itemx group
25618 @itemx gshadow
25619 @itemx hosts
25620 @itemx initgroups
25621 @itemx netgroup
25622 @itemx networks
25623 @itemx password
25624 @itemx public-key
25625 @itemx rpc
25626 @itemx services
25627 @itemx shadow
25628 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
25629 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
25630 @end table
25631 @end deftp
25632
25633 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
25634
25635 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
25636 associated lookup action.
25637
25638 @table @code
25639 @item name
25640 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
25641 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25642
25643 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
25644 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
25645 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
25646 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
25647
25648 @item reaction
25649 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
25650 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
25651 Reference Manual}). For example:
25652
25653 @lisp
25654 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
25655 (success => return))
25656 @end lisp
25657 @end table
25658 @end deftp
25659
25660 @node Initial RAM Disk
25661 @section Initial RAM Disk
25662
25663 @cindex initrd
25664 @cindex initial RAM disk
25665 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
25666 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
25667 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
25668 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
25669 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
25670
25671 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
25672 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
25673 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
25674 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
25675 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
25676 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
25677 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
25678 file system, you would write:
25679
25680 @lisp
25681 (operating-system
25682 ;; @dots{}
25683 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
25684 @end lisp
25685
25686 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
25687 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
25688 @end defvr
25689
25690 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
25691 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
25692 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
25693 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
25694 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
25695 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
25696
25697 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
25698 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
25699 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
25700 system declaration like this:
25701
25702 @lisp
25703 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
25704 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
25705 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
25706 (apply base-initrd file-systems
25707 #:qemu-networking? #t
25708 rest)))
25709 @end lisp
25710
25711 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
25712 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
25713 volatile root file system.
25714
25715 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
25716 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
25717 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
25718 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
25719 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
25720 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
25721
25722 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
25723 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
25724 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
25725 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
25726
25727 @table @code
25728 @item --load=@var{boot}
25729 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
25730 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
25731
25732 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
25733 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
25734 initialization system.
25735
25736 @item --root=@var{root}
25737 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
25738 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system
25739 UUID.
25740
25741 @item --system=@var{system}
25742 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
25743 @var{system}.
25744
25745 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
25746 @cindex module, black-listing
25747 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
25748 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
25749 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
25750 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
25751 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
25752
25753 @item --repl
25754 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
25755 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
25756 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
25757 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
25758 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
25759
25760 @end table
25761
25762 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
25763 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
25764 here is how to use it and customize it further.
25765
25766 @cindex initrd
25767 @cindex initial RAM disk
25768 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
25769 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
25770 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
25771 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
25772 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
25773 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
25774 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
25775 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
25776 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
25777 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
25778 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
25779 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
25780 the root file system.
25781
25782 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
25783 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
25784 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
25785 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
25786 intended keyboard layout.
25787
25788 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
25789 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
25790 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
25791
25792 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
25793 to it are lost.
25794 @end deffn
25795
25796 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
25797 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
25798 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
25799 [#:linux-modules '()]
25800 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
25801 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
25802 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
25803 on the kernel command line via @code{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
25804 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
25805
25806 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
25807 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
25808 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
25809 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
25810 intended keyboard layout.
25811
25812 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
25813
25814 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
25815 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
25816 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
25817 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
25818 @end deffn
25819
25820 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
25821 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
25822 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
25823 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
25824 program to run in that initrd.
25825
25826 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
25827 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
25828 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
25829 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
25830 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
25831 automatically copied to the initrd.
25832 @end deffn
25833
25834 @node Bootloader Configuration
25835 @section Bootloader Configuration
25836
25837 @cindex bootloader
25838 @cindex boot loader
25839
25840 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
25841 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
25842 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
25843 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
25844 installed.
25845
25846 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
25847 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
25848 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
25849 field.
25850
25851 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
25852 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
25853
25854 @table @asis
25855
25856 @item @code{bootloader}
25857 @cindex EFI, bootloader
25858 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
25859 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
25860 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
25861 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
25862 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
25863
25864 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
25865 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
25866 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
25867 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
25868 when you boot it on your system.
25869
25870 @vindex grub-bootloader
25871 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
25872 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
25873
25874 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
25875 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
25876 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
25877 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
25878 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
25879 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
25880
25881 @item @code{target}
25882 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
25883 bootloader.
25884
25885 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
25886 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
25887 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
25888 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
25889 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
25890 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}.
25891
25892 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
25893 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
25894 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
25895 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
25896
25897 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
25898 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
25899 current system.
25900
25901 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
25902 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
25903 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
25904
25905 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
25906 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
25907 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
25908 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
25909
25910 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
25911 Layout}).
25912
25913 @quotation Note
25914 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
25915 @code{grub-efi}.
25916 @end quotation
25917
25918 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
25919 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
25920 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
25921 for GRUB.
25922
25923 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
25924 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
25925 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
25926 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
25927 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
25928 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
25929 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
25930
25931 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
25932 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
25933 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
25934 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
25935 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
25936 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
25937 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
25938 manual}).
25939
25940 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
25941 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
25942 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
25943 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
25944
25945 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
25946 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
25947 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
25948 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
25949 @end table
25950
25951 @end deftp
25952
25953 @cindex dual boot
25954 @cindex boot menu
25955 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
25956 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
25957 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
25958 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
25959 along these lines:
25960
25961 @lisp
25962 (menu-entry
25963 (label "The Other Distro")
25964 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
25965 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
25966 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
25967 @end lisp
25968
25969 Details below.
25970
25971 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
25972 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
25973
25974 @table @asis
25975
25976 @item @code{label}
25977 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
25978
25979 @item @code{linux}
25980 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
25981
25982 @lisp
25983 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
25984 @end lisp
25985
25986 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
25987 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
25988 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
25989
25990 @example
25991 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
25992 @end example
25993
25994 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
25995 field is ignored entirely.
25996
25997 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
25998 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
25999 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
26000
26001 @item @code{initrd}
26002 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
26003 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
26004 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
26005 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
26006 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
26007
26008 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
26009 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
26010 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
26011 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
26012 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
26013
26014 @end table
26015 @end deftp
26016
26017 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
26018 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
26019 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not documented yet.
26020
26021 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
26022 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
26023 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
26024 record.
26025
26026 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
26027 logos.
26028 @end defvr
26029
26030
26031 @node Invoking guix system
26032 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
26033
26034 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
26035 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
26036 system} command. The synopsis is:
26037
26038 @example
26039 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
26040 @end example
26041
26042 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
26043 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
26044 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
26045 supported:
26046
26047 @table @code
26048 @item search
26049 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
26050 expressions, sorted by relevance:
26051
26052 @cindex HDPI
26053 @cindex HiDPI
26054 @cindex resolution
26055 @example
26056 $ guix system search console
26057 name: console-fonts
26058 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
26059 extends: shepherd-root
26060 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
26061 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
26062 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
26063 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
26064 +
26065 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
26066 + ("tty2" . (file-append
26067 + font-tamzen
26068 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
26069 + ("tty3" . (file-append
26070 + font-terminus
26071 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
26072 relevance: 9
26073
26074 name: mingetty
26075 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
26076 extends: shepherd-root
26077 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
26078 relevance: 2
26079
26080 name: login
26081 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
26082 extends: pam
26083 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
26084 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
26085 relevance: 2
26086
26087 @dots{}
26088 @end example
26089
26090 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
26091 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
26092 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
26093
26094 @item reconfigure
26095 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
26096 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
26097 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
26098 systems already running Guix System.}.
26099
26100 @quotation Note
26101 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
26102 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
26103 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
26104 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
26105 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
26106 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
26107 @end quotation
26108
26109 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
26110 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
26111 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
26112 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
26113 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
26114 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
26115
26116 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
26117 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
26118 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
26119 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
26120 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26121
26122 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
26123 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
26124 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
26125 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
26126
26127 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
26128 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
26129 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
26130 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
26131 @var{file} itself, when available. This information is useful should
26132 you later want to inspect how this particular generation was built.
26133
26134 In fact, assuming @var{file} is self-contained, you can later rebuild
26135 generation @var{n} of your operating system with:
26136
26137 @example
26138 guix time-machine \
26139 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
26140 system reconfigure \
26141 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
26142 @end example
26143
26144 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
26145 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
26146 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
26147 information on provenance tracking.
26148
26149 @item switch-generation
26150 @cindex generations
26151 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
26152 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
26153 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
26154 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
26155 and it moves the entries for the other generatiors to a submenu, if
26156 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
26157 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
26158
26159 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
26160 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
26161 configuration file.
26162
26163 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
26164 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
26165 generation 7:
26166
26167 @example
26168 guix system switch-generation 7
26169 @end example
26170
26171 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
26172 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
26173 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
26174 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
26175 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
26176 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
26177
26178 @example
26179 guix system switch-generation -- -1
26180 @end example
26181
26182 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
26183 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
26184 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
26185 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
26186 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
26187 like activating and deactivating services.
26188
26189 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
26190
26191 @item roll-back
26192 @cindex rolling back
26193 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
26194 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
26195 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
26196 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
26197
26198 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
26199 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
26200 generation.
26201
26202 @item delete-generations
26203 @cindex deleting system generations
26204 @cindex saving space
26205 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
26206 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
26207 collector'').
26208
26209 This works in the same way as @command{guix package --delete-generations}
26210 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{--delete-generations}}). With no
26211 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
26212
26213 @example
26214 guix system delete-generations
26215 @end example
26216
26217 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
26218 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
26219
26220 @example
26221 guix system delete-generations 2m
26222 @end example
26223
26224 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
26225 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
26226 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
26227
26228 @item build
26229 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
26230 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
26231 This action does not actually install anything.
26232
26233 @item init
26234 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
26235 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
26236 installations of Guix System. For instance:
26237
26238 @example
26239 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
26240 @end example
26241
26242 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
26243 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
26244 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
26245 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
26246 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
26247
26248 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
26249 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
26250 passed.
26251
26252 @item vm
26253 @cindex virtual machine
26254 @cindex VM
26255 @anchor{guix system vm}
26256 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
26257 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
26258
26259 @quotation Note
26260 The @code{vm} action and others below
26261 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
26262 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
26263 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
26264 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
26265 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
26266 @end quotation
26267
26268 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
26269 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
26270 emulated machine:
26271
26272 @example
26273 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
26274 @end example
26275
26276 The VM shares its store with the host system.
26277
26278 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
26279 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
26280 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
26281 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
26282
26283 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
26284 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
26285 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
26286
26287 @example
26288 guix system vm my-config.scm \
26289 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
26290 @end example
26291
26292 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
26293 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
26294 store of the host can then be mounted.
26295
26296 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
26297 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
26298 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
26299 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
26300 size of the image.
26301
26302 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
26303 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
26304 @item vm-image
26305 @itemx disk-image
26306 @itemx docker-image
26307 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
26308 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
26309 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
26310 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
26311 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
26312 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
26313 @code{docker-image}.
26314
26315 You can specify the root file system type by using the
26316 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
26317
26318 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
26319 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM},
26320 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
26321
26322 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
26323 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
26324 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
26325 using the following command:
26326
26327 @example
26328 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
26329 @end example
26330
26331 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
26332 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
26333 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
26334 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
26335 Docker container using commands like the following:
26336
26337 @example
26338 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
26339 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
26340 docker start $container_id
26341 @end example
26342
26343 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
26344 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
26345 start any services you have defined in the operating system
26346 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
26347 using @command{docker exec}:
26348
26349 @example
26350 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
26351 @end example
26352
26353 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
26354 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
26355 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
26356 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
26357 @code{docker create}.
26358
26359 @item container
26360 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
26361 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
26362 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
26363 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
26364 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
26365 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
26366
26367 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
26368 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
26369 system.
26370
26371 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
26372 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
26373 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
26374
26375 @example
26376 guix system container my-config.scm \
26377 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
26378 @end example
26379
26380 @quotation Note
26381 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
26382 @end quotation
26383
26384 @end table
26385
26386 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
26387 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
26388 following:
26389
26390 @table @option
26391 @item --expression=@var{expr}
26392 @itemx -e @var{expr}
26393 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
26394 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
26395 operating system.
26396 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
26397 Installation Image}).
26398
26399 @item --system=@var{system}
26400 @itemx -s @var{system}
26401 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
26402 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
26403
26404 @item --derivation
26405 @itemx -d
26406 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
26407 building anything.
26408
26409 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
26410 @item --save-provenance
26411 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
26412 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
26413 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
26414 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
26415 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
26416 can run:
26417
26418 @example
26419 guix system vm-image --save-provenance config.scm
26420 @end example
26421
26422 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
26423 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
26424 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
26425 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
26426 of the image.
26427
26428 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
26429 @itemx -t @var{type}
26430 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
26431 @var{type} on the image.
26432
26433 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
26434
26435 @cindex ISO-9660 format
26436 @cindex CD image format
26437 @cindex DVD image format
26438 @code{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
26439 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
26440
26441 @item --image-size=@var{size}
26442 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
26443 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
26444 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
26445 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
26446
26447 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
26448 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
26449 @var{file}.
26450
26451 @item --network
26452 @itemx -N
26453 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
26454 that is, do not create a network namespace.
26455
26456 @item --root=@var{file}
26457 @itemx -r @var{file}
26458 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
26459 collector root.
26460
26461 @item --skip-checks
26462 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
26463
26464 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
26465 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
26466 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
26467 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
26468 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
26469 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
26470
26471 @cindex on-error
26472 @cindex on-error strategy
26473 @cindex error strategy
26474 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
26475 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
26476 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
26477
26478 @table @code
26479 @item nothing-special
26480 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
26481
26482 @item backtrace
26483 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
26484
26485 @item debug
26486 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
26487 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
26488 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
26489 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
26490 a list of available debugging commands.
26491 @end table
26492 @end table
26493
26494 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
26495 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
26496 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
26497 bootloader boot menu:
26498
26499 @table @code
26500
26501 @item describe
26502 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
26503 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
26504
26505 @item list-generations
26506 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
26507 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
26508 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
26509 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26510
26511 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
26512 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
26513 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
26514 generations that are up to 10 days old:
26515
26516 @example
26517 $ guix system list-generations 10d
26518 @end example
26519
26520 @end table
26521
26522 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
26523 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
26524 each other:
26525
26526 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
26527 @table @code
26528
26529 @item extension-graph
26530 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
26531 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
26532 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
26533 extensions.)
26534
26535 The command:
26536
26537 @example
26538 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
26539 @end example
26540
26541 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
26542
26543 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
26544 @item shepherd-graph
26545 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
26546 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
26547 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
26548 example graph.
26549
26550 @end table
26551
26552 @node Invoking guix deploy
26553 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
26554
26555 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
26556 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
26557 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
26558 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
26559 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
26560 once as a logical ``deployment''.
26561
26562 @quotation Note
26563 The functionality described in this section is still under development
26564 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
26565 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
26566 @end quotation
26567
26568 @example
26569 guix deploy @var{file}
26570 @end example
26571
26572 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
26573 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
26574
26575 @lisp
26576 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
26577 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
26578 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
26579 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
26580 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
26581
26582 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
26583 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
26584
26585 (define %system
26586 (operating-system
26587 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
26588 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
26589 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
26590 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
26591 (target "/dev/vda")
26592 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
26593 (file-systems (cons (file-system
26594 (mount-point "/")
26595 (device "/dev/vda1")
26596 (type "ext4"))
26597 %base-file-systems))
26598 (services
26599 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
26600 (service openssh-service-type
26601 (openssh-configuration
26602 (permit-root-login #t)
26603 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
26604 %base-services))))
26605
26606 (list (machine
26607 (operating-system %system)
26608 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
26609 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
26610 (host-name "localhost")
26611 (system "x86_64-linux")
26612 (user "alice")
26613 (identity "./id_rsa")
26614 (port 2222)))))
26615 @end lisp
26616
26617 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
26618 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
26619 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @var{%system}.
26620 @var{environment} and @var{configuration} specify how the machine should be
26621 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
26622 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
26623 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
26624 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
26625 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
26626 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
26627 @var{environment} type would be used.
26628
26629 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
26630 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
26631 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
26632
26633 @example
26634 # guix archive --generate-key
26635 @end example
26636
26637 @noindent
26638 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
26639 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
26640
26641 @example
26642 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
26643 @end example
26644
26645 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
26646 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
26647 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
26648 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
26649 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
26650 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
26651 @code{user}. That is: the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
26652 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag.
26653
26654 @deftp {Data Type} machine
26655 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
26656 deployment.
26657
26658 @table @asis
26659 @item @code{operating-system}
26660 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
26661
26662 @item @code{environment}
26663 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
26664
26665 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
26666 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
26667 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
26668 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
26669 however, an error will be thrown.
26670 @end table
26671 @end deftp
26672
26673 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
26674 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
26675 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
26676
26677 @table @asis
26678 @item @code{host-name}
26679 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
26680 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
26681 @item @code{system}
26682 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
26683 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
26684 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
26685 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
26686 keyring.
26687 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
26688 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
26689 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
26690 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
26691 remote host.
26692
26693 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
26694 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
26695
26696 @example
26697 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
26698 @end example
26699
26700 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
26701 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
26702 client does.
26703
26704 @end table
26705 @end deftp
26706
26707 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
26708 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
26709 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
26710
26711 @table @asis
26712 @item @code{ssh-key}
26713 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
26714 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
26715 @item @code{tags}
26716 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
26717 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
26718 @item @code{region}
26719 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
26720 @item @code{size}
26721 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
26722 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
26723 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
26724 @end table
26725 @end deftp
26726
26727 @node Running Guix in a VM
26728 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
26729
26730 @cindex virtual machine
26731 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
26732 distributed at
26733 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
26734 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
26735 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
26736 as QEMU (see below for details).
26737
26738 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
26739 commonly-used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
26740 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
26741 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
26742 as @file{/etc/config.scm} (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
26743
26744 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
26745 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
26746 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
26747 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
26748
26749 @cindex QEMU
26750 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
26751 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
26752 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
26753 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
26754 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
26755 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
26756
26757 @example
26758 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
26759 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
26760 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
26761 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
26762 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
26763 @end example
26764
26765 Here is what each of these options means:
26766
26767 @table @code
26768 @item qemu-system-x86_64
26769 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
26770 host.
26771
26772 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
26773 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
26774 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
26775 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
26776 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
26777 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
26778 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
26779 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
26780
26781 @item -enable-kvm
26782 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
26783 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
26784 faster.
26785
26786 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
26787 @item -m 1024
26788 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
26789 which may be insufficient for some operations.
26790
26791 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
26792 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
26793 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
26794 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
26795 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
26796
26797 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
26798 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing store the
26799 the ``myhd'' drive.
26800 @end table
26801
26802 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
26803 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
26804 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
26805 to your system definition and start the VM using
26806 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
26807 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
26808 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
26809 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
26810
26811 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
26812
26813 @cindex SSH
26814 @cindex SSH server
26815 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
26816 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
26817 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
26818 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
26819
26820 @example
26821 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
26822 @end example
26823
26824 To connect to the VM you can run
26825
26826 @example
26827 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
26828 @end example
26829
26830 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
26831 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
26832 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
26833 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
26834 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
26835
26836 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
26837
26838 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
26839 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
26840 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
26841 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
26842
26843 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
26844 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
26845
26846 @example
26847 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
26848 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
26849 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
26850 name=com.redhat.spice.0
26851 @end example
26852
26853 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
26854
26855 @node Defining Services
26856 @section Defining Services
26857
26858 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
26859 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
26860 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
26861
26862 @menu
26863 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
26864 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
26865 * Service Reference:: API reference.
26866 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
26867 @end menu
26868
26869 @node Service Composition
26870 @subsection Service Composition
26871
26872 @cindex services
26873 @cindex daemons
26874 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
26875 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
26876 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
26877 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
26878 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
26879 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
26880 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
26881 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
26882 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
26883 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
26884 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
26885 of the system.
26886
26887 @cindex service extensions
26888 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
26889 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
26890 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
26891 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
26892 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
26893 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
26894 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
26895 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
26896 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
26897 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
26898 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
26899
26900 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
26901 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
26902 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
26903
26904 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
26905
26906 @cindex system service
26907 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
26908 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
26909 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
26910 to learn about the other service types shown here.
26911 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
26912 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
26913 particular operating system definition.
26914
26915 @cindex service types
26916 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
26917 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
26918 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
26919 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
26920 different parameters.
26921
26922 The following section describes the programming interface for service
26923 types and services.
26924
26925 @node Service Types and Services
26926 @subsection Service Types and Services
26927
26928 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
26929 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
26930 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
26931
26932 @lisp
26933 (define guix-service-type
26934 (service-type
26935 (name 'guix)
26936 (extensions
26937 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
26938 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
26939 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
26940 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
26941 @end lisp
26942
26943 @noindent
26944 It defines three things:
26945
26946 @enumerate
26947 @item
26948 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
26949
26950 @item
26951 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
26952 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
26953 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
26954
26955 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
26956 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
26957
26958 @item
26959 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
26960 @end enumerate
26961
26962 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
26963
26964 @table @code
26965 @item shepherd-root-service-type
26966 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
26967 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
26968 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
26969 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
26970
26971 @item account-service-type
26972 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
26973 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
26974 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
26975 guix-daemon}).
26976
26977 @item activation-service-type
26978 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
26979 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
26980 booted.
26981 @end table
26982
26983 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
26984
26985 @lisp
26986 (service guix-service-type
26987 (guix-configuration
26988 (build-accounts 5)
26989 (use-substitutes? #f)))
26990 @end lisp
26991
26992 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
26993 the parameters of this specific service instance.
26994 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
26995 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
26996 value is omitted, the default value specified by
26997 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
26998
26999 @lisp
27000 (service guix-service-type)
27001 @end lisp
27002
27003 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
27004 services but is not extensible itself.
27005
27006 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
27007
27008 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
27009
27010 @lisp
27011 (define udev-service-type
27012 (service-type (name 'udev)
27013 (extensions
27014 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
27015 udev-shepherd-service)))
27016
27017 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
27018 (extend (lambda (config rules)
27019 (match config
27020 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
27021 (udev-configuration
27022 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
27023 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
27024 @end lisp
27025
27026 This is the service type for the
27027 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
27028 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
27029 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
27030
27031 @table @code
27032 @item compose
27033 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
27034 services of this type.
27035
27036 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
27037 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
27038
27039 @item extend
27040 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
27041 the composition of the extensions.
27042
27043 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
27044 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
27045 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
27046 list of contributed rules.
27047
27048 @item description
27049 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
27050 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
27051 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
27052 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
27053 @end table
27054
27055 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
27056 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
27057 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
27058
27059 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
27060 interface for services.
27061
27062 @node Service Reference
27063 @subsection Service Reference
27064
27065 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
27066 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
27067 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
27068 @code{(gnu services)} module.
27069
27070 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
27071 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
27072 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
27073 this particular service instance.
27074
27075 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
27076 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
27077 raised.
27078
27079 For instance, this:
27080
27081 @lisp
27082 (service openssh-service-type)
27083 @end lisp
27084
27085 @noindent
27086 is equivalent to this:
27087
27088 @lisp
27089 (service openssh-service-type
27090 (openssh-configuration))
27091 @end lisp
27092
27093 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
27094 with the default configuration.
27095 @end deffn
27096
27097 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
27098 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
27099 @end deffn
27100
27101 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
27102 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
27103 @end deffn
27104
27105 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
27106 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
27107 parameters.
27108 @end deffn
27109
27110 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
27111
27112 @lisp
27113 (define s
27114 (service nginx-service-type
27115 (nginx-configuration
27116 (nginx nginx)
27117 (log-directory log-directory)
27118 (run-directory run-directory)
27119 (file config-file))))
27120
27121 (service? s)
27122 @result{} #t
27123
27124 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
27125 @result{} #t
27126 @end lisp
27127
27128 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
27129 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
27130 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
27131 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
27132 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
27133 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
27134 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
27135 common pattern.
27136
27137 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
27138 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
27139
27140 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
27141 clauses. Each clause has the form:
27142
27143 @example
27144 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
27145 @end example
27146
27147 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
27148 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
27149 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
27150 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
27151 @var{type}.
27152
27153 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
27154 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
27155 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
27156 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
27157 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
27158 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
27159
27160 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
27161
27162 @end deffn
27163
27164 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
27165 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
27166 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
27167 @code{operating-system} declaration.
27168
27169 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
27170 @cindex service type
27171 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
27172 and Services}).
27173
27174 @table @asis
27175 @item @code{name}
27176 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
27177
27178 @item @code{extensions}
27179 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
27180
27181 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
27182 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
27183 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
27184 services.
27185
27186 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
27187 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
27188 extensions. It may return any single value.
27189
27190 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
27191 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
27192
27193 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
27194 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
27195 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
27196 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
27197 parameter value for the service instance.
27198 @end table
27199
27200 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
27201 @end deftp
27202
27203 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
27204 @var{compute}
27205 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
27206 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
27207 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
27208 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
27209 @end deffn
27210
27211 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
27212 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
27213 @end deffn
27214
27215 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
27216 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
27217 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
27218 provides a shorthand for this.
27219
27220 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
27221 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
27222 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
27223 service is an instance.
27224
27225 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
27226 an additional job:
27227
27228 @lisp
27229 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
27230 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
27231 @end lisp
27232 @end deffn
27233
27234 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
27235 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
27236 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
27237 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
27238 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
27239 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
27240 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
27241
27242 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
27243 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
27244 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
27245 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
27246 @end deffn
27247
27248 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
27249 service types, some of which are listed below.
27250
27251 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
27252 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
27253 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
27254 @end defvr
27255
27256 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
27257 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
27258 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
27259 @end defvr
27260
27261 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
27262 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
27263 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
27264 passing it name/file tuples such as:
27265
27266 @lisp
27267 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
27268 @end lisp
27269
27270 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
27271 pointing to the given file.
27272 @end defvr
27273
27274 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
27275 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
27276 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
27277 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
27278 @end defvr
27279
27280 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
27281 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
27282 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
27283 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
27284 @end defvr
27285
27286 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
27287 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
27288 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
27289 in the system itself. It creates several files under
27290 @file{/run/current-system}:
27291
27292 @table @file
27293 @item channels.scm
27294 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
27295 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
27296 to build the system, if that information was available
27297 (@pxref{Channels}).
27298
27299 @item configuration.scm
27300 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
27301 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
27302 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
27303 received on the command line.
27304
27305 @item provenance
27306 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
27307 format that is more readily processable.
27308 @end table
27309
27310 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
27311 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
27312
27313 @quotation Caveats
27314 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
27315 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
27316 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
27317 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
27318 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
27319 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
27320
27321 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
27322 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
27323 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
27324 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
27325 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
27326 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
27327 comparison less trivial.
27328 @end quotation
27329
27330 This service is automatically added to your operating system
27331 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
27332 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
27333 @end defvr
27334
27335 @node Shepherd Services
27336 @subsection Shepherd Services
27337
27338 @cindex shepherd services
27339 @cindex PID 1
27340 @cindex init system
27341 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
27342 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
27343 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
27344 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
27345 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27346
27347 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
27348 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
27349 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
27350 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
27351 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
27352
27353 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
27354
27355 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
27356 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
27357 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
27358
27359 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
27360 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
27361 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
27362
27363 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
27364 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
27365
27366 @table @asis
27367 @item @code{provision}
27368 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
27369
27370 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
27371 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
27372 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
27373 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
27374
27375 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
27376 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
27377
27378 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
27379 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
27380 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
27381 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
27382 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
27383
27384 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
27385 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
27386 underlying process dies.
27387
27388 @item @code{start}
27389 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
27390 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
27391 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
27392 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
27393 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
27394 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
27395
27396 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
27397 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
27398 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
27399 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
27400 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
27401 @command{herd} sub-commands:
27402
27403 @example
27404 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
27405 @end example
27406
27407 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
27408 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
27409 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
27410
27411 @item @code{documentation}
27412 A documentation string, as shown when running:
27413
27414 @example
27415 herd doc @var{service-name}
27416 @end example
27417
27418 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
27419 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27420
27421 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
27422 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
27423 @code{stop} are evaluated.
27424
27425 @end table
27426 @end deftp
27427
27428 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
27429 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
27430 Shepherd service (see above).
27431
27432 @table @code
27433 @item name
27434 Symbol naming the action.
27435
27436 @item documentation
27437 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
27438
27439 @example
27440 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
27441 @end example
27442
27443 @item procedure
27444 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
27445 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
27446 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27447 @end table
27448
27449 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
27450 greets the user:
27451
27452 @lisp
27453 (shepherd-action
27454 (name 'say-hello)
27455 (documentation "Say hi!")
27456 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
27457 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
27458 args)
27459 #t)))
27460 @end lisp
27461
27462 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
27463
27464 @example
27465 # herd say-hello example
27466 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
27467 # herd say-hello example a b c
27468 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
27469 @end example
27470
27471 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
27472 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
27473 info on actions.
27474 @end deftp
27475
27476 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
27477 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
27478
27479 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
27480 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
27481 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
27482 @end defvr
27483
27484 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
27485 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
27486 @end defvr
27487
27488
27489 @node Documentation
27490 @chapter Documentation
27491
27492 @cindex documentation, searching for
27493 @cindex searching for documentation
27494 @cindex Info, documentation format
27495 @cindex man pages
27496 @cindex manual pages
27497 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
27498 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
27499 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
27500 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
27501 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
27502 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
27503
27504 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
27505 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
27506 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
27507
27508 @example
27509 $ info -k TLS
27510 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
27511 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
27512 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
27513 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
27514 @dots{}
27515 @end example
27516
27517 @noindent
27518 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
27519
27520 @example
27521 $ man -k TLS
27522 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
27523 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
27524 @dots {}
27525 @end example
27526
27527 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
27528 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
27529 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
27530 respected.
27531
27532 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
27533 running, say:
27534
27535 @example
27536 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
27537 @end example
27538
27539 @noindent
27540 or:
27541
27542 @example
27543 $ man certtool
27544 @end example
27545
27546 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
27547 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
27548 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
27549 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
27550 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
27551 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
27552
27553 @node Installing Debugging Files
27554 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
27555
27556 @cindex debugging files
27557 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
27558 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
27559 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
27560 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
27561 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
27562
27563 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
27564 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
27565 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
27566 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
27567 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
27568 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
27569 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
27570
27571 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
27572 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
27573 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
27574 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
27575 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
27576 with GDB}).
27577
27578 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
27579 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
27580 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
27581 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
27582 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
27583 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
27584 Guile:
27585
27586 @example
27587 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
27588 @end example
27589
27590 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
27591 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
27592 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
27593 GDB}):
27594
27595 @example
27596 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
27597 @end example
27598
27599 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
27600 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
27601
27602 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
27603 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
27604 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
27605 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
27606 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
27607 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
27608
27609 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
27610 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
27611 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
27612 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
27613 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
27614 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
27615 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
27616 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
27617
27618
27619 @node Security Updates
27620 @chapter Security Updates
27621
27622 @cindex security updates
27623 @cindex security vulnerabilities
27624 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
27625 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
27626 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
27627 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
27628 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
27629 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
27630 distribution:
27631
27632 @smallexample
27633 $ guix lint -c cve
27634 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
27635 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
27636 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
27637 @dots{}
27638 @end smallexample
27639
27640 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
27641
27642 Guix follows a functional
27643 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
27644 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
27645 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
27646 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
27647 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
27648 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
27649 desired.
27650
27651 @cindex grafts
27652 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
27653 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
27654 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
27655 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
27656 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
27657 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
27658 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
27659
27660 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
27661 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
27662 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
27663 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
27664 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
27665 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
27666
27667 @lisp
27668 (define bash
27669 (package
27670 (name "bash")
27671 ;; @dots{}
27672 (replacement bash-fixed)))
27673 @end lisp
27674
27675 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
27676 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
27677 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
27678 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
27679 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
27680 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
27681 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
27682 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
27683
27684 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
27685 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
27686 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
27687 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
27688 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
27689 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
27690 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
27691
27692 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
27693 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
27694 Thus, the command:
27695
27696 @example
27697 guix build bash --no-grafts
27698 @end example
27699
27700 @noindent
27701 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
27702
27703 @example
27704 guix build bash
27705 @end example
27706
27707 @noindent
27708 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
27709 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
27710
27711 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
27712 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
27713
27714 @example
27715 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
27716 @end example
27717
27718 @noindent
27719 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
27720 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
27721
27722 @example
27723 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
27724 @end example
27725
27726 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
27727 @command{lsof} command:
27728
27729 @example
27730 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
27731 @end example
27732
27733
27734 @node Bootstrapping
27735 @chapter Bootstrapping
27736
27737 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
27738
27739 @cindex bootstrapping
27740
27741 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
27742 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
27743 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
27744 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
27745 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
27746 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
27747 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
27748 a ``regular user''.
27749
27750 @cindex bootstrap binaries
27751 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
27752 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
27753 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
27754 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
27755 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
27756 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
27757 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
27758 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
27759 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
27760
27761 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
27762 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
27763
27764 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux} the Guix bootstrap process is
27765 more elaborate, @pxref{Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap}.
27766
27767 @menu
27768 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
27769 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
27770 @end menu
27771
27772 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
27773 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
27774
27775 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
27776 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
27777 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
27778 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
27779 ``taken for granted.''
27780
27781 Taking these binaries for granted means that we consider them to be a correct
27782 and trustworthy `seed' for building the complete system. Therein lies a
27783 problem: the current combined size of these bootstrap binaries is about 250MB
27784 (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing or even inspecting
27785 these is next to impossible.
27786
27787 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a ``Reduced
27788 Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full Source
27789 Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would be hyperbole
27790 to use that term for what we do now.}.
27791
27792 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
27793 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
27794 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
27795 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
27796 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC). Using
27797 these new binary seeds and a new set of
27798 @c
27799 packages@footnote{@c
27800 nyacc-boot,
27801 mes-boot,
27802 tcc-boot0,
27803 tcc-boot,
27804 make-mesboot0,
27805 diffutils-mesboot,
27806 binutils-mesboot0,
27807 gcc-core-mesboot,
27808 mesboot-headers,
27809 glibc-mesboot0,
27810 gcc-mesboot0,
27811 binutils-mesboot,
27812 make-mesboot,
27813 gcc-mesboot1,
27814 gcc-mesboot1-wrapper,
27815 glibc-headers-mesboot,
27816 glibc-mesboot,
27817 gcc-mesboot,
27818 and
27819 gcc-mesboot-wrapper.
27820 }
27821 @c
27822 the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU C Library are built from source.
27823 From here on the more traditional bootstrap process resumes. This approach
27824 has reduced the bootstrap binaries in size to about 130MB. Work is ongoing to
27825 reduce this further. If you are interested, join us on @code{#bootstrappable}
27826 on the Freenode IRC network.
27827
27828 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph --type=bag -e '(begin (use-modules (guix packages)) (%current-system "i686-linux") (@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-mesboot))' > doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.dot
27829 @c dot -T png doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.dot > doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.png
27830
27831 Below is the generated dependency graph for @code{gcc-mesboot}, the bootstrap
27832 compiler used to build the rest of GuixSD.
27833
27834 @image{images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the gcc-mesboot}
27835
27836 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
27837 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
27838
27839 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
27840 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
27841 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
27842
27843 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
27844 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
27845 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
27846 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
27847
27848 @example
27849 guix graph -t derivation \
27850 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
27851 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
27852 @end example
27853
27854 or, for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
27855
27856 @example
27857 guix graph -t derivation \
27858 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
27859 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
27860 @end example
27861
27862 At this level of detail, things are
27863 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
27864 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
27865 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
27866 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
27867 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
27868 (@pxref{The Store}).
27869
27870 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
27871 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
27872 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
27873 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
27874 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
27875 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
27876 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
27877 tarball to be unpacked.
27878
27879 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
27880 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
27881 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
27882 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
27883 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
27884 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
27885 in the store, using the original layout. The
27886 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
27887 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
27888 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
27889 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
27890
27891 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
27892 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
27893 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
27894 point we have a working C tool chain.
27895
27896 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
27897
27898 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
27899 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
27900 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
27901 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
27902 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
27903 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
27904 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
27905
27906 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
27907 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
27908 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
27909 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
27910 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
27911 package from source. The command:
27912
27913 @example
27914 guix graph -t bag \
27915 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
27916 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
27917 @end example
27918
27919 @noindent
27920 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
27921 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
27922 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
27923 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
27924
27925 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
27926
27927 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
27928 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
27929 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
27930 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
27931 built.
27932
27933 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
27934 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
27935 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
27936 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
27937
27938 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
27939 GCC uses @code{ld}
27940 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
27941 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
27942 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
27943
27944 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
27945 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
27946 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
27947 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
27948 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
27949
27950
27951 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
27952
27953 @cindex bootstrap binaries
27954 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
27955 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
27956 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
27957 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
27958
27959 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
27960 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
27961 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
27962 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
27963 command-line tools):
27964
27965 @example
27966 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
27967 @end example
27968
27969 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
27970 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
27971 this section.
27972
27973 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
27974 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
27975 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
27976 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
27977 know.
27978
27979 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
27980
27981 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
27982 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
27983 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
27984 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
27985 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
27986 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
27987
27988 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
27989 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
27990 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
27991 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
27992 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
27993
27994 The @uref{http://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
27995 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
27996 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
27997 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
27998 a simple and auditable assembler.
27999
28000 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
28001 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
28002 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
28003 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
28004 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
28005 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
28006 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
28007 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
28008
28009 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
28010 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
28011
28012 @node Porting
28013 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
28014
28015 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
28016 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
28017 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
28018 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
28019 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
28020 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
28021 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
28022
28023 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
28024 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
28025 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
28026 one:
28027
28028 @example
28029 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
28030 @end example
28031
28032 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
28033 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
28034 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
28035 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
28036 taught about the new platform.
28037
28038 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
28039 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
28040 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
28041 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
28042 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
28043 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
28044 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
28045 as well.
28046
28047 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
28048 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
28049 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
28050 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
28051 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
28052 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
28053 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
28054 reason.
28055
28056 @c *********************************************************************
28057 @include contributing.texi
28058
28059 @c *********************************************************************
28060 @node Acknowledgments
28061 @chapter Acknowledgments
28062
28063 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
28064 which was designed and
28065 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
28066 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
28067 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
28068 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
28069 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
28070
28071 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
28072 an inspiration for Guix.
28073
28074 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
28075 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
28076 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
28077 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
28078 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
28079
28080
28081 @c *********************************************************************
28082 @node GNU Free Documentation License
28083 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
28084 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
28085 @include fdl-1.3.texi
28086
28087 @c *********************************************************************
28088 @node Concept Index
28089 @unnumbered Concept Index
28090 @printindex cp
28091
28092 @node Programming Index
28093 @unnumbered Programming Index
28094 @syncodeindex tp fn
28095 @syncodeindex vr fn
28096 @printindex fn
28097
28098 @bye
28099
28100 @c Local Variables:
28101 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
28102 @c End: